Loading...
HomeMy WebLinkAboutFinally adopt Ordinance No. 1761 Report compiled on June 23, 2009 Commission Memorandum REPORT TO: Honorable Mayor and City Commission FROM: Andrew Epple, Planning Director Chris Kukulski, City Manager SUBJECT: Ordinance 1761, second reading adopting UDO text amendments, Z- 08041 MEETING DATE: Monday, July 6, 2009 RECOMMENDATION: Approve 2nd reading of Ordinance 1761 adopting amendments to Title 18, Unified Development Ordinance, BMC. BACKGROUND: The City Commission concluded the public hearing on this item on June 22nd and took action to pass first reading of Ordinance 1761. This action is the 2nd reading of the ordinance. The effective date for this ordinance has been set for August 8, 2009. This is the first weekend after the passage of the minimum 30 day delayed implementation period. We traditionally have selected effective dates of ordinances to occur on weekends as they provide a clean transition of standards. UNRESOLVED ISSUES: None FISCAL EFFECTS: No immediate or direct fiscal effects are expected from most edits. Revisions to the requirement to include maps in published notices will reduce costs for advertising. Those costs are primarily covered with application fees. ALTERNATIVES: As suggested by the City Commission. CONTACT: Please feel free to call or email Chris Saunders at csaunders@bozeman.net, 582- 2260, if you have questions prior to the meeting. Respectfully submitted, Andrew Epple, Planning Director Chris Kukulski, City Manager Attachments: Second Reading ordinance 1761 Text attachment for ordinance 1761 56 1 ORDINANCE NO. 1761 AN ORDINANCE OF THE CITY COMMISSION OF THE CITY OF BOZEMAN, MONTANA, AMENDING TITLE 18 OF THE BOZEMAN MUNICIPAL CODE (THE UNIFIED DEVELOPMENT ORDINANCE) REVISING DEVELOPMENT PROCEDURES, AMENDING AND ESTABLISHING DEFINITIONS, ESTABLISHING CATEGORIES OF USES, AND AMENDING DEVELOPMENT STANDARDS. WHEREAS, the City of Bozeman has adopted a Unified Development Ordinance which establishes common standards for both zoning and subdivision development; and WHEREAS, the proposed Unified Development Ordinance text amendment application has been properly submitted, reviewed and advertised; and WHEREAS, the Bozeman Zoning Commission and Bozeman Planning Board held a joint public hearing on April 21, 2009 to receive and review all written and oral testimony on the request for a Unified Development Ordinance text amendment; and WHEREAS, as shown in Zoning Commission Resolution Z-08041, the Bozeman Zoning Commission recommended to the Bozeman City Commission that some of the Unified Development Ordinance text amendments be approved and others not be approved; and WHEREAS, as shown in Planning Board Resolution Z-08041, the Bozeman Planning Board recommended to the Bozeman City Commission that some of the Unified Development Ordinance text amendments be approved and others not be approved; and 57 2 WHEREAS, after proper notice, the City Commission held it’s public hearing on May 11, 2009, to receive and review all written and oral testimony on the request for a text amendment to the Unified Development Ordinance; and WHEREAS, the City Commission has reviewed and considered the relevant Unified Development Ordinance text amendment criteria established in Section 76-2-304, M.C.A., and found the proposed Unified Development Ordinance text amendment to be in compliance with the purposes of the title as locally adopted in Section 18.02.040, BMC; and WHEREAS, the City Commission has reviewed and considered the purposes of subdivision regulations established in Sections 76-3-102 and 76-3-501 M.C.A. and locally incorporated in Section 18.02.040, Unified Development Ordinance, and found the proposed Unified Development Ordinance text amendment to be in compliance with the purposes of Section 18.02.040, BMC; and WHEREAS, at its public hearing held on May 11, 2009, the City Commission saw that additional time was required to consider the proposed Unified Development Ordinance text amendment and continued the public hearing; and WHEREAS, at its continued public hearing held on June 22, 2009, the City Commission found that the proposed Unified Development Ordinance text amendment with revisions as directed by the City Commission would be in compliance with Bozeman’s adopted growth policy and would be in the public interest. NOW, THEREFORE, BE IT ORDAINED by the City Commission of the City of Bozeman, Montana, upon a vote of _____ to ____, that: Section 1 Chapter 18.16 of the Unified Development Ordinance be amended as follows: 58 3 See Exhibit A Section 2 Chapter 18.18 of the Unified Development Ordinance be amended as follows: See Exhibit B Section 3 Chapter 18.20 of the Unified Development Ordinance be amended as follows: See Exhibit C Section 4 Chapter 18.28 of the Unified Development Ordinance be amended as follows: See Exhibit D Section 5 Chapter 18.34 of the Unified Development Ordinance be amended as follows: See Exhibit E Section 6 Chapter 18.38 of the Unified Development Ordinance be amended as follows: See Exhibit F Section 7 Chapter 18.40 of the Unified Development Ordinance be amended as follows: See Exhibit G Section 8 Chapter 18.42 of the Unified Development Ordinance be amended as follows: See Exhibit H Section 9 59 4 Chapter 18.46 of the Unified Development Ordinance be amended as follows: See Exhibit I Section 10 Chapter 18.52 of the Unified Development Ordinance be amended as follows: See Exhibit J Section 11 Chapter 18.56 of the Unified Development Ordinance be amended as follows: See Exhibit K Section 12 Chapter 18.62 of the Unified Development Ordinance be amended as follows: See Exhibit L Section 13 Chapter 18.64 of the Unified Development Ordinance be amended as follows: See Exhibit M Section 14 Chapter 18.72 of the Unified Development Ordinance be amended as follows: See Exhibit N Section 15 Chapter 18.74 of the Unified Development Ordinance be amended as follows: See Exhibit O Section 16 Chapter 18.76 of the Unified Development Ordinance be amended as follows: See Exhibit P 60 5 Section 17 Chapter 18.78 of the Unified Development Ordinance be amended as follows: See Exhibit Q Section 18 Chapter 18.80 of the Unified Development Ordinance be amended as follows: See Exhibit R Section 19 Severability. If any provision of this ordinance or the application thereof to any person or circumstances is held invalid, such invalidity shall not affect the other provisions of this ordinance which may be given effect without the invalid provision or application and, to this end, the provisions of this ordinance are declared to be severable. Section 20 Savings Provision. This ordinance does not affect the rights of duties that matured, penalties and assessments that were incurred or proceedings that began before the effective date of this ordinance. Section 21 The effective date is August 8, 2009. 61 6 PASSED by the City Commission of the City of Bozeman, Montana, on first reading, at a regular session thereof held on the 22nd day of June 2009. _____________________________ KAAREN JACOBSON Mayor ATTEST: ____________________________ STACY ULMEN, CMC City Clerk PASSED, ADOPTED AND FINALLY APPROVED by the City Commission of the City of Bozeman, Montana, on second reading, at a regular session thereof held on the 6th day of July 2009. ____________________________ KAAREN JACOBSON Mayor ATTEST: ___________________________ STACY ULMEN, CMC City Clerk APPROVED AS TO FORM: ______________________________ GREG SULLIVAN City Attorney 62 Ordinance # 1761. page 16-1 CHAPTER 18.16 RESIDENTIAL ZONING DISTRICTS 18.16.010 INTENT AND PURPOSE OF RESIDENTIAL ZONING DISTRICTS The intent and purpose of the residential zoning districts is to establish areas within Bozeman that are primarily residential in character and to set forth certain minimum standards for development within those areas. The purpose in having more than one residential district is to provide opportunities for a variety of housing types and arrangements within the community while providing a basic level of predictability. There is a rebuttable presumption that the uses set forth for each district will be compatible with each other when the standards of this title are met and any applicable conditions of approval have been satisfied. Additional requirements for development apply within overlay districts. All development is subject to §18.02.050, BMC. A. The intent and purpose of the R-S, Residential Suburban, district is to allow open space, resource protection and primarily single-household development in circumstances where environmental constraints limit the desirable density. All new subdivision and site plan developments in this district shall be subject to the provisions of Chapter 18.36, BMC, Planned Unit Development, and shall be developed in compliance with the adopted Bozeman growth policy. B. The intent of the R-1, Residential Single-household, Low Density district is to provide for primarily single-household residential development and related uses within the City at urban densities, and to provide for such community facilities and services as will serve the area’s residents while respecting the residential character and quality of the area. C. The intent of the R-2, Residential Two-household, Medium Density district is to provide for one- and two-household residential development at urban densities within the City in areas that present few or no development constraints, and for community facilities to serve such development while respecting the residential quality and nature of the area. D. The intent of the R-3, Residential Medium Density, district is to provide for the development of one- to five-household residential structures near service facilities within the City. It should provide for a variety of housing types to serve the varied needs of households of different size, age and character, while reducing the adverse effect of nonresidential uses. E. The intent of the R-4, Residential High Density district is to provide for high-density residential development through a variety of housing types within the City with associated service functions. This will provide for a variety of compatible housing types to serve the varying needs of the community’s residents. The net density, as defined in Chapter 18.80, BMC, for new developments shall be 8 dwellings per acre or greater. Although some office use is permitted, it shall remain as a secondary use to residential development. Secondary status shall be as measured by percentage of total building area. F. The intent of the R-O, Residential-Office district is to provide for and encourage the development of multi-household and apartment development and compatible professional offices and businesses that would blend well with adjacent land uses. The primary use of a lot, as measured by building area, permitted in the R-O district is determined by the underlying growth policy land use designation. Where the district lies over a residential growth policy designation the primary use shall be non-office uses; where the district lies over a non-residential designation the primary use shall be office and other non-residential uses. Primary use shall be measured by percentage of building floor area. 63 Ordinance # 1761. page 16-2 G. The intent of the RMH, Residential Manufactured Home Community district is to provide for manufactured home community development and directly related complementary uses within the City at a density and character compatible with adjacent development. The district is intended to be residential in character and consistent with the standards for other forms of residential development permitted by this title. 18.16.020 AUTHORIZED USES A. Uses in the various residential districts are depicted in the table below. Principal uses are indicated with a “P”, conditional uses are indicated with a “C”, accessory uses are indicated with an “A” and uses which are not permitted with the district are indicated by a “-”. B. Additional uses for telecommunication uses are contained in Chapter 18.54, BMC. Table 16-1 Table of Residential Uses Authorized Uses R-S R-1 R-2 R-3 R-4 R-O RMH Accessory dwelling units8, 9 C C P P P P - Agricultural uses on 2.5 acres or more2 P - - - - - - Agricultural uses on less than 2.5 acres2 C - - - - - - Apartments/Apartment Building, as defined in Chapter 18.80 - - - - P P - Assisted living/elderly care facilities - - - C C P - Bed and breakfast C - C C P P - Commercial stable C - - - - - - Community centers C C C C C P C Community residential facilities (with more than four residents) C C C P P P C Cooperative housing C C C P P P C Day care centers C C C P P P C Essential services (Type I) P P P P P P P Essential services (Type II) C - - - - - C Extended stay lodgings - - - - P P - Family day care home P P P P P P P Fences A A A A A A A Fraternity and sorority houses - - - C P P - Golf courses C C C - - - C Greenhouses A A A A A A - Group day care home P P P P P P P Guesthouses A A A A A A - 64 Ordinance # 1761. page 16-3 Table of Residential Uses Authorized Uses R-S R-1 R-2 R-3 R-4 R-O RMH Home based businesses5 A/C A/C A/C A/C A/C A/C A/C Lodging houses - - - C P P - Offices - - - - C3 P - Other buildings and structures typically accessory to authorized uses A A A A A A A Private garages A A A A A A A Private or jointly owned community center or recreational facilities A A A A A A A Private storm water control facilities A A A A A A A Private vehicle and boat storage A A A A A A A/C4 Public and private parks P P P P P P P Manufactured homes on permanent foundations1 P P P P P P P Manufactured home communities - - - - - - P Medical offices, clinics, and centers - - - - C P - Recreational vehicle parks C - - - - - P Signs, subject to Chapter 18.52, BMC A A A A A A A Single-household dwelling P P P P P P P Temporary buildings and yards incidental to construction work A A A A A A A Temporary sales and office buildings A A A A A A A Three- or four-household dwelling - - - P P P - Two-household dwelling - - P P P P - Townhouses (two attached units) P7 P7 P P P P P7 Townhouses (five attached units or less) - - - P6 P P - Townhouses (more than five attached units) - - - - P P - Tool sheds for storage of domestic supplies A A A A A A A Uses approved as part of a PUD per Chapter 18.36, BMC C C C C C C C Veterinary uses C - - - - - - Notes: 1Manufactured homes are subject to the standards of §18.40.130, BMC. 2Agricultural uses includes barns and animal shelters, and the keeping of animals and fowl, together with their dependent young, as hereinafter set forth per 2.5 acres: one horse or one cow; two sheep or two goats; ten rabbits; thirty-six fowl (chickens, pheasants, pigeons, etc.) or six larger fowl (ducks, geese, turkeys, etc.). For larger parcels the Planning Director may determine that a larger number of livestock is consistent with the requirements of this section. 3Only when in conjunction with dwellings. 65 Ordinance # 1761. page 16-4 4Storage for more than three recreational vehicles or boats. 5Home based businesses are subject to the terms and thresholds of §18.40.110, BMC. 6In the R-3 district, townhouse groups shall not exceed 120 feet in total width 7In the R-S, R-1, and RMH district townhomes are only allowed when utilized to satisfy the requirements of Title 17, Chapter 2, BMC, Affordable Housing. May only be utilized in developments subject to Chapter 17.02, BMC, 8Not permitted on reduced size lots for work force housing as described in Chapter 17.02, BMC. 9Accessory Dwelling Units in the RS and R1 Districts, shall be permitted to be placed above garages only in subdivisions receiving preliminary plat approval after January 1, 1997. 18.16.030 LOT COVERAGE AND FLOOR AREA A. Maximum lot coverage by principal and accessory buildings shall be: 1. For newly created lots in the R-S district, determined through the PUD review procedures set forth in Chapter 18.36, BMC, in compliance with the adopted Bozeman growth policy. a. For existing lots in the R-S district, not more than 25 percent of the lot area shall be covered by principal and accessory buildings. 2. Not more than 40 percent of the lot area in the R-1, R-2, R-3 and RMH districts. 3. Not more than 50 percent in the R-4 district. 4. Not more than 40 percent for residential uses or 60 percent for nonresidential or mixed uses in the R-O district. 5. In all residential zoning districts for those lots used to satisfy the requirements of Chapter 17.02 BMC not more than 60 percent of the lot area shall be covered by principal and accessory buildings. When a larger lot has a portion of its total dwellings subject to the requirements of Chapter 17.02, BMC, either directly or inherited from an previous subdivision, the portion used for those dwellings may have up to 60 percent of the lot area covered by principal and accessory buildings. B. Minimum floor area requirements for each dwelling in all districts shall be that area required by the City’s adopted International Building Code. C. The total floor area of the unit built on a lot subject to the provisions of §18.42.180, Provision of Restricted Size Lots and Units, (excluding area used for a garage) shall not exceed a floor area ratio of 1:3.3. For example, if the lot is 5,000 square feet the square footage of the house can not exceed 1,515, or a ratio of 1 square foot of floor area for each 3.3 square feet of lot area. 18.16.040 LOT AREA AND WIDTH A. All lots shall have a minimum area as set forth in the table below and are cumulative. These minimums assume a lack of development constraints. Each lot must have a usable lot area of at least 50% of the total minimum lot area: Table 16-2 Lot Area Table Minimum Lot Area in Square Feet1 R-S R-1 R-2 R-3 R-4 R-O RMH Single-household dwelling See Paragraph C below 5,0001 5,0001 5,0001 5,0001 5,0001 5,0001 Single-household dwelling (only for dwellings to satisfy minimum requirements of Chapter 17.02, BMC)7 2,7008 2,7008 2,7008 2,7008 2,7008 2,7008 2,7008 Two-household dwelling - - 6,000 6,000 6,000 6,000 - 66 Ordinance # 1761. page 16-5 Lot Area Table Minimum Lot Area in Square Feet1 R-S R-1 R-2 R-3 R-4 R-O RMH Two-household dwelling (only for dwellings to satisfy minimum requirements of Chapter 17.02, BMC)7 - - 2,500 2,500 2,500 2,500 - Lot area per dwelling in three- or four-household dwelling configurations - - - 3,000 3,000 3,000 - Lot area per dwelling in three- or four-household dwelling configurations (only for dwellings to satisfy minimum requirements of Chapter 17.02, BMC)7 - - - 2,500 2,500 2,500 - Townhouses - - 3,0006 3,0002 3,0002 3,0002 - Townhouses (only for dwellings to satisfy minimum requirements of Chapter 17.02, BMC) 7 2,500 2,500 2,500 2,500 2,500 2,500 2,500 Apartments - first dwelling - - - - 5,000 5,000 - Apartments - each dwelling after the first - - - - 1,200 1,200 - Apartments - each dwelling after the first (only for dwellings to satisfy minimum requirements of Chapter 17.02, BMC) 7 - - - - 900 900 - Additional area required for an accessory dwelling unit3 1,0004 1,000 1,0005 1,0005 1,0005 1,0005 - All other uses 5,0001 5,0001 5,0001 5,0001 5,0001 5,0001 5,0001 Notes: 1In order to comply with the standards contained in Title 18, lot area in excess of the required minimum may be needed; for example for corner lots, parking, landscaping or large residential structures, and may be necessary for property adjacent to watercourses, ridgelines, or other environmental features in order to provide an appropriate buildable area on the lot. 2For townhouse clusters the minimum average lot area per dwelling in an individual structure shall be 3,000 square feet. 3As defined in Chapter 18.80, BMC and subject to the requirements of Chapter 18.40, BMC. 4Extra lot size requirement does not apply when R-S lots are larger than 6,000 square feet. 5Second dwellings in accessory buildings are subject to all restrictions in this title relating to accessory buildings. Lot area and width shall be provided as if the dwelling were attached to the principal use. Dwellings to be developed under this option are subject to §18.40.030, BMC. 6Per townhouse lot. 7May only be utilized in developments subject to Chapter 17.02, BMC. 8 A larger lot size may be required to comply with the requirements of Section 17.02.050, table Mix and Price of Dwelling Units B. All lots shall have a minimum width as set forth in the table below. These minimums assume a lack of development constraints Table 16-3 Lot Width Table Minimum Lot Width in Feet R-S R-1 R-2 R-3 R-4 R-O RMH Single-household dwelling See Paragraph C below 50 50 50 50 50 50 Single-household dwelling (only for dwellings to satisfy requirements of Chapter 17.02, BMC) See Paragraph C below 30 30 30 30 30 30 Two household dwelling - - 60 60 50 50 - 67 Ordinance # 1761. page 16-6 Lot Width Table Minimum Lot Width in Feet R-S R-1 R-2 R-3 R-4 R-O RMH Accessory dwelling unit1 50 50 60 60 60 60 - Dwellings in three- or four-household dwelling configurations - - - 60 60 60 - Townhouses 30 30 30 Width of interior units Width of interior units Width of interior units - All other uses See Paragraph C below 50 50 50 50 50 50 Notes: 1Second dwellings in accessory buildings are subject to all restrictions in this title relating to accessory buildings. Lot area and width shall be provided as if the dwelling were attached to the principal use. Dwellings to be developed under this option are subject to §18.40.030, BMC. C. Lot Area and Width for R-S, Residential Suburban Lots. 1. Lot area and width for newly created lots in R-S districts shall be determined through the PUD review procedures set forth in Chapter 18.36, BMC and in compliance with the adopted Bozeman growth policy. Unless otherwise approved through the planned unit development process, the average lot size shall be one acre. 2. Existing lots in the R-S district not utilizing a community water and/or sewer system shall be considered nonconforming lots if less than one acre in area and/or 100 feet in width and subject to Chapter 18.66, BMC. Existing lots in the R-S district utilizing a community water and/or sewer system shall be considered nonconforming lots if less than one-half acre in area and/or 100 feet in width and subject to Chapter 18.60, BMC. D. Lot area and width may be reduced to allow a density bonus through the PUD process. Amount of a bonus, methodology for calculating the bonus, and standards for allowing a bonus are described in §18.36.090.E.2.b(6), BMC. E. When new lots are created utilizing the modular lotting provisions of §18.42.030, BMC, they shall be developed in combination adequate to meet the width requirements of subsections A and B of this section. 18.16.050 YARDS A. Minimum yards required for the R-1, R-2, R-3, R-4, R-O and RMH districts are: 1. Front yard: a. Adjacent to arterial streets as designated in the Bozeman growth policy - 25 feet b. Adjacent to collector streets as designated in the Bozeman growth policy - 20 feet c. Adjacent to local streets - 15 feet 2. Rear yard - 20 feet a. Adjacent to arterial streets as designated in the Bozeman growth policy - 25 feet 3. Side yard - 5 feet; or 0 feet for interior walls of townhouses. 4. All vehicle entrances, oriented to the street, into garages shall be no closer than 20 feet to a property line, unless explicitly authorized otherwise under this title. B. Minimum yards required for the R-S district are: 1. For lots created in the R-S district prior to the effective date of these regulations: 68 Ordinance # 1761. page 16-7 a. Front yard - 35 feet b. Rear yard - 25 feet c. Side yard - 25 feet 2. Minimum yard requirements for newly created R-S lots shall be determined through the PUD review process. 3. All pens, coops, barns, stables or permanent corrals shall be set back not less than 100 feet from any residence or public road and not less than 50 feet from any property line. C. When a lot has 1 or more principal buildings which are oriented to place the functional rear of a building adjacent to a side lot line a setback from the property line equal to that for a rear yard shall be provided. D All yards are subject to the provisions of §18.30.060, §18.38.060, §18.42.100, §18.44.100 and §18.48.100, BMC. 18.16.060 BUILDING HEIGHT Maximum building height for each residential district shall be as follows: Table 16-4 Residential Building Height Table Maximum Building Height in Feet Roof Pitch in Feet R-S R-1 R-2 R-3 R-4 R-O RMH Less than 3:12 24 24 24 32 34 34 24 3:12 or greater but less than 6:12 30 28 28 38 38 38 28 6:12 or greater but less than 9:12 34 32 32 40 42 42 32 Equal to or greater than 9:12 38 36 36 42 44 44 36 18.16.070 RESIDENTIAL GARAGES Attached residential garages shall not obscure the entrance to the dwelling. Attached garages are required to be clearly subordinate to the dwelling. A subordinate garage has two or more of the following characteristics: A. The principal facade of the dwelling has been emphasized through the use of architectural features such as, but not limited to, porches, fenestration treatment, architectural details, height, orientation or gables, so that the non-garage portion of the residence is visually dominant; B. The facade with the garage vehicle entrance(s) is recessed at least 4 feet behind the facade of the dwelling containing the main entry; and/or C. The area of the garage vehicle door(s) comprise 30 percent or less of the total square footage, exclusive of any exposed roof areas, of the principal facade of the dwelling. Principal façade shall include all wall areas parallel to the garage door(s). Alternative means of addressing the intent of this section will be considered. Detached garages are encouraged when they are compatible with the existing neighborhood development pattern. Vehicular garage access on non-principal facades and/or alleys is also encouraged. 18.16.080 ADDITIONAL RMH DISTRICT PERFORMANCE STANDARDS Development of any parcel of land within the RMH district shall be subject to all applicable requirements of Chapter 18.40, BMC, Standards for Specific Uses and Chapter 18.42, BMC, Development Standards, including, but not limited to, fences, parking, signs, landscaping and home 69 Ordinance # 1761. page 16-8 occupations. In addition, manufactured home communities will be subject to the following general requirements: A. Minimum Area for Manufactured Home Community District. 1. The minimum total RMH district area shall be no less than 10 acres unless the applicant can show that the minimum area requirements should be waived because the waiver would be in the public interest and that one or both of the following conditions exist: a. Unusual physical features of the property itself or of the surrounding area such that development under the standard provisions of this title would not be appropriate in order to conserve a physical or terrain feature of importance to the neighborhood or community; or b. The property is adjacent to or across the street from property which has been developed under the provisions of this section and will contribute to the amenities of the area. 2. Waiver of the 10 acre minimum may only be granted by the City Commission. 70 Ordinance # 1761. page 18-1 CHAPTER 18.18 COMMERCIAL ZONING DISTRICTS 18.18.010 INTENT AND PURPOSE OF COMMERCIAL ZONING DISTRICTS The intent and purposes of the commercial zoning districts are to establish areas within Bozeman that are primarily commercial in character and to set forth certain minimum standards for development within those areas. The purpose in having more than one commercial district is to provide opportunities for a variety of employment and community service opportunities within the community, while providing predictability. There is a rebuttable presumption that the uses set forth for each district will be compatible with each other both within the individual districts and to adjoining zoning districts when the standards of this title are met and any applicable conditions of approval have been satisfied. Additional requirements for development apply within overlay districts. A. The intent of the B-1 neighborhood business district is to provide for smaller scale retail and service activities frequently required by neighborhood residents on a day to day basis, as well as residential development as a secondary purpose, while still maintaining compatibility with adjacent residential land uses. Development scale and pedestrian orientation are important elements of this district. B. The intent of the B-2 community business district is to provide for a broad range of mutually supportive retail and service functions located in clustered areas bordered on one or more sides by limited access arterial streets. C. The intent of the B-3 central business district is to provide a central area for the community’s business, government service and cultural activities. Uses within this district should be appropriate to such a focal center with inappropriate uses being excluded. Room should be provided in appropriate areas for logical and planned expansion of the present district. 1. It is the intent of this district to encourage high volume, pedestrian-oriented uses in ground floor space in the “core area” of Bozeman’s central business district, i.e., along Main Street from Grand to Rouse and to the alleys one-half block north and south from Main Street. Lower volume pedestrian uses such as professional offices may locate on ground floor space in the B-3 area outside the above defined core. 18.18.020 AUTHORIZED USES A. Uses in the various commercial districts are depicted in the table below. Principal uses are indicated with a “P”, conditional uses are indicated with a “C”, accessory uses are indicated with an “A”, and uses which are not permitted within the district are indicated by a “-”. A particular proposed development or use may fall under more than one listed category with different review processes. In such cases, the more stringent review process shall apply. B. The uses listed are deliberately broad and some are given special definitions in Chapter 18.80, BMC. The intent of this method is to provide general guidance for uses while allowing the unique needs and circumstances of each proposal to be specifically addressed through the review process. Some uses are the subject of special regulations contained in Chapter 18.40, BMC. C. Additional uses for telecommunications are established in Chapter 18.54, BMC. 71 Ordinance # 1761. page 18-2 Table 18-1 Table of Commercial Uses Authorized Uses B-1 B-2 B-3 Ambulance service - P P Apartments and Apartment buildings6, as defined in this title P P 1/C P 3 Arts and entertainment center, as defined in this title P P P Assisted living/elderly care facilities - C - Automobile fuel sales or repair, as defined in this title C C C Automobile parking lot or garage (public or private) P P P Automobile washing establishment C P C Banks and other financial institutions P P P Business, technical or vocational school - C P 3 Bus terminals - C C Community centers P P P 3 Convenience uses C P C Convenience use restaurant P P P Day care centers P P P Essential services (Type I) P P P Essential services (Type II) - CP CP Extended- stay lodgings - P P Food processing facilities - C - Frozen food storage and locker rental - P - Health and exercise establishments P 1/C P P Hospitals - P C Hotel or motel - P P Laboratories, research and diagnostic - P P 3 Laundry, dry cleaning - C C Light goods repair, as defined in this title - C -A Lodging houses - C C 3 Manufacturing, light and completely indoors - C - Mortuary - C C 72 Ordinance # 1761. page 18-3 Table of Commercial Uses Authorized Uses B-1 B-2 B-3 Museum - C C Medical and dental clinics P 1/C P P Meeting hall - P P Offices, as defined in this title P 1/C P P 3 Other buildings and structures typically accessory to permitted uses A A A Parking facilities P P P3 Personal and convenience services, as defined in this title P P P Pet grooming shop P P P Printing offices and publishing establishments - - C Private club, fraternity, sorority or lodge - P P Public buildings P P P Refuse and recycling containers A A A Research laboratories - P P Restaurants P5 P P Retail uses, as defined in this title P 2 P 2 P 2 Retail, large scale - P - Sales of alcohol for on-premise consumption7, C C C Sign paint shops (not including neon sign fabrication) - P C Upholstery shops (excluding on site upholstery service for cars, boats, trailers, trucks and other motorized vehicles requiring overnight storage) - P P 3 Veterinary clinic - C - Wholesale distributors with on-premise retail outlets, providing warehousing is limited to commodities which are sold on the premises - C - Wholesale establishments that use samples, but do not stock on premises - P P Any use, except adult businesses and casinos approved as part of a planned unit development subject to the provisions of Chapter 18.36, BMC C C C Notes: 1When located on the second or subsequent floor, or basement as defined in Chapter 18.80, BMC. 2Excluding adult businesses, and large scale retail, as they are defined in Chapter 18.80, BMC. 3Except on ground floor in the core area as defined in this chapter. 4Private arts instruction shall only be on the second or subsequent floor in the core area as defined in this chapter. 5Exclusive of drive-ins. 73 Ordinance # 1761. page 18-4 6May be subject to the provisions of Chapter 17.02, BMC 7Also subject to Chapter 5.12, BMC. 18.18.030 LOT COVERAGE AND FLOOR AREA A. In the B-1, B-2 and B-3 districts, the entire lot, exclusive of required yards and parking, may be occupied by the principal and accessory buildings. This title provides opportunities for parking requirements to be met by shared and off-site parking as allowed by Chapter 18.46, BMC. B. In the B-1 district, the footprint of individual buildings shall not exceed 5,000 square feet. C. Minimum floor area requirements for each dwelling in all districts shall be that area required by the City’s adopted International Building Code. 18.18.040 LOT AREA AND WIDTH A. All newly created lots shall have a minimum area adequate to provide for required yards and parking but in no case shall they be less than: 1. B-1 - 5,000 square feet 2. B-2 - No minimum size 3. B-3 - No minimum size B. Lot width for all newly created lots shall not be less than: 1. B-1 - 50 feet 2. B-2 - 100 feet, except in Conservation Overlay District shall have no minimum width 3. B-3 - No minimum width C. When new lots are created utilizing the modular lotting provisions of §18.42.030, BMC, they shall be developed in combination adequate to meet the width and area requirements of subsections B.1 through 3. 18.18.050 YARDS A. Minimum yards required for the B-1 and B-2 districts are: 1. Buildings: Front yard – 7 feet, except along arterials where minimum is 25 feet Rear yard – 10 feet Side yards – 5 feet (except zero lot lines as allowed by §18.38.060, BMC) 2. Parking and loading areas: Front yard – 25 feet Rear yard – 10 feet1 Side yards – 8 feet1 1Side and rear yards for parking may be allowed to be 0 feet when coordinated parking arrangements between adjacent properties is provided. 3. The purpose of differentiated yard setback requirements is to encourage the placement and development of buildings in a manner to address the street and adjacent pedestrian activity and encourage a vigorous and diverse streetscape. 4. All vehicle entrances into garages shall be no closer than 20 feet to a property line, unless explicitly authorized otherwise under this title. 5. Rear and side yards adjacent to alleys shall be at least five feet. 74 Ordinance # 1761. page 18-5 B. Minimum yards required for the B-3 district are: 1. No minimum yards prescribed for the B-3 district except a 7-foot front yard shall be required on Mendenhall and Babcock Streets. 2. Where at least 50 percent of a block (from cross-street to cross-street) in the B-3 district is presently used for residential purposes the minimum yards established in Section 18.18.050.A shall be required. 3. Rear and side yards adjacent to alleys shall be at least five feet. C. All yards shall be subject to the provisions of §18.30.060, §18.38.060, §18.42.100, §18.44.100, and §18.48.100 BMC, when applicable. 18.18.060 BUILDING HEIGHT Maximum building height for each commercial district shall be as follows: A. In the B-1 district: 1. Roof pitch less than 3:12 – 34 feet 2. Roof pitch 3:12 or greater – 38 feet B. In the B-2 district: 1. Roof pitch less than 3:12 – 38 feet 2. Roof pitch 3:12 or greater – 44 feet 3. Maximum height allowed by 1 and 2 above may be increased by up to a maximum of 50 percent when the B-2 zoning district is implementing a Regional Commercial and Services growth policy land use designation. 4. Maximum height otherwise cumulatively allowed by this section may be increased by 30 percent through the approval of a conditional use permit, but only when the additional height is a specifically identified purpose of the review. C. In the B-3 district: 1. In the B-3 district core area – 55 feet 2. In the B-3 district outside of the core area – 70 feet D. In all districts, all commercial floor space provided on the ground floor of a building shall have a minimum floor-to-ceiling height of 12 feet. 75 Ordinance # 1761. page 20-1 CHAPTER 18.20 INDUSTRIAL ZONING DISTRICTS 18.20.010 INTENT AND PURPOSE OF INDUSTRIAL ZONING DISTRICTS The intent and purposes of the industrial zoning districts is to establish areas within Bozeman that are primarily industrial in character and to set forth certain minimum standards for development within those areas. The purpose in having more than one industrial district is to provide opportunities for a variety of employment and community service functions within the community while providing predictability. There is a rebuttable presumption that the uses set forth for each district will be compatible with each other when the standards of this title are met and any applicable conditions of approval have been satisfied. Additional requirements for development apply within overlay districts. A. The intent of the M-1 light manufacturing district is to provide for the community’s needs for wholesale trade, storage and warehousing, trucking and transportation terminals, light manufacturing and similar activities. The district should be oriented to major transportation facilities yet arranged to minimize adverse effects on residential development, therefore, some type of screening may be necessary. B. The intent of the M-2 manufacturing and industrial district is to provide for heavy manufacturing and industrial uses, servicing vocational and employment needs of Bozeman residents. C. The intent of the B-P business park district is to provide for high quality settings and facilities for the development of a variety of compatible employment opportunities. These areas should be developed so as to recognize the impact on surrounding or adjacent development and contribute to the overall image of the community. Compatibility with adjacent land uses and zoning is required. 18.20.020 AUTHORIZED USES A. Uses in the various industrial districts are depicted in the table below. Principal uses are indicated with a “P”, conditional uses are indicated with a “C”, accessory uses are indicated with an “A”, and uses which are not permitted with the district are indicated by a “-”. A particular proposed development may fall under more than one listed category with different review processes. In such cases, the more stringent review process shall apply. B. The uses listed are deliberately broad and are defined in Chapter 18.80, BMC. The intent of this method is to provide general guidance for uses while allowing the unique needs and circumstances of each proposal to be specifically addressed through the review process. Some uses are the subject of special regulations contained in Chapter 18.40, BMC. C. Additional telecommunication uses are established in Chapter 18.54, BMC. Table 20-1 Table of Industrial Uses Permitted Uses BP M-1 M-2 Adult business1 - P1 P1 Ambulance service - P P Amusement and recreational facilities - P C 76 Ordinance # 1761. page 20-2 Table of Industrial Uses Permitted Uses BP M-1 M-2 Animal shelters - C C Automobile, boat or recreational vehicle sales, service and/or rental - P P Automobile fuel sale or repair, as defined in this title - P P Automobile parking lot or garage (public or private) P/A2 P/A2 P/A2 Automobile washing establishment - P P Banks and other financial institutions C P C Building Materials – P P Community center, as defined in this title P P P Day care center C/A3 C/A3 C/A3 Food processing facility - P P Essential services (Type I) P P P Essential services (Type II) CP CP P Fences A A A Health and exercise establishments C P P Hospitals P - - Hotel or motel - P P Junk salvage or automobile reduction/salvage yards - - C Laboratories, research and diagnostic P P P Light goods repair, as defined in this title - P P Manufacturing, light P4 P4 P Manufacturing or industrial uses of all types if in compliance with all provisions of this title unless otherwise stated in this section. - - P Medical clinics P P P Offices, as defined in this title P5 P P Other buildings and structures typically accessory to permitted uses A A A Outside storage -/A6 P/A6 P/A6 Personal and convenience services, as defined in this title - C C Personnel service facilities providing services, education, food and convenience goods primarily for those personnel employed in the principal use A A A Production manufacturing and generation facilities (electric and gas) - - C Public buildings P P P 77 Ordinance # 1761. page 20-3 Table of Industrial Uses Permitted Uses BP M-1 M-2 Retail sales of goods produced or warehoused on site and related products, not to exceed 20 percent of gross floor area or 10,000 square feet, whichever is less A A A Residential use which is clearly accessory to the operation of a permitted principal or conditional use7, 11 - A7, 11 A7, 11 Restaurant8 - P8 P8 Restaurants serving alcoholic beverages9 - C9 C9 Refuse and recycling containers A A A Retail establishments other than principal uses listed in this section - C C Signs10 A A A Solid waste transfer station - - C Temporary buildings and yards incidental to on-going construction work A A A Truck, bus and rail terminal facilities - P P Truck repair, washing, and fueling facilities - C P Technology research establishments P P P Trade schools - P P Veterinary clinics P P P Warehousing - P P Warehousing, residential storage (mini warehousing) - P P Any use, except casinos and retail, large scale, approved as part of a planned unit development subject to the provisions of Chapter 18.36, BMC C C C 1Subject to the requirements of §18.40, BMC. 2As required by this title and meeting the standards of this title. 3If primarily offering services to a single business or group of businesses within the same building or building complex. 4Completely enclosed within a building. 5Professional and business offices only. 6Only if accessory to a principal use and if screened from the street and surrounding properties by a solid fence or dense plantings at least 6 feet in height. 7For the purposes of this section, accessory means less than 50 percent of gross floor area of a building, and being generally located on the second or subsequent floor. 8Occupying not more than 20 percent of the gross floor area of a building or 1,500 square feet, whichever is less, or occupying not more than 45 percent of the gross floor area of a food processing facility. 9Limited to state beer and wine licenses issued since 1997, prohibiting any form of gambling and occupying not more than 45 percent of the total building area of a food processing facility. 10Subject to the requirements of Chapter 18.52, BMC. 11May be subject to the provisions of Chapter 17.02, BMC 78 Ordinance # 1761. page 20-4 18.20.030 LOT COVERAGE AND FLOOR AREA A. In the M-1 and M-2 districts, the entire lot, exclusive of required yards and parking, may be occupied by the principal and accessory buildings. This title provides opportunities for parking requirements to be met by shared and off-site parking as allowed by Chapter 18.46, BMC. B. In the B-P district, not more than 60 percent of the total lot area shall be occupied by impervious surfaces. The remaining 40 percent of the total lot area shall be landscaped as defined in this title. C. Minimum floor area requirements for each dwelling in all districts shall be that area required by the City’s adopted International Building Code. 18.20.040 LOT AREA AND WIDTH A. All newly created lots shall have a minimum area adequate to provide for required yards and parking but in no case shall they be less than: 1. In the M-1 district - 7,500 square feet 2. In the M-2 district - No minimum area 3. In the B-P district - 43,560 square feet B. Lot width for all newly created lots shall not be less than: 1. In the M-1 district - 75 feet 2. In the M-2 district - 100 feet 3. In the B-P district - 150 feet C. When new lots are created utilizing the modular lotting provisions of §18.42.030, BMC, they shall be developed in combination adequate to meet the width and area requirements of this section. 18.20.050 YARDS A. Minimum yards required for the M-1 and M-2 districts are: 1. Structures (unless otherwise permitted by this title): a. Front yard – 20 feet b. Rear yard – 3 feet c. Side yards – 3 feet (except zero lot lines as allowed by §18.38.060, BMC) 2. Parking and loading areas: a. Front yard – 20 feet b. Rear yard – 0 feet c. Side yards – 0 feet 3. Rear and side yards adjacent to alleys shall be at least five feet. B. Minimum yards required for the B-P district are: 1. Front yard – 25 feet 2. Rear yard – 20 feet 3. Side yards – 15 feet (except zero lot lines as allowed by section §18.38.060, BMC) 4. All yards fronting on public or private streets shall be a minimum of 25 feet. Front, rear and side yard requirements shall be increased 3 feet for each additional 5,000 square feet 79 Ordinance # 1761. page 20-5 over a total gross footprint area of 25,000 square feet, up to maximum requirement of 40 feet for rear and side yards and 50 feet for front yards. 5. Rear and side yards adjacent to alleys shall be at least five feet. C. All yards shall be subject to the provisions of §18.30.060, §18.38.060, §18.42.100, §18.44.100, and §18.48.100 BMC, when applicable. 18.20.060 BUILDING HEIGHT Maximum building height for each industrial district shall be as follows: A. In the M-1 and M-2 districts – 45 feet B. In the B-P district: 1. Roof pitch less than 3:12 – 38 feet 2. Roof pitch 3:12 or greater – 44 feet 3. Maximum height otherwise allowed by 1 and 2 above may be increased by up to a maximum of 50 percent when the B-P zoning district is implementing a Regional Commercial and Services growth policy land use designation. 4. Maximum height otherwise cumulatively allowed by this section may be increased by 30 percent through the approval of a conditional use permit, but only when the additional height is a specifically identified purpose of the review. 80 Ordinance # 1761. page 28-1 CHAPTER 18.28 NEIGHBORHOOD CONSERVATION OVERLAY DISTRICT 18.28.010 INTENT AND PURPOSE A. All new construction, alterations to existing structures, movement of structures into or out of the neighborhood conservation overlay district, hereinafter referred to as the conservation district, or demolition of structures by any means or process will be subject to design review. The recommendations of the Design Review Board or Administrative Design Review staff shall be given careful consideration in the final action of the Planning Director or City Commission. B. This chapter defines and sets forth standards which apply to the conservation district. C. The intent and purpose of the conservation district designation is to stimulate the restoration and rehabilitation of structures, and all other elements contributing to the character and fabric of established residential neighborhoods and commercial or industrial areas. New construction will be invited and encouraged provided primary emphasis is given to the preservation of existing buildings and further provided the design of such new space enhances and contributes to the aesthetic character and function of the property and the surrounding neighborhood or area. Contemporary design will be encouraged, provided it is in keeping with the above-stated criteria, as an acknowledged fact of the continuing developmental pattern of a dynamic, changing community. The neighboring community shall be provided notice and opportunity to comment upon the proposed property improvements in accordance with Chapter 18.76, BMC. In addition, aggrieved persons shall have the right to appeal any design review decision made under the provisions of this chapter, in accordance with Chapter 18.66, BMC. D. In view of the fact that most of the area included within the boundaries of the conservation district was developed and built out prior to the adoption of zoning and contemporary subdivision regulations, the construction, development pattern and range of uses is highly diverse and frequently may not be in compliance with conventional regulatory requirements. This chapter recognizes that this diversity is a major contributing element of the historic character of these neighborhoods or areas. The provisions of this chapter shall be applied in a manner that will encourage the protection and enhancement of the many diverse features for future generations. E. The conservation district boundary is largely coterminous with the area surveyed in the effort that led to the listing of nine historic districts and 40 additional landmark structures in the National Register of Historic Places, and includes the nine designated historic districts and 40 individual landmarks. This chapter sets forth the means of protecting and enhancing the conservation district. F. It is further the purpose of the conservation district designation to protect and enhance neighborhoods or areas of significant land planning or architectural character, historic landmarks or other built or natural features for the educational, cultural, economic benefit or enjoyment of Bozeman citizens. It will be the policy and responsibility of the administrative entities of this chapter to: 1. Protect, preserve, enhance and regulate structures, archaeological or cultural sites, and areas that: a. Are reminders of past eras, events or persons important in local, state or national history; b. Provide significant examples of land planning or architectural styles, or are landmarks in the history of land planning and architecture; 81 Ordinance # 1761. page 28-2 c. Are unique or irreplaceable assets to the City and its neighborhoods; d. Provide examples of physical surroundings in which past generations lived; or e. Represent and express the unique characteristics of small agricultural-based, western city developmental patterns; 2. Enhance property values through the stabilization of neighborhoods and areas of the City, increase economic and financial benefits to the City and its inhabitants, and promote tourist trade and interests; 3. Develop and maintain the appropriate environment for buildings, structures, sites and areas, that reflect varied planning and architectural styles and distinguished phases of Bozeman’s history and prehistory; 4. Stimulate an enhancement of human life by developing educational and cultural dimensions, which foster the knowledge of Bozeman’s heritage, and cultivate civic pride in the accomplishments of the past; 5. Seek to maintain and enhance the many private and public elements that are unique to the fabric, theme and character of each neighborhood and area, including but not limited to: lighting, pathways, street trees, natural areas and other features that may, from time to time, be identified by the citizens and property owners of neighborhoods, areas and subsections thereof; and 6. Provide the neighboring community with notice and opportunity to comment upon the proposed property improvements in accordance with Chapter 18.76, BMC, with the exception of certain sketch plan applications with potentially little neighborhood impact, and to further provide aggrieved persons with the right to appeal review decisions made under the provisions of this chapter, in accordance with Chapter 18.66, BMC. 18.28.020 DESIGN REVIEW BOARD AND ADMINISTRATIVE DESIGN REVIEW STAFF POWERS AND DUTIES WITHIN CONSERVATION DISTRICTS It is intended that the Design Review Board and Administrative Design Review staff will review and make recommendations to the City Commission or Planning Director regarding development within the neighborhood conservation district in order to maintain the underlying and desirable characteristics of structures and areas within such districts, while recognizing the need for innovation and individual expression in the development of these districts. In carrying out this mission, in addition to the duties established in Chapter 18.62, BMC, the Design Review Board and Administrative Design Review staff shall have the duty to review any tax abatement or other incentive programs being considered by the City Commission that are designed to stimulate preservation and rehabilitation of structures and properties, and to review any proposed action or development utilizing these abatement or incentive programs. 18.28.030 CONSERVATION DISTRICT DESIGNATION OR RECISION A site, structure, object, area or district may be designated or rescinded as a landmark, or added to or removed from the conservation district by the City Commission upon recommendation of the Historic Preservation Advisory Board subject to the provisions of Chapter 2.80, BMC, Historic Preservation Advisory Board, and Chapters 18.68 and 18.70, BMC, Text Amendments and Zoning Map Amendments. Property owner concurrence is necessary for the designation or recision of landmark status. 18.28.040 CERTIFICATE OF APPROPRIATENESS A certificate of appropriateness, received from either the Planning Director or the City Commission after recommendation by the Administrative Design Review staff or Design Review Board, shall be 82 Ordinance # 1761. page 28-3 required before any and all alteration(s) other than repair as defined in Chapter 18.80, are undertaken upon any structure in the conservation district. For alterations not requiring City Commission approval, compliance with the Planning Director’s decisions will be mandatory subject to appeal to the City Commission as set forth in Chapter 18.66, BMC. The Montana Historical and Architectural Inventory Form shall be reviewed and, if necessary, updated by the historic preservation staff to reflect current conditions on the site, prior to the review of the proposal. Application procedures are as follows: A. No building, demolition, conditional use, sign or moving permit shall be issued within the conservation district until a certificate of appropriateness has been issued by the appropriate review authority, and until final action on the proposal has been taken. B. Application, review and public notice procedures for proposals located within the conservation district are set forth in Chapter 18.34, BMC, Review Procedures for Site Development, Chapter 18.62, BMC, Development Review Committee, Design Review Board, Administrative Design Review and Wetlands Review Board and Chapter 18.76, BMC, Noticing. If the demolition or movement of structures or sites subject to the conservation district requirements is proposed, the procedures in §18.28.080, BMC shall apply. C. A denial of a certificate of appropriateness shall be accompanied by a written statement of reasons for the denial. D. The architectural designs of individual workforce housing units used to satisfy the requirements of Section 17.02.030, BMC and meeting the requirements of Section 17.02.060.A.13, BMC are exempt from the review requirements of this chapter. This exemption does not extend to removal or alterations of existing structures. 18.28.050 STANDARDS FOR CERTIFICATES OF APPROPRIATENESS A. All work performed in completion of an approved certificate of appropriateness shall be in conformance with the most recent edition of the Secretary of Interior’s Standards for the Treatment of Historic Properties with Guidelines for Preserving, Rehabilitating, Restoring and Reconstructing Historic Buildings (Published 1995), published by U.S. Department of the Interior, National Park Service, Cultural Resource Stewardship and Partnerships, Heritage Preservation Services, Washington, D.C. (available for review at the Planning Department). B. Architectural appearance design guidelines used to consider the appropriateness and compatibility of proposed alterations with original design features of subject structures, or properties and with neighboring structures and properties, shall focus upon the following: l. Height; 2. Proportions of doors and windows; 3. Relationship of building masses and spaces; 4. Roof shape; 5. Scale; 6. Directional expression, with regard to the dominant horizontal or vertical expression of surrounding structures; 7. Architectural details; 8. Concealment of nonperiod appurtenances, such as mechanical equipment; and 9. Materials and color schemes (any requirements or conditions imposed regarding color schemes shall be limited to the prevention of nuisances upon abutting properties and prevention of degradation of features on the property in question. Color schemes may be considered as primary design elements if a deviation from the underlying zoning is requested). 83 Ordinance # 1761. page 28-4 C. Contemporary, nonperiod and innovative design of new structures and additions to existing structures shall be encouraged when such new construction or additions do not destroy significant historical, cultural or architectural structures or their components and when such design is compatible with the foregoing elements of the structure and surrounding structures. D. When applying the standards of subsections A-C, the review authority shall be guided by the Design Guidelines for the Neighborhood Conservation Overlay District which are hereby incorporated by this reference. Application of the Design Guidelines may vary by property as explained in the Introduction to the Design Guidelines. When reviewing a contemporary, non- period, or innovative design of new structures or addition to existing structure, the review authority shall be guided by the Design Guidelines for the Neighborhood Conservation Overlay District to determine whether the proposal is compatible with any existing or surrounding structures. E. Conformance with other applicable development standards of this title. F. Tax abatement Certificate of Appropriateness applications are also reviewed with the procedures and standards established in Chapter 3.30, BMC. 18.28.060 APPLICATION REQUIREMENTS FOR CERTIFICATES OF APPROPRIATENESS IN CONSERVATION DISTRICTS Applications for certificates of appropriateness shall be made in conjunction with applications for site plan approval in accordance with Chapter 18.34, BMC of this title. Where development projects in the conservation district require only sketch plan review as per Chapter 18.34, BMC (i.e. single-household, two-household, three-household and four-household residential structures, each on individual lots; signs; fences; property alterations; and certain amendments to site plans), applications for certificates of appropriateness shall be made on a form provided by the Planning Department, and shall include the information and material as set forth in Chapter 18.78, BMC. 18.28.070 DEVIATIONS FROM UNDERLYING ZONING REQUIREMENTS Because the development of much of historic Bozeman preceded zoning, subdivision and construction regulations, many buildings within the conservation district do not conform to contemporary zoning standards. In order to encourage restoration and rehabilitation activity that would contribute to the overall historic character of the community, deviations from underlying zoning requirements may be granted by the City Commission after considering the recommendations of the Design Review Board or Administrative Design Review staff. The criteria for granting deviations from the underlying zoning requirements are: A. Modifications shall be more historically appropriate for the building and site in question and the adjacent properties, as determined by the standards in §18.28.050 of this chapter, than would be achieved under a literal enforcement of this title; B. Modifications will have minimal adverse effect on abutting properties or the permitted uses thereof; and C. Modifications shall assure the protection of the public health, safety and general welfare. Approvals may be conditioned to assure such protection, and such conditions may include a time period within which alterations will be completed; landscaping and maintenance thereof; architectural, site plan and landscape design modifications; or any other conditions in conformity with the intent and purpose set forth in this chapter. 84 Ordinance # 1761. page 28-5 18.28.080 DEMOLITION OR MOVEMENT OF STRUCTURES OR SITES WITHIN THE CONSERVATION DISTRICT The demolition or movement of any structure or site within the conservation district shall be subject to the provisions of this chapter and section. The review procedures and criteria for the demolition or movement of any structure or site within the conservation district are as follows: A. Applications for the demolition or movement of structures within the conservation district will not be accepted without a complete submittal for the subsequent development or treatment of the site after the demolition or movement has occurred. The subsequent development or treatment must be approved before a demolition or moving permit may be issued. B. The demolition or movement of conservation district principal and accessory structures or sites, which are designated as intrusive or neutral elements by the Montana Historical and Architectural Inventory, and are not within recognized historic districts or in other ways listed on the National Register of Historic Places, shall be subject to approval by the Planning Director after review and recommendation of Administrative Design Review staff or Design Review Board as per Chapters 18.34 and 18.62, BMC, and the standards outlined in §18.28.050, BMC. The Montana Historical and Architectural Inventory Form shall be reviewed and, if necessary, updated by the Hhistoric Ppreservation Plannerstaff to reflect current conditions on the site, prior to the review of the demolition or movement proposal. The final approval authority for the demolition or movement of structures or sites described within this section shall rest with the City Commission when proposed in conjunction with a deviation, variance, conditional use permit or planned unit development application. C. The demolition or movement of conservation district principal and accessory structures or sites, which are designated as contributing elements by the Montana Historical and Architectural Inventory, and all properties within historic districts and all landmarks, shall be subject to approval by the City Commission, through a public hearing. Notice of the public hearing before the City Commission shall be provided in accordance with Chapter 18.76, BMC. Prior to holding the public hearing, the City Commission shall receive a recommendation from Administrative Design Review staff and the Design Review Board. The Montana Historical and Architectural Inventory Form shall be reviewed and, if necessary, updated by the Hhistoric Ppreservation Planner staff to reflect current conditions on the site, prior to the review of the demolition or movement proposal. The final approval authority for the demolition or movement of structures or sites described within this section shall rest with the City Commission. The City Commission shall base its decision on the following: 1. The standards in §18.28.050, BMC and the architectural, social, cultural and historical importance of the structure or site and their relationship to the district as determined by the State Historic Preservation Office and the Planning Department. 2. If the Commission finds that the criteria of this section are not satisfied, then, before approving an application to demolish or remove, the Commission must find that at least one of the following factors apply based on definitive evidence supplied by the applicant, including structural analysis and cost estimates indicating the costs of repair and/or rehabilitation versus the costs of demolition and redevelopment: a. The structure or site is a threat to public health or safety, and that no reasonable repairs or alterations will remove such threat; any costs associated with the removal of health or safety threats must exceed the value of the structure. b. The structure or site has no viable economic or useful life remaining. 85 Ordinance # 1761. page 28-6 D. If an application for demolition or moving is denied, issuance of a demolition or moving permit shall be stayed for a period of two years from the date of the final decision in order to allow the applicant and City to explore alternatives to the demolition or move, including but not limited to, the use of tax credits or adaptive reuse. The two year stay may be terminated at any point in time if an alternate proposal is approved or if sufficient additional evidence is presented to otherwise satisfy the requirements of subsection B or C of this section. E. All structures or sites approved for demolition or moving shall be fully documented in a manner acceptable to the Historic Preservation Planner and Administrative Design Review staff prior to the issuance of demolition or moving permits. F. In addition to the remedies in Chapter 18.64, BMC, the owner of any structure or site that is demolished or moved contrary to the provisions of this section, and any contractor performing such work, may be required to reconstruct such structure or site in a design and manner identical to its condition prior to such illegal demolition or move, and in conformance with all applicable codes and regulations. 18.28.090 APPEALS Aggrieved persons, as defined in Chapter 18.80, BMC, may appeal the decision of the Planning Director or City Commission pursuant to the provisions of Chapter 18.66, BMC. In such event, the issuance of a certificate shall be stayed until the appeal process has been satisfied. 86 Ordinance # 1761 page 34-1 CHAPTER 18.34 SITE PLAN REVIEW 18.34.010 INTRODUCTION A. All non-subdivision development proposals within the City will be subject to plan review and approval. Depending on the complexity of development and status of proposed use in the applicable zoning district, either sketch plans, site plans or conditional use permits will be required as specified in this chapter. B. Special development proposals (e.g., PUDs, CUPs, variances, etc.) require other information to be submitted in conjunction with sketch plans or site plans and are subject to requirements specific to the type of proposal. These additional submittal requirements and review procedures are outlined in §18.34.030, BMC. C. When a development is proposed within a neighborhood conservation or entryway corridor overlay district, or proposes signs which do not specifically conform to the requirements of this title, design review is required in conjunction with either sketch plan or site plan review. In such cases, additional submittal requirements and review procedures apply as outlined in §18.78.090, BMC. D. Conditional Uses. Certain uses, while generally not suitable in a particular zoning district, may, under certain circumstances, be acceptable. When such circumstances can be demonstrated by the applicant to exist, a conditional use permit may be granted by the Board of Adjustment. Conditions may be applied to the issuance of the permit and periodic review may be required. No conditional use permit shall be granted for a use which is not specifically designated as a conditional use in this title. E. Approval shall be granted for a particular use and not for a particular person or firm. F. This chapter is provided to meet the purposes of §18.02.040, BMC and all other relevant portions of this title. G. Applications subject to this chapter shall be reviewed under the authority established by Chapter 18.64, BMC. 18.34.020 CLASSIFICATION OF SITE PLANS A. All developments within the City, except individual single-household, two-household, three- household and four-household residential structures, each on individual lots, and other development proposals specifically identified as requiring only sketch plan review, shall be subject to site plan review procedures and criteria of this chapter and the applicable submittal requirements of Chapter 18.78, BMC. For the purposes of this title, site plans will be classified as either a master site plan or a site plan. All developments, as defined in Chapter 18.80, within the City shall be subject to site plan review procedures and criteria of this chapter and the applicable submittal requirements of Chapter 18.78, BMC. For the purposes of this title, site plans will be classified as either a master site plan or a site plan. 1. Exception. Those developments specified in Section 18.34.050, BMC and other development proposals when so specifically identified require only sketch plan review. B. A master site plan is a generalized development plan that establishes building envelopes and overall entitlements for complex, large-scale projects that will require multiple years to reach completion. Use of a master site plan is an option and not required. A master site plan involves one or more of the following: 87 Ordinance # 1761 page 34-2 1. One hundred or more dwelling units in a multiple household structure or structures; 2. Fifty thousand or more square feet of office space, retail commercial space, service commercial space or industrial space; 3. Multiple buildings located on multiple contiguous lots and/or contiguous City blocks; 4. Multiple owners; 5. Development phasing projected to extend beyond two years; or 6. Parking for more than two-hundred vehicles. C. Any planned unit development shall be reviewed according to the regulations in Chapter 18.36, BMC, in addition to this chapter. D. Telecommunication facilities shall be reviewed according to the regulations in Chapter 18.54, BMC, in addition to this chapter. E. Uses identified in Chapter 18.40, BMC shall be reviewed according to the standards and regulations contained in Chapter 18.40, BMC, in addition to this chapter. 18.34.030 SPECIAL DEVELOPMENT PROPOSALS - ADDITIONAL APPLICATION REQUIREMENTS, REVIEW PROCEDURES AND REVIEW CRITERIA A. Application Requirements. Applications for special development proposals (e.g. PUD, CUP, flood plain development permits, variances, etc.) shall include: 1. The required information for site plans described in §18.78.080, BMC; 2. Any additional application information required for specific reviews as listed in the following chapters of this title: a. §18.36, Planned Unit Development; b. §18.40, Standards for Specific Uses; c. §18.54, Telecommunications; d. §18.58, Bozeman Floodplain Regulations; and e. §18.66, Appeals, Deviations and Variance Procedures; B. Review Procedures and Review Criteria. Additional review procedures and review criteria for specific development proposals are defined in the following chapters of this title: 1. §18.34.100, Conditional Use Procedure; 2. §18.36, Planned Unit Development; 3. §18.40, Standards for Specific Uses; 4. §18.54, Telecommunications; 5. §18.58, Bozeman Floodplain Regulations; and 6. §18.66, Appeals, Deviations and Variance Procedures. 18.34.040 REVIEW AUTHORITY A. The City Commission, Board of Adjustment and Planning Director have the review authority established in §18.64.010, BMC. B. The Development Review Committee, Design Review Board, Administrative Design Review Staff, and Wetlands Review Board have the review authority established in Chapter 18.62, BMC. C. Site Plan Design Review Thresholds. When a development is subject to design review and meets one or more of the following thresholds the Design Review Board shall have responsibility for conducting the design review. 88 Ordinance # 1761 page 34-3 1. Twenty or more dwelling units in a multiple household structure or structures; 2. Thirty thousand or more square feet of office space, retail commercial space, service commercial space or industrial space; 3. More than two buildings on one site for permitted office uses, permitted retail commercial uses, permitted service commercial uses, permitted industrial uses or permitted combinations of uses; 4. Twenty thousand or more square feet of exterior storage of materials or goods; or 5. Parking for more than sixty vehicles. 18.34.050 SKETCH PLAN REVIEW A. Sketch Plan Submittal Requirements. 1. Certain independent development proposals (i.e., not in conjunction with other development) are required to submit only sketch plans meeting the requirements of §18.78.110, BMC. 2. Separate construction plans are necessary for building permits when the proposal requires such permits. Additional information is also necessary when the proposal requires the issuance of a certificate of appropriateness (see §18.34.110 and §18.78.090, BMC). 3. Examples of independent projects which qualify for sketch plan review are: individual single-household, two-household, three-household, and four-household residential units, each on individual lots and independent of other site development; accessory dwelling units in the R-2, R-3 and R-4 districts; manufactured homes on individual lots; fences; signs in compliance with the requirements of this title; regulated activities in areas with regulated wetlands not in conjunction with a land development proposal; grading of sites disturbing more than one-eighth but less than one-half acre, or movement of more than 30 but less than 100 cubic yards of material, or cut or fill of less than one cumulative foot, whichever is less; special temporary uses; and accessory structures associated with these uses. Other similar projects may be determined by the Planning Director to require only sketch plan review. The Planning Director shall determine all submittal requirements. Projects which do not require sketch plan review may still require review and permitting for non-zoning issues. B. Sketch Plan Review Procedures. 1. No Certificate of Appropriateness Required. Sketch plans for projects which do not require a certificate of appropriateness shall be submitted to the Planning Department staff for a determination of compliance with the requirements of this title. Once compliance is achieved, the application will be approved for construction or referred to the appropriate permitting authorities. 2. Certificate of Appropriateness Required. Sketch plans, including the material required by §18.78.090, BMC, and such additional information as may be required for projects which require a certificate of appropriateness as per §18.34.110, BMC shall be submitted to the ADR staff, who shall review the proposal for compliance with this title, including compliance with the applicable overlay district requirements. Once compliance is achieved, the application will be approved for construction or referred to the appropriate permitting authorities. Review and approval authority for sketch plans that require certificates of appropriateness shall rest with the DRB if the ADR staff consists of less than two members. 89 Ordinance # 1761 page 34-4 C. Sketch Plan Review Criteria. Sketch plans shall be reviewed for compliance with all applicable requirements of this title including overlay district requirements and the cessation of any current violations of this title, exclusive of any legal nonconforming conditions. Plan changes may be required. 18.34.060 APPLICATION OF SITE PLAN REVIEW PROCEDURES A. These procedures shall apply to all developments within the City except for development proposals specified as requiring only sketch plan review. B. The preliminary site plan shall be submitted and approved, and final site plan approval received, prior to the issuance of any building permit. C. No occupancy permits shall be issued for any development for which site plan review is required until certification has been provided demonstrating that all terms and conditions of site plan approval have been complied with. D. Unless a deviation or variance is explicitly sought and granted in association with a site plan, all standards of this title apply whether explicitly mentioned in the record of the review or not. An omission or oversight of a nonconformity with the standards of this title in the site plan shall not constitute approval of such nonconformance. Any nonconformance which was not the subject of an explicitly approved deviation or variance may be required to be cured at such time the City becomes aware of the nonconforming condition’s existence. E. In the event that the volume of site development applications submitted for review exceeds the ability of the City to process them simultaneously, preference in order of scheduling will be given to those projects which provide the most affordable housing in excess of minimum requirements, as measured by the total number of affordable units. 18.34.070 SITE PLAN REVIEW PROCEDURES A. Acceptability and Adequacy of Application. 1. The Planning Department shall review the application for acceptability within five working days to determine if the application is does not omit any of the submittal elements required by this title. If the application does not contain all of the required elements, the application, review fee and a written explanation of what the application is missing shall be returned to the property owner or their representative. The five working day review period will be considered met if the letter is dated, signed and placed in the outgoing mail within the five day review period. 2. After the application is deemed to contain the required elements and to be acceptable, it shall be reviewed for adequacy. A determination of adequacy means the application contains all of the required elements in sufficient detail and accuracy to enable the applicable review agency to make a determination that the application either does or does not conform to the requirements of this title and any other applicable regulations under the jurisdiction of the City of Bozeman. The review for adequacy shall be conducted by the appropriate agency with expertise in the subject matter. The adequacy review period shall begin on the next working day after the date that the Planning Department determines the application to contain all the required elements and shall be completed within not more than 15 working days. The 15 working day review period will be considered met if the letter is dated, signed and placed in the outgoing mail within the 15 working day review period. If the application is inadequate, a written explanation of why the application is inadequate will be returned to the property owner. Upon a determination of adequacy the review of the development will be scheduled. 90 Ordinance # 1761 page 34-5 a. In the event the missing information is not received by the City within 15 working days of notification to the property owner of inadequacy, all application materials and one-half of the review fee shall be returned to the property owner or their representative. Subsequent resubmittal shall require payment of a review fee as if it were a new application. b. A determination that an application is adequate does not restrict the City from requesting additional information during the site plan review process. 3. Should the property owner choose not to provide the required information after an application has been found unacceptable, nor to accept return of the application and accompanying fee, the application may be processed by the City with the recognition by the property owner that unacceptability is an adequate basis for denial of the application regardless of other merit of the application. 4. The DRC may grant reasonable waivers from submittal of application materials required by these regulations where it is found that these regulations allow a waiver to be requested and granted. If in the opinion of the final approval authority the waived materials are necessary for proper review of the development, the materials shall be provided before review is completed. 5. In order to be granted a waiver the applicant shall include with the submission of the preliminary site plan a written statement describing the requested waiver and the reasons upon which the request is based. The final approval body shall then consider each waiver at the time the preliminary site plan is reviewed. All waivers must be identified not later than initial submittal of the preliminary site plan stage of review. B. Site plans shall be reviewed by the review bodies established by Chapter 18.62, BMC and according to the procedures established by this title. After review of the applicable submittal materials required by Chapter 18.78, BMC, and upon recommendation by the appropriate review bodies, the Planning Director, Board of Adjustment, or City Commission shall act to approve, approve with conditions or deny the application, subject to the appeal provisions of Chapter 18.66, BMC. The basis for the Planning Director’s, Board of Adjustment’s, or City Commission’s action shall be whether the application, including any required conditions, complies with all the applicable standards and requirements of this title, including § 18.02.050, BMC. 1. Site Plan. The Planning Director shall provide an opportunity for the public to comment upon development proposals. The duration of the initial comment period shall be included in any notice required by Chapter 18.76, BMC. The comment period shall be from the date of the first consideration of the complete preliminary plan and supplementary materials by the DRC until 5:00 pm on the third working day after DRC and other review bodies as may be appropriate have taken action regarding the proposal. a. The Planning Director, after receiving the recommendations of the DRC, ADR, DRB or WRB, shall act to approve, approve with conditions or deny an application within ten working days of the close of the public comment period. The Planning Director’s decision shall be in writing and shall include any special conditions which are to be applied to the development. (1) After formal notice of a project review has been given, interested parties may request in writing to receive a copy of the director’s decision regarding an application. Persons making such a request shall provide an addressed envelope for use in delivering their copy of the decision. 2. Site Plan with Deviations or Variances and Conditional Use Permits. The Board of Adjustment shall provide an opportunity for the public to comment upon a proposed 91 Ordinance # 1761 page 34-6 site plan or conditional use permit. The ending date of the comment period shall be included in the notice required by Chapter 18.76, BMC. The comment period shall be from the date of the first consideration of the complete preliminary plan and supplementary materials by the DRC until the decision by the Board of Adjustment. a. The Board of Adjustment, after receiving the recommendations of the DRC, ADR, DRB or WRB, shall act to approve, approve with conditions or deny an application. The Board of Adjustment’s decision shall be in writing and shall include any special conditions which are to be applied to the development. 3. Master Site Plan. The City Commission shall provide an opportunity for the public to comment upon a proposed master site plan. The duration of the comment period shall be included in any notice required by Chapter 18.76, BMC. The comment period shall be from the date of the first consideration of the complete preliminary plan and supplementary materials by the DRC until the decision by the City Commission. a. The City Commission, after receiving the recommendations of the DRC, ADR, DRB or WRB, shall act to approve, approve with conditions or deny an application. The City Commission’s decision shall be in writing and shall include any special conditions which are to be applied to the development. 18.34.080 APPLICATION FOR CONDITIONAL USE PERMIT - NOTICE REQUIREMENTS A. The person applying for a conditional use permit shall fill out and submit to the Planning Director the appropriate form with the required fee. The request for a conditional use permit shall follow the procedures and application requirements of this chapter. B. In consideration of all conditional use permit applications, a public hearing shall be conducted by the Board of Adjustment. Notice of the Board of Adjustment public hearing shall be provided in accordance with Chapter 18.76, BMC. C. If a rezoning is required prior to approval of a conditional use permit, the application for rezoning and the conditional use permit may be filed and acted upon simultaneously, however the conditional use permit shall not be effective until zoning has been approved by the City Commission. 18.34.090 SITE PLAN AND MASTER SITE PLAN REVIEW CRITERIA A. In considering applications for site plan approval under this title, the Planning Director, Board of Adjustment, City Commission, DRC, and when appropriate, the ADR staff, DRB or WRB shall consider the following: 1. Conformance to and consistency with the City’s adopted growth policy. 2. Conformance to this title, including the cessation of any current violations; 3. Conformance with all other applicable laws, ordinances and regulations; 4. Relationship of site plan elements to conditions both on and off the property, including: a. Compatibility with, and sensitivity to, the immediate environment of the site and the adjacent neighborhoods and other approved development relative to architectural design, building mass and height, neighborhood identity, landscaping, historical character, orientation of buildings on the site and visual integration; b. Design and arrangement of the elements of the site plan (e.g., buildings, circulation, open space and landscaping, etc.) so that activities are integrated with the organizational scheme of the community, neighborhood, and other approved 92 Ordinance # 1761 page 34-7 development and produce an efficient, functionally organized and cohesive development; c. Design and arrangement of elements of the site plan (e.g., buildings circulation, open space and landscaping, etc.) in harmony with the existing natural topography, natural water bodies and water courses, existing vegetation, and to contribute to the overall aesthetic quality of the site configuration; and d. If the proposed project is located within a locally designated historical district, or includes a locally designated landmark structure, the project is in conformance with the provisions of Chapter 18.28, BMC; 5. The impact of the proposal on the existing and anticipated traffic and parking conditions; 6. Pedestrian and vehicular ingress, egress and circulation, including: a. Design of the pedestrian and vehicular circulation systems to assure that pedestrians and vehicles can move safely and easily both within the site and between properties and activities within the neighborhood area; b. Non-automotive transportation and circulation systems design features to enhance convenience and safety across parking lots and streets, including, but not limited to, paving patterns, grade differences, landscaping and lighting; c. Adequate connection and integration of the pedestrian and vehicular transportation systems to the systems in adjacent developments and general community; and d. Dedication of right-of-way or easements necessary for streets and similar transportation facilities; 7. Landscaping, including the enhancement of buildings, the appearance of vehicular use, open space and pedestrian areas, and the preservation or replacement of natural vegetation; 8. Open space, including: a. The enhancement of the natural environment; b. Precautions being taken to preserve existing wildlife habitats or natural wildlife feeding areas; c. If the development is adjacent to an existing or approved public park or public open space area, have provisions been made in the site plan to avoid interfering with public access to and use of that area; d. Is any provided recreational area suitably located and accessible to the residential units it is intended to serve and is adequate screening provided to ensure privacy and quiet for neighboring residential uses; e. Open space shall be provided in accordance with Chapter 18.50, BMC; f. Park land shall be provided in accordance with Chapter 18.50, BMC. 9. Building location and height; 10. Setbacks; 11. Lighting; 12. Provisions for utilities, including efficient public services and facilities; 13. Site surface drainage and stormwater control; 93 Ordinance # 1761 page 34-8 14. Loading and unloading areas; 15. Grading; 16. Signage; 17. Screening; 18. Overlay district provisions; 19. Other related matters, including relevant comment from affected parties; and 20. If the development includes multiple lots that are interdependent for circulation or other means of addressing requirements of this title, whether the lots are either: a. Configured so that the sale of individual lots will not alter the approved configuration or use of the property or cause the development to become nonconforming; or b. The subject of reciprocal and perpetual easements or other agreements to which the City is a party so that the sale of individual lots will not cause one or more elements of the development to become nonconforming. 21. Compliance with Title 17 Chapter 2, BMC. B. In considering applications for master site plan approval under this title, the City Commission, DRC, and when appropriate, the ADR staff, DRB or WRB shall consider the following: 1. Conformance to and consistency with the City’s adopted growth policy; 2. Conformance to this title, including the cessation of any current violations; 3. Conformance with all other applicable laws, ordinances and regulations; 4. A generalized site plan showing the orientation and relationships among key plan elements both on and off the property, including: a. Compatibility with, and sensitivity to, the immediate environment of the site and the adjacent neighborhoods in terms of overall site organization and building mass and height; b. Arrangement of the elements of the site plan (e.g., buildings, circulation, open space and landscaping, etc.) so that activities are integrated with the structure of the surrounding area and produce an efficient, functionally organized and visually cohesive development that contributes to the overall aesthetic quality of the area; c. If the proposed project is located within a locally designated historical district, or includes a locally designated landmark structure, a statement describing how the project is in conformance with the provisions of Chapter 18.28, BMC; and d. Description of many elements in a Master Site Plan may be described in written and/or graphic formats whichever provides the superior form of communication. 5. A statement accompanying the site plan describing the generalized architectural character and its relationship to and compatibility with the historical character of the area, generalized landscape concept including treatment of public space and relationship to the surrounding area, and visual and aesthetic integration of the proposed development into the surrounding area and its effect on the identity of the adjacent neighborhood; 6. The impact of the proposed development on the existing and anticipated traffic and parking conditions, including identification of the traffic generation and parking needs of individual plan elements; 94 Ordinance # 1761 page 34-9 7. Pedestrian and vehicular ingress, egress and circulation, including: a. Overall pedestrian and vehicular circulation systems to assure that pedestrians and vehicles can move safely and easily both within the site and between properties and activities within the neighborhood area; b. Non-automotive transportation and circulation systems design features to enhance convenience and safety across parking lots and streets; c. Adequate connection and integration of the pedestrian and vehicular transportation systems to the systems in adjacent developments and general community; and d. Dedication and/or abandonment of rights-of-way or easements necessary for efficient land use and accompanying streets and related transportation facilities; 8. Open space, if required under the zoning classification(s) of the proposed development, including: a. Enhancement of the natural environment; b. Precautions being taken to preserve existing wildlife habitats or natural wildlife feeding areas; c. Provisions to avoid interfering with public access to and use of any adjacent parks and other open space; d. Provision of recreational areas suitably located and configured, and accessible to the residential units it is intended to serve; and e. Adequacy of open space as required within this title; f. Open space shall be provided in accordance with Chapter 18.50, BMC; g. Park land shall be provided in accordance with Chapter 18.50, BMC. 9. Generalized building gross area (square feet), building locations, building envelopes, and building heights; 10. Setbacks; 11. Generalized lighting concept as pertains to public safety; 12. Generalized provisions for utilities, including efficient public services and facilities; 13. Generalized site surface drainage and stormwater control; 14. Generalized locations of loading and unloading areas; 15. Generalized grading; 16. Statement regarding proposed signage; 17. Statement regarding screening of trash, outdoor storage and utility areas; 18. Overlay district provisions where applicable; and 19. Other related matters, including relevant comment from affected parties. C. If the Planning Director, Board of Adjustment, or City Commission, after recommendation from the DRC and, if appropriate, ADR staff, DRB and WRB shall determine that the proposed site plan or master site plan will not be detrimental to the health, safety or welfare of the community, is in compliance with the requirements of this title and is in harmony with the purposes and intent of this title and the Bozeman growth policy, approval shall be granted, and such conditions and safeguards may be imposed as deemed necessary. Notice of action shall be given in writing. 95 Ordinance # 1761 page 34-10 D. Site plan approval or master site plan approval may be denied upon a determination that the conditions required for approval do not exist. Persons objecting to the recommendations of review bodies carry the burden of proof. A denial of approval shall be in writing. E. Following approval of a master site plan, the applicant shall submit to the Planning Department, sequential individual site plans for specific areas within the master site plan. Each subsequent application for a site plan shall be consistent with the approved master site plan and subject to the review criteria set forth in subsection A above. Evidence that the review criteria have been met through the master site plan review process may be incorporated by reference in order to eliminate duplication of review. 18.34.100 BOARD OF ADJUSTMENT CONSIDERATION AND RECORD FOR CONDITIONAL USE PERMITS A. The Board of Adjustment, in approving a conditional use permit, shall review the application against the review requirements of §18.34.090, BMC; B. In addition to the review criteria of §18.34.090, BMC, the Board of Adjustment shall, in approving a conditional use permit, determine favorably as follows: 1. That the site for the proposed use is adequate in size and topography to accommodate such use, and all yards, spaces, walls and fences, parking, loading and landscaping are adequate to properly relate such use with the land and uses in the vicinity; 2. That the proposed use will have no material adverse effect upon the abutting property. Persons objecting to the recommendations of review bodies carry the burden of proof; 3. That any additional conditions stated in the approval are deemed necessary to protect the public health, safety and general welfare. Such conditions may include, but are not limited to: a. Regulation of use; b. Special yards, spaces and buffers; c. Special fences, solid fences and walls; d. Surfacing of parking areas; e. Requiring street, service road or alley dedications and improvements or appropriate bonds; f. Regulation of points of vehicular ingress and egress; g. Regulation of signs; h. Requiring maintenance of the grounds; i. Regulation of noise, vibrations and odors; j. Regulation of hours for certain activities; k. Time period within which the proposed use shall be developed; l. Duration of use; m. Requiring the dedication of access rights; and n. Other such conditions as will make possible the development of the City in an orderly and efficient manner. C. The Board of Adjustment shall, in addition to all other conditions, impose the following general conditions upon every conditional use permit granted: 1. That the right to a use and occupancy permit shall be contingent upon the fulfillment of all general and special conditions imposed by the conditional use permit procedure; and 96 Ordinance # 1761 page 34-11 2. That all of the special conditions shall constitute restrictions running with the land use, shall apply and be adhered to by the owner of the land, successors or assigns, shall be binding upon the owner of the land, his successors or assigns, shall be consented to in writing, and shall be recorded as such with the County Clerk and Recorder’s Office by the property owner prior to the issuance of any building permits, final site plan approval or commencement of the conditional use. D. Applications for conditional use permits may be approved, conditionally approved or denied by motion of the Board of Adjustment. If an application is denied, the denial shall constitute a determination that the applicant has not shown that the conditions required for approval do exist. E. The applicant shall be notified in writing of the action taken by the Board of Adjustment within seven working days of its action. If the conditional use permit has been granted the notification shall include any conditions, automatic termination date, period of review or other requirements. If the conditional use permit has been granted, the permit shall be issued upon the signature of the Planning Director after completion of all conditions and final site plan. F. Termination/ Revocation of Conditional Use Permit approval. 1. Conditional use permits are approved based on an analysis of current local circumstances and regulatory requirements. Over time these things may change and the use may no longer be appropriate to a location. A conditional use permit will be considered as terminated and of no further effect if: a. After having been commenced, the approved use is not actively conducted on the site for a period of two continuous calendar years; b. Final zoning approval to reuse the property for another principal or conditional use is granted; c. The use or development of the site is not begun within the time limits of the final site plan approval in Section 18.34.130, BMC. 2. A conditional use which has terminated may be reestablished on a site by either, the review and approval of a new conditional use permit application, or a determination by the Planning Director that the local circumstances and regulatory requirements are essentially the same as at the time of the original approval. A denial of renewal by the Planning Director may not be appealed. If the Planning Director determines that the conditional use permit may be renewed on a site then any conditions of approval of the original conditional use permit are also renewed. 3. If activity begins for which a conditional use permit has been given final approval, all activities must comply with any conditions of approval or code requirements. Should there be a failure to maintain compliance the City may revoke the approval through the procedures outlined in Section 18.64.160, BMC. 18.34.110 CERTIFICATES OF APPROPRIATENESS - ADDITIONAL REVIEW PROCEDURES AND REVIEW CRITERIA A. Sign Proposals Which Do Not Specifically Conform to the Requirements of This Title. Independent sign proposals (i.e., not in conjunction with other development) which do not specifically conform to the requirements of this title, are required to submit full site plans. Additional site design information, in sufficient detail to demonstrate compliance with the Design Objective Plan, encompassing the property’s location shall be provided. If no Design Objectives Plan has been prepared for the location, additional site design information, if 97 Ordinance # 1761 page 34-12 necessary, shall be determined by the ADR staff. All signs shall comply with the dimensional standards of this title unless a deviation or variance has been properly granted. B. Review Procedures and Criteria for Certificates of Appropriateness. 1. Certificates of appropriateness shall only be issued according to procedures and criteria specified in Chapters 18.28, 18.30, 18.36 and 18.62, BMC. 2. Sign proposals which specifically conform to the requirements of this title shall be reviewed according to procedures and criteria outlined in Chapter 18.52, BMC. 18.34.120 PUBLIC NOTICE REQUIREMENTS A. Public notice of development proposals and approvals subject to this chapter shall be provided as required by Chapter 18.76, BMC. 18.34.130 FINAL SITE PLAN A. No later than six months after the date of approval of a preliminary site plan or master site plan, the applicant shall submit to the Planning Department a final site plan with accompanying application form and review fee. The number of copies of the final site plan to be submitted shall be established by the Planning Director. The final site plan shall contain the materials required in §§18.78.080 and18.78.090 BMC and whatever revisions to the preliminary site plan or master site plan are required to comply with any conditions of approval. Prior to the passage of six months, the applicant may seek an extension of not more than an additional six months from the Planning Director. B. In addition to the materials required in subsection A of this section, the owner shall submit a certification of completion and compliance stating that they understand any conditions of approval and the submitted final site plans or master site plan have complied with any conditions of approval or corrections to comply with code provisions. C. In addition to the materials required in subsections A and B of this section, the owner shall submit a statement of intent to construct according to the final site plan. Such statement shall acknowledge that construction not in compliance with the approved final site plan may result in delays of occupancy or costs to correct noncompliance. D. Following approval of a final site plan, the final site plan shall be in effect for one year. Prior to the passage of one year, the applicant may seek an extension of not more than one additional year from the Planning Director. In such instances, the Planning Director shall determine whether the relevant terms of this title and circumstances have significantly changed since the initial approval. If relevant terms of this title or circumstances have significantly changed, the extension of the approval shall not be granted. E. Following approval of a final master site plan, the final master site plan shall be in effect for not more than five years. Owners of property subject to the master site plan may seek appropriate extensions. Approval of an extension shall be made by the Planning Director. Approval shall be granted if the Planning Director determines that the relevant terms of this title and circumstances have not significantly changed since the initial approval. F. Upon approval of the final site plan by the Planning Director the applicant may obtain a building permit as provided for by Chapter 18.64, BMC. 1. Subsequent site plan approvals are required to implement a master site plan, and approval of a master site plan does not entitle an applicant to obtain any building permits. 98 Ordinance # 1761 page 34-13 18.34.140 BUILDING PERMITS BASED UPON APPROVED SKETCH OR SITE PLANS Based upon the approved sketch or final site plan (hereinafter referred to as “plan”), and after any appeals have been resolved, a building permit for the site may be requested and may be granted pursuant to Chapter 18.64, BMC. No building permit may be granted on the basis of an approved sketch or site plan whose approval has expired. 18.34.150 AMENDMENTS TO SKETCH AND SITE PLANS A. It is the intent of this section to assure that issues of community concern are addressed during the redevelopment, reuse or change in use of existing facilities in the community. Specific areas of community concern include public safety, mitigation of off-site environmental impacts and site character in relation to surroundings. The following procedures for amendments to approved plans, reuse of existing facilities and further development of sites assure that these concerns are adequately and expeditiously addressed. B. Any amendment to or modification of a site plan or master site plan approved under the ordinance codified in this chapter (September 3, 1991 - Ordinance 1332) shall be submitted to the Planning Director for review and possible approval. Proposals for further development, reuse or change in use of sites developed pursuant to this title shall also be reviewed as an amendment to an approved plan. All amendments shall be shown on a revised plan drawing. Amendments to approved plans shall be reviewed and may be approved by the Planning Director upon determining that the amended plan is in substantial compliance with the originally approved plan. If it is determined that the amended plan is not in substantial compliance with the originally approved plan, the application shall be resubmitted as a new application and shall be subject to all standards and site plan review and approval provisions of this title. Substantial compliance may be shown by demonstrating that the amendments do not exceed the thresholds established in §18.34.170.B, BMC. C. Modifications or amendments to a master site plan at the time an extension of approval is sought may be proposed by either the applicant or the City Commission, and shall be based on substantive current information that indicates that relevant circumstances have changed and that such circumstances support the proposed modifications. Such circumstances may include market analyses, economic conditions, changes in surrounding land uses, changes in ownership, etc. 18.34.160 MODIFICATION OR ENLARGEMENT OF STRUCTURES AUTHORIZED UNDER A CONDITIONAL USE PERMIT Any proposed additions, enlargements or modifications of the structures approved in any conditional use permit, or any proposed extension of the use into areas not approved in any such permit, shall be subject to the review procedures of this chapter. 18.34.170 REUSE, CHANGE IN USE OR FURTHER DEVELOPMENT OF SITES DEVELOPED PRIOR TO THE ADOPTION OF THE ORDINANCE CODIFIED IN THIS TITLE A. Sites legally developed prior to the adoption of the ordinance codified in this title (September 3, 1991 - Ordinance 1332) shall be considered to have developed under an approved plan. Proposals for reuse, change in use or the further development of sites legally developed prior to the adoption of the ordinance codified in this title may be approved by the Planning Director upon determining that no significant alteration of the previous use and site are proposed, and upon review by the City Engineer or designee to assure that adequate access and site surface drainage are provided. All such proposals shall be shown on a plan drawing as required by the Planning Director. 99 Ordinance # 1761 page 34-14 B. The criteria for determining that no significant alteration of the previous use and site will result from the proposed reuse, change in use or further development of a site shall include but not be limited to the following: 1. The proposed use is allowed under the same zoning district use classification as the previous use, however replacement of nonconforming uses must comply with the provisions of Chapter 18.60, BMC; 2. Changes proposed for the site, singly or cumulatively, do not increase lot coverage by buildings, storage areas, parking areas or impervious surfaces and/or do not result in an increase in intensity of use as measured by parking requirements, traffic generation or other measurable off-site impacts; a. By more than 20 percent for developments not meeting one or more of the criteria of §18.34.040.C; OR b. By more than 10 percent for developments meeting or exceeding one or more of the criteria of §18.34.040.C; 3. The proposed use does not continue any unsafe or hazardous conditions previously existing on the site or associated with the proposed use of the property. C. If it is determined that the proposed reuse, change in use or further development of a site contains significant alterations to the previous use and/or site, the application shall be resubmitted as a new application and shall be subject to all plan review and approval provisions of this chapter. D. When proposals for reuse, change in use or further development of a site are located in the neighborhood conservation or entryway corridor overlay districts, review by ADR staff or the DRB may be required to determine whether resubmittal as a new application is necessary. 18.34.180 IMPROVEMENTS TO EXISTING DEVELOPED SITES INDEPENDENT OF SITE PLAN REVIEW A. The continued improvement of existing developed sites is desired to increase the level of compliance with the provisions of this title. An applicant may propose improvements, not in association with a site plan review, to increase conformity with the standards of this title for landscaping, lighting, parking or similar components of a site to occur over a defined period of time, not to exceed three years. Such improvements shall be depicted on a site plan drawn to scale and which shall be sufficiently detailed to clearly depict the current conditions, the intended end result of the proposed improvements and any phasing of work. Such improvements shall be reviewed by and approved at the discretion of the Planning Director. The Planning Director may require surety in accordance with the terms of Chapter 18.74, BMC for work performed. 18.34.190 SPECIAL TEMPORARY USE PERMIT A. Generally. Uses permitted subject to a special temporary use permit are those temporary uses which are required for the proper function of the community or are temporarily required in the process of establishing a permitted use, constructing a public facility or providing for response to an emergency. Such uses shall be so conducted that they will not be detrimental in any way to the surrounding properties or to the community. Uses permitted subject to a special temporary use permit may include: 1. Carnivals, circuses, special events of not over seventy-two consecutive hours; 2. Tent revival meetings; 3. Swap meets; or 100 Ordinance # 1761 page 34-15 4. Such other uses as the Planning Director may deem to be within the intent and purpose of this section. B. Application and Filing Fee. Application for a special temporary use permit may be made by a property owner or his authorized agent. A copy of the fees are available at the Planning Department. Such application shall be filed with the Planning Director who shall charge and collect a filing fee for each such application, as provided in Chapter 18.64, BMC. The Planning Director may also require any information deemed necessary to support the approval of a special temporary use permit, including site plans per this chapter. C. Decision. Application for a special temporary use permit shall be reviewed by the Planning Director who shall approve, conditionally approve or disapprove such application. Approval or conditional approval shall be given only when in the judgment of the Planning Director such approval is within the intent and purposes of this chapter. D. Conditions. In approving such a permit, the approval shall be made subject to a time limit and other conditions deemed necessary to assure that there will be no adverse effect upon adjacent properties. Such conditions may include, but are not limited to, the following: 1. Regulation of parking; 2. Regulation of hours; 3. Regulation of noise; 4. Regulation of lights; 5. Requirement of bonds or other guarantees for cleanup or removal of structure or equipment; and/or 6. Such other conditions deemed necessary to carry out the intent and purpose of this section. 18.34.200 APPEALS Appeals of decisions rendered in conjunction with this chapter may be taken as set forth in Chapter 18.66, BMC. In such event, any plan review approval and associated right to proceed with development shall be stayed until the appeal process has been completed. 18.34.210 IMPROVEMENTS Improvements depicted on an approved site plan shall be installed subject to the requirements of Chapter 18.74, BMC. 101 Ordinance 1761 38-1 CHAPTER 18.38 GENERAL LAND USE STANDARDS AND REQUIREMENTS 18.38.010 AREA REQUIREMENTS FOR INDIVIDUAL BUILDINGS - RESTRICTIONS No part of any yard, or other open space, or off-street parking or loading space required about or in connection with any building for the purpose of complying with this title, shall be included as part of a yard, open space or off-street parking or loading space similarly required for any other building except as provided in §18.46.050 of this title. 18.38.020 YARDS AND LOTS - REDUCTION PROHIBITED No yard or lot existing at the time of adoption of the ordinance codified in this title shall be reduced in dimension or area below the minimum requirements of said ordinance except as set forth herein. Yards or lots created after the effective date of said ordinance shall meet at least the minimum requirements established by this title. 18.38.030 USE OF LANDS - BUILDINGS AND STRUCTURES A. Only Uses Specifically Identified by This Title to be Built. No building, or structure or part thereof shall be erected, altered or enlarged for a use, nor shall any existing building, structure or part thereof, or land, be used for a purpose or in a manner that is not in conformity with the uses listed as permitted uses for the zone in which such buildings, structure or land is situated. In addition, any land, building or structure to be erected or used for a purpose listed as a conditional use in such zone shall first receive approval from the City Commission. Existing nonconforming uses and structures shall be governed by Chapter 18.60, BMC. B. No building, or part thereof, or structure shall be erected, nor shall any existing building be altered, enlarged or rebuilt, or moved into any zone, nor shall any open space be encroached upon or reduced in any manner, except in conformity to the yard and setback regulations designed for the zone in which such building or open space is located, except as otherwise specified in this title. C. Recreational Vehicle Parking on Residential Lot. No person shall park or occupy any recreational vehicle or mobile home on the premises of any occupied dwelling or on any lot which is not a part of the premises of any occupied dwelling, either of which is situated outside of any approved manufactured home community or recreational vehicle park except that: 1. The parking of only one unoccupied recreational vehicle in any accessory private garage, or in a rear yard in any district is permitted, providing no living quarters shall be maintained or any business practiced in the recreational vehicle while such recreational vehicle is so parked or stored; and 2. In the event of hardship, temporary use permits may be granted for occupying such recreational vehicle or mobile home. D. Municipal Infrastructure Requirements. 1. Whenever any building lots and/or building sites are created inside the City limits or existing lots are annexed, and prior to the issuance of any building permits on such lots or sites, municipal water distribution, municipal sanitary sewer collection, and streets shall be provided to the site. Each building site must utilize and be connected to both the municipal water distribution and municipal sanitary sewer collection systems. Installation of improvements is subject to Chapter 18.74, BMC. a. Alternative. When in the City’s sole determination it is in the City’s long term best interests to allow a building lot or site to be created or developed without 102 Ordinance 1761 38-2 immediate access to either municipal water or municipal sewer the City may, in its sole discretion, make such allowance when all of the following have been met: (1) The nonmunicipal system(s) to service the lot or site shall be designed, reviewed and constructed to meet City of Bozeman standards. Systems serving more than one lot or user shall be central systems; (2) The nonmunicipal system(s) shall be designed and constructed in a manner to allow connection to the municipal system components shown in applicable facility plans to serve the property at such time as it becomes available; (3) The landowner shall provide waivers of right to protest creation of SIDs or other financing methods to extend municipal water and sewer services. Such extensions or connections may require construction of system components that are not immediately adjacent to the building lot or site; (4) The landowner shall agree to connect to municipal water and sewer services and abandon and remove nonmunicipal services when so instructed by the City. Such agreement shall be binding on all successors and run with the land; (5) If the City takes responsibility to operate the nonmunicipal system(s) it may impose a surcharge to cover extra operational expenses. City operation of the system is at the City’s discretion; (6) The requirement for future connection to the municipal water and/or sewer system, waivers and agreements, and other applicable materials shall be either noted on the plat or final plan OR a separate notice be recorded at the Gallatin County Clerk and Recorder’s Office so that such notice will appear on a title report or abstract of the property; (7) No nonmunicipal water or sewer systems shall be constructed until it has received all necessary approvals from the Department of Environmental Quality, City of Bozeman, County Environmental Health, and any other relevant agency; and (8) The use of municipal water or sewer systems is considered to be the best means to protect the public interest and welfare. The alternative for the use of nonmunicipal systems is intended to be used sparingly and in extraordinary circumstances. In order to protect the public interest, in approving a nonmunicipal system the City may impose such conditions of approval as it deems necessary. 2. These improvements shall be designed, constructed and installed according to the standards and criteria as adopted by the City and approved by both the City Engineer and Water and Sewer Superintendent prior to the issuance of any building permits. 3. When municipal water distribution and municipal sanitary sewer collection systems are being provided to serve a development proposal occurring under the provisions of Chapter 18.36, BMC, Planned Unit Development (PUD), the issuance of a building permit may be allowed prior to completion of the public infrastructure, provided the criteria of §18.74.030, BMC are met. 4. Notwithstanding the provisions of subsection D.3 above, the City may limit the scope, type and number of projects eligible for simultaneous construction consideration. 18.38.040 DWELLING UNIT RESTRICTIONS A. No Use of Unfinished Structures. No cellar, garage, tent, tepee, yurt, basement with unfinished structure above, accessory building, or vehicle; or any manufactured home or recreational vehicle 103 Ordinance 1761 38-3 outside of an approved manufactured home community, recreational vehicle park, or approved individual lot in accordance with §18.40.130, BMC shall at any time be used as a dwelling unit, unless approved for use as a temporary dwelling unit due to a demonstrated hardship. B. Use of Basements. The basement portion of a finished home shall be properly damp-proofed and have heating, ventilation, suitable fire protection and exits if used for living purposes, and natural lighting. 18.38.050 ACCESSORY BUILDINGS, USES AND EQUIPMENT A. An accessory building shall be considered an integral part of the principal building if it is connected to the principal building by a common wall for not less than five feet. B. Accessory buildings, uses or equipment shall not be stored or constructed between the front lot line and required front building line. C. Accessory buildings and garages shall not be located within a utility easement without written approval of the easement holder. D. Accessory buildings in any business or industrial district may be located only to the rear of the front line of the principal building. E. No accessory building shall exceed the footprint of the principal building unless such accessory building has been otherwise approved per this title. An accessory building shall not either: 1. Exceed the height of the principal building unless such accessory building has been otherwise approved per this title; or 2. Within a residential district, exceed a height of one and a half stories, where a half story is established by a side wall, under a sloped roof, of fivethree feet in height or less above the floor level within space allowed to be occupied by persons by the International Building Code. 3. The height between finished floor to finished floor shall not exceed 12 feet in residential districts. A greater height between finished floors may be approved in non-residential districts if the other requirements of this title are met. F. Mechanical Equipment Screening. 1. Rooftop mechanical equipment should be screened. Screening should be incorporated into the roof form when possible. The requirement for screening of rooftop mechanical equipment does not apply to solar or wind energy collection devices. 2. Ground mounted mechanical equipment shall be screened from public rights-of-way with walls, fencing or evergreen plant materials. Mechanical equipment shall not encroach into required setbacks. G. Detached Structures Setback Requirements. 1. Accessory structures less than or equal to 120 square feet in footprint shall not be located in any front, side, or corner-side yard and shall maintain a minimum setback of three feet from the property lines in the rear yard. 2. Accessory structures greater than 120 square feet but less than or equal to 600 square feet in footprint shall not be located in any front, side, or corner-side yard. The accessory structure shall be set back a minimum of either: 6 feet, or when parking is provided between the structure and the rear property line, 20 feet except when required parking spaces need a greater setback for back-up maneuverability. See examples below. 104 Ordinance 1761 38-4 Alley Right-of- Way Width Setback for Garage Setback for a Garage with Stacked Parking Off of an Alley 30 feet 6 feet 20 feet 20 feet 6 feet 26 feet 16 feet 10 feet 30 feet 14 feet 12 feet 32 feet 3. Accessory structures greater than 600 square feet shall not be located in any required front, rear, or side yard and shall provide adequate back-up maneuverability for required parking spaces. H. Structures may occupy not more than 20 percent of the area of the lot located to the rear of the principal building(s). I. All structures located within the neighborhood conservation or entryway corridor overlay districts require a certificate of appropriateness. J. More than two deviations shall not be granted for any accessory structure. 18.38.060 YARD AND HEIGHT ENCROACHMENTS, LIMITATIONS AND EXCEPTIONS A. Permitted Encroachments Into Yards. The following shall be permitted encroachments into required yards, subject to any and all applicable International Building Code requirements: 1. Architectural features, which do not add usable area to a structure, such as chimneys, balconies, stairways, wing walls, bay windows, sills, pilasters, lintels, cornices, eaves, gutters, awnings, window wells and steps, provided such architectural features do not extend more than 5 feet into any required front or rear yard; 2. Architectural features, which do not add usable area to a structure, such as chimneys, balconies, stairways, wing walls, bay windows, sills, pilasters, lintels, cornices, awnings, window wells and steps, provided such architectural features do not extend more than 2 feet into any required side yard, except that eaves and gutters may extend 2.5 feet into any required side yard; 3. Terraces and patios, uncovered decks and stoops or similar features, provided that such features shall not extend above the height of the ground floor level of the principal structure nor more than 5 feet into any required front or rear yard or 2 feet into any required side yard; 4. Where porches, covered terraces and covered decks occupy not more than one-third of the length of the building wall, excluding the width of the garage if applicable they may encroach: a. where the required front yard is greater than 15 feet, not more than 5 feet into any required front yard, b. not more than 5 feet into a required rear yard, c. not more than 2 feet into any required side yard, and; 5. Fire escapes may be permitted in required side or rear yards only; 6. Wheelchair ramps may encroach into any required yard, but shall not be located closer than 3 feet from any property line; and 7. Flag poles, ornamental features, trees, shrubs, walkways, and nameplate signs, and floodlights or other sources of illumination provided the direct source of light is not 105 Ordinance 1761 38-5 visible from the public right-of-way or adjacent residential property may be located within a required yard. Street vision triangle requirements apply. B. Zero Lot Line Conditions. In districts where zero sideyard setbacks are not otherwise allowed, where an individual owns two or more adjoining lots, or where the owners of two or more adjoining lots make legal written agreement recorded at the Gallatin County Clerk and Recorder, a zero lot line concept may be used for commercial or single-household dwelling unit developments. In residential districts this may result in the creation of a two-household residential structure, only in districts permitting such a structure, or the creation of townhouse clusters in districts permitting such structures. In all such cases in residential districts, a minimum 8 foot side yard shall be maintained adjacent to the exterior side, or nonzero lot line side, of the structure. C. Special Yard Setbacks. 1. Where the required setback is greater than 15 feet, the corner side yard for any corner lot not located on an arterial street may be 15 feet. However, where the vehicular access to a garage is located on the frontage of the corner side yard, the portion accessible to vehicles shall maintain at least a 20 foot setback. 2. A 25 foot front yard or corner side yard shall be provided on all arterials designated in the Bozeman growth policy, except within the B-3 district. 3. Setbacks from watercourses as set forth in §18.42.100, BMC. 4. Setbacks from intersections as set forth in §18.44.090, BMC. D. Height Limitation Exceptions. 1. Non-Specific Exemptions. No building, or part thereof, or structure shall be erected, reconstructed or structurally altered to exceed in height the limit herein designated for the district in which such building is located, except as is specified in Chapter 18.66, BMC, or as specifically authorized by the City Commission as an approved condition of a planned unit development. Such approved conditions must include the recommendations of the City Fire Marshal. 2. Specific Exemptions. a. Height limitations shall not apply to church spires, belfries, cupolas and domes; monuments; chimneys and smokestacks; flag poles; public and private utility facilities; parapet walls extending no more than 4 feet above the limiting height of the building except as hereinafter provided; amateur radio antennae; and solar energy collectors and equipment used for the mounting or operation of such collectors; and building mounted horizontal and vertical axis wind energy collectors under 15 feet in height from the building mounting surface and equipment used for the mounting or operation of such collectors. b. Places of public assembly in churches, schools and other permitted public and semipublic buildings may exceed height limitations otherwise established by this title, provided that: (1) These are located on the ground floor of such buildings; and (2) That for each 1 foot by which the height of such building exceeds the maximum height otherwise permitted in the district, its side and rear yards shall be increased in width or depth by an additional 1 foot over the side and rear yards required in the district. c. Elevator and stair penthouses, water tanks, monitors and scenery lofts are exempt from height limitations otherwise established in this title, provided that 106 Ordinance 1761 38-6 no linear dimension of any such structure exceed 50 percent of the corresponding street frontage line. d. Towers and monuments, cooling towers, gas holders or other structures, where the manufacturing process requires a greater height, and grain elevators and silos are exempt from this title, provided that any structure above the height otherwise permitted in the district shall occupy no more than 25 percent of the area of the lot and shall be at least 25 feet from every lot line. e. Height restrictions for wireless facilities are governed by Chapter 18.54, BMC. 18.38.070 STANDARDS FOR SPECIFIC SITE IMPACTS AND ELEMENTS A. Surface-Water Ponding. Natural ponding areas shall be retained as much as possible or, if necessary, enlarged or modified as directed by the City Engineer to restrict the off-site runoff, subject to the storm water runoff control provisions of this title and the City’s stormwater drainage requirements. B. Trash and Garbage Incineration. No exterior incineration of materials is permitted except as allowed by the Department of Public Safety. C. Smoke, Dust and Other Particulate Matter. The emission of smoke or other particulates from any point source shall not exceed a density greater than that permitted by Method 9, 40 CFR 60 Appendix A. Dirt, dust, fly ash and other forms of particulate matter shall not be emitted beyond the property lines of the use creating the particulate matter. D. Bulk Storage (Liquid). All uses associated with bulk storage of all gasoline, liquid fertilizer, chemicals, flammable and similar liquids shall comply with International Building and Fire Code requirements and any applicable County regulations. F. Water Quality, Hazardous Wastes and Wastewater. Discharge of hazardous waste, chemicals or wastewater will be subject to Montana Department of Environmental Quality standards and permitting processes. But in no case shall any hazardous waste, hazardous chemicals or hazardous wastewater be discharged into any perennial stream within the City. G. Odors and Toxic Gases. 1. The emission of odors shall be controlled such that objectionable or offensive odors are not perceptible beyond a distance of 50 feet past the property lines of the use creating the odors. 2. No toxic, noxious or corrosive fumes or gases shall be emitted beyond the property lines of the use creating such fumes or gases. H. Noise. No noise shall be produced that causes a violation of the City’s regulations regarding disturbance of the peace or creates a nuisance. I. Vibrations. No ground vibrations, except for those only perceptible with the use of instruments, shall be permitted beyond the property lines of the use generating the ground vibrations. J. Electrical Disturbance. No activity shall be permitted which causes electrical disturbances affecting the operation of any equipment located beyond the property line of the activity. This paragraph does not apply to uses which are regulated by and are in compliance with federal agencies or law. K. Glare and Heat. Any use producing intense glare or heat shall be conducted so that the glare is effectively screened from view at any point on the lot line of the lot in which the use is located. Any heat will be dissipated so that it is not perceptible without instruments at any point on the lot line of the lot on which the use is located. 107 Ordinance 1761 38-7 L. Fire and Explosive Hazards. Any use or activity involving the use or storage of combustible, flammable or explosive materials shall be in compliance with the Uniform Fire Code as adopted by the City. Burning of waste materials in open fires is prohibited, unless otherwise permitted by and in conformance with, another ordinance. M. Liquid or Solid Waste. No materials, compounds or chemicals, which can contaminate any water supply, interfere with bacterial processes in sewage treatment or otherwise cause emissions of elements which are offensive or hazardous to the public health, safety and general welfare shall be discharged at any point into any public sewer, private sewage disposal system or stream or into the ground, except in accordance with the code of the City and the standards approved by the Montana State Department of Environmental Quality or such governmental agency as may have jurisdiction over such activities. N. Fissionable, Radioactivity or Electromagnetic Disturbance. No activities shall be permitted which utilize fissionable or radioactive materials if, at any time, their use results in the release or emission of any fissionable or radioactive material into the atmosphere, ground or sewerage system. No activities or devices shall be permitted which at any time emit radio-frequency energy affecting any activity or the operation of any equipment beyond the site property line. Radio- frequency energy shall be considered as being electromagnetic energy at any frequency in the radio spectrum between ten kilocycles and three million megacycles. This limitation on radio- frequency interference does not apply to those uses and circumstances falling under the jurisdiction of the FCC. 18.38.080 CLEAN UP OF PROPERTY AND REVEGETATION REQUIRED A. Clean Up of Property. Prior to final plat or final occupancy approval, the developer shall ensure that all construction and other debris is removed from the development. This includes concrete, asphalt, dead trees and shrubs, and fencing materials. B. Revegetation. All areas disturbed during construction shall be reseeded with vegetation types approved by the Gallatin County Weed Control Supervisor. 108 Ordinance # 1761. page 40-1 CHAPTER 18.40 STANDARDS FOR SPECIFIC USES 18.40.010 PURPOSE The purpose of this section is to further describe the standards and conditions under which certain uses may be permitted as principal or conditional uses in specific districts. 18.40.020 APPLICABILITY All uses listed in this section shall be subject to the specific standards described for each use, in addition to all other applicable standards. 18.40.030 ACCESSORY DWELLING UNITS A. An owner or the owners of real property may establish and maintain an accessory dwelling unit, either within a detached single-household dwelling or above a detached garage which is accessory to the detached single-household dwelling, in the R-S or R-1 districts if all of the following conditions are met and continue to be met during the life of the accessory dwelling unit: 1. The detached dwelling unit within which the accessory dwelling unit is located, or the accessory dwelling unit itself, is actually and physically occupied as a principal residence by at least one owner of record who possesses at least an estate for life or a 50 percent fee simple ownership interest. No more than one of the dwellings, either the principal dwelling or the accessory dwelling, may be rented by non-owners at the same time. The City may require a guarantee of compliance with the requirements of this section, including but not limited to a binding deed restriction or covenant enforcing the single rental restriction as allowed in §18.74.080.B, BMC, as a condition of approval; 2. In addition to the parking required for the principal residence, one paved off-street parking space is provided for the exclusive use of the accessory dwelling unit. The parking provided shall be located on the lot and may not utilize the on-street parking provisions of Chapter 18.46, BMC; 3. The occupancy of the accessory dwelling unit does not exceed two persons; 4. Garages shall not be converted for use as accessory dwelling units. However, accessory dwelling units shall be permitted to be placed above garages only in subdivisions receiving preliminary plat approval after January 1, 1997; 5. No permit for an accessory dwelling unit shall be granted unless the lot has been configured to accept an accessory dwelling unit with adequate lot area, utility services, and compliance with setbacks and height standards; 6. In no case shall an accessory dwelling unit be larger than 800 square feet or have more than a single bedroom. The method of calculating the maximum ADU square footage will be “living area” defined as “all floor area exclusive of areas with a sloped ceiling less than five (53) feet in height, stairwells, and exterior decks.” Bedrooms, living rooms, kitchens, casework, interior walls, hallways, closets, bathrooms, and any other living space shall be included in the maximum square footage calculation.; 7. Second story additions on detached garages shall be approved only if found compatible and consistent with the character and fabric of the neighborhood; 8. Only one accessory dwelling unit may be created per lot; and 109 Ordinance # 1761. page 40-2 9. If the accessory dwelling unit is a part of the principal dwelling unit, the accessory dwelling unit shall be clearly incidental to the principal dwelling unit and shall meet the following criteria: a. The accessory dwelling unit is created only in a single-household detached dwelling unit on a lot of 6,000 square feet or more; b. The accessory dwelling unit does not exceed one-third of the total area of the principal structure; c. The accessory dwelling unit is created only through internal conversion of the principal structure or constructed above a garage. Minor exterior changes may be made on the building, if the square footage added constitutes no more than 10 percent of the principal structure’s existing living area (exclusive of the garage); and d. If the entrance for the accessory dwelling unit is separate from the entrance of the principal structure, the entrance shall only be located in the rear or side yards. 10. All accessory dwelling units are subject to CUP provisions established in Chapter 18.34, BMC. 11. No deviations shall be granted to lot area requirements or parking requirements to allow the establishment of an accessory dwelling unit. In no case shall more than a total of two deviations be granted to allow the establishment of an accessory dwelling unit. B. An owner or the owners of real property may establish per §18.34.050 and maintain an accessory dwelling unit, in the R-2, R-3, R-4 or R-O districts if all of the following conditions are met and continue to be met during the life of the accessory dwelling unit. If the following conditions are not met the dwelling shall be reviewed under the provisions of §18.34.090, BMC. 1. In addition to the parking required for the principal residence, the minimum number of required paved off-street parking shall be provided for the exclusive use of the accessory dwelling unit; 2. The occupancy of the accessory dwelling unit does not exceed two persons; 3. Garages shall not be converted for use as accessory dwelling units. However, accessory dwelling units shall be permitted to be placed above garages; 4. In no case shall an accessory dwelling unit be larger than 600 square feet or contain more than a single bedroom. The method of calculating the maximum ADU square footage will be “living area” defined as “all floor area exclusive of areas with a sloped ceiling less than five (5) feet in height, stairwells, and exterior decks.” Bedrooms, living rooms, kitchens, casework, interior walls, hallways, closets, bathrooms, and any other living space shall be included in the maximum square footage calculation; 5. Second story additions on detached garages shall be approved only if found compatible and consistent with the existing character and fabric of the neighborhood; and 6. Only one accessory dwelling unit may be created per lot. 7. No deviations shall be granted to lot area requirements or parking requirements to allow the establishment of an accessory dwelling unit. In no case shall more than a total of two deviations be granted to allow the establishment of an accessory dwelling unit. 8. The accessory dwelling unit is located above a detached garage. 9. An accessory dwelling unit may not be approved on a reduced size lot created to meet the minimum workforce housing requirements of Chapter 17.02, BMC. 110 Ordinance # 1761. page 40-3 C. The applicant shall comply with Building Department standards. 18.40.040 ADULT BUSINESSES In addition to the requirements to be followed for all development established in this title, the following requirements shall apply to all adult businesses. A. An adult business must be separated by at least a 500-foot radius from any other adult use, residence, residential district, school, place of worship, public park or any youth-oriented establishment. Subsequent establishment of one of the above listed uses within the required separation radius does not compel the relocation of an adult business. 18.40.050 ALCOHOL SALES FOR ON PREMISE CONSUMPTION Alcohol sales for on premise consumption, on either a temporary or permanent basis, may not be conducted on the same lot or premises where an adult business or auto retail fuel sale is permitted. 18.40.060 AUTOMOBILE REPAIR AND/OR FUEL SALES In addition to the requirements to be followed for all convenience uses as defined in this title, and provided in §18.40.100 of this chapter, the following requirements shall apply to all service station and automobile uses as listed below. Compliance with all criteria listed below does not necessarily guarantee approval by the City. A. Gas pump and pump island canopies are to be located not closer than 10 feet to any side or rear property line. Design of the canopy shall architecturally match the design of the main building. All canopies shall be connected to the roof of the main structure unless otherwise approved. All lighting shall meet the lighting standards of this title. The maximum height of the canopy shall not exceed 18 feet. All signs must conform to the sign regulations of Chapter 18.52, BMC; B. All on-site activities, except those normally performed at the fuel pumps, are to be performed within a completely enclosed building; C. Where towing service is to be provided, a parking bay for the towing vehicle is to be provided. Vehicles that are either under repair or vehicles that have been repaired may be stored on a temporary basis, not to exceed seven days, and designated parking bays must be provided for each vehicle awaiting repairs. Vehicle storage areas are subject to the same screening requirements as parking lots; D. All lighting shall conform to Section 18.42.150; E. All structures approved under these standards shall be of a design character that is appropriate to the area in which they are to be constructed. Color renderings of buildings shall accompany each application and construction shall be in conformity thereto. Architectural detailing shall be consistent on all four sides of the building; F. All restroom entrances shall be screened from view of adjacent properties or street rights of-way by a decorative wall or landscaping, or shall be accessed from the inside of the main entrance to the building; G. No outside storage of, and no sale, lease or rental of trailers, trucks or similar equipment shall be permitted except as may be specifically allowed in that zone; H. Parking space for each service stall in the station shall be provided. Pump islands shall not be considered as service bays. Standing areas at pump islands and interior circulation areas shall not be used as parking areas in calculating required parking spaces; and I. Automotive Repair Facilities. 1. All repairs or painting shall be performed within a building; 111 Ordinance # 1761. page 40-4 2. No site plan shall be approved which exposes unassembled vehicles, auto repair activities or auto parts to any street or residential district; 3. Any facility shall be designed to contain and minimize noise and odors; and 4. All facilities shall have a water quality facility (oil / water separator) as part of the water quality design for storm water runoff, and shall conform to Section 18.42.080. 18.40.070 AUTOMOBILE WASHING ESTABLISHMENT In addition to the requirements to be followed for all convenience uses, the following requirements shall apply to all auto washing establishments as listed below. A. All detergents must be biodegradable; B. Building surfaces shall be faced with masonry, brick, stucco, wood or some other permanent looking material; C. Trash and litter containers shall be emptied daily. In addition, the site shall be patrolled at least once daily in order to remove litter; D. Sale of automobile accessories such as batteries, tires, gasoline, etc. is prohibited during any period when establishment employees are not present; and E. Canopies are to be located not closer than 10 feet to any side or rear property line. Design of the canopy shall architecturally match the design of the main building. All lighting shall meet the lighting standards of this title. The maximum height of the canopy shall not exceed 18 feet. All signs must conform to the sign regulations of Chapter 18.52, BMC. 18.40.080 CEMETERIES A. Total site area, including business office and storage building, shall be a minimum of 40 acres, of which at least 10 acres shall be subdivided and developed in the initial plot. B. The cemetery may include accessory uses such as a chapel, mortuary, office, mausoleum and those industrial uses which are incidental to the operation of a cemetery. Industrial uses may include such things as the manufacture of burial vaults and headstone foundations, provided all of the products are used on the site and are not offered for sale and use elsewhere. The cemetery shall not include uses of an industrial nature other than those stated in this section. 18.40.090 CONDOMINIUMS A. Unit Ownership Act. Condominium developments shall comply with all provisions of the Unit Ownership Act, §70-23-102 et seq., MCA, and all regulations adopted pursuant thereto. B. Condominium Association. A condominium association shall be established for each condominium development. The developer shall prepare bylaws for the condominium association, as well as covenants, conditions and restrictions for the condominium development, in compliance with Chapter 18.72 of this title. The bylaws, covenants, conditions and restrictions shall be submitted to the City for review and approval prior to the granting of final site plan approval or approval for condominiumization of existing development. C. Internal circulation in a condominium development shall be designed in accordance with Chapter 18.46, and shall, when deemed necessary by the City Engineer, not have to comply with Section 18.44.020. D. Condominiums may be subject to Chapter 17.02, BMC. 112 Ordinance # 1761. page 40-5 18.40.100 CONVENIENCE USES AND DRIVE THROUGH/DRIVE IN RESTAURANTS A. Architectural Guidelines. 1. All convenience uses shall be designed with an architectural and design character that is appropriate for and compatible with the area, and shall also comply with all applicable design standards and guidelines including the Design Objectives Plan for entry way corridors; 2. Use of standardized corporate identification themes integrated into the architectural design is generally not acceptable. Excessive use of such themes may be used as grounds for denial of the project; 3. When located in shopping centers, the architectural character of the building shall be integrated with the design theme of the center through the use of the same building materials, shapes and details. The effect of color in creating a design character that is appropriate for and compatible with the area will be considered. All parking, circulation, driveways, setbacks and signage shall be integrated with the entire design theme of the project; and 4. The elevation design of the building shall provide design character and detailing on all four sides. B. Noise from drive through speakers shall not be audible from adjacent residential districts. 18.40.110 HOME BASED BUSINESSES A. Generally. A home based business is a use that is considered accessory to a dwelling unit. Buildings combining live/work arrangements located in districts where both the residential and nonresidential uses to be combined are permitted are not subject to the requirements of this section. B. Home Based Business as Accessory Use 1. The use shall be clearly incidental and secondary to the use of the dwelling for residential purposes and shall not change the character of the dwelling or adversely affect the uses permitted in the residential district of which it is a part. The home based business may not be conducted in an accessory structure, and shall comply with the standards of subsection C below. 2. Purpose. It is in the intent of this section to eliminate as accessory home based businesses for all uses except those that conform to the standards set forth in this section. In general, an accessory home based business is a use so located and conducted that the average neighbor, under normal circumstances, would not be aware of its existence with the exception of permitted signage as allowed by Chapter 18.52, BMC. The standards for home based businesses included in this section are intended to insure compatibility with other permitted uses and with the residential character of the neighborhood. A clearly accessory or incidental status in relation to the residential use of the main building is the criteria for determining whether a proposed accessory use qualifies as an of right home based business. 3. Necessary Conditions for Accessory Use. Accessory home based businesses are permitted accessory uses in residential districts only so long as all the following conditions are observed: a. Such home based business shall be conducted by resident occupants in their residence with not more than one on-premise halftime nonresident employee; 113 Ordinance # 1761. page 40-6 b. No more than 25 percent of the gross area of all structures shall be used for such purpose; c. No use shall require internal or external alterations or involve construction features or the use of electrical or mechanical equipment that would change the fire rating of the structure; d. No home based business shall cause an increase in the use of any one or more utilities (water, sewer, garbage, etc.) so that the combined total use for dwelling and home based business purposes exceeds the average for residences in the neighborhood; e. There shall be no outside storage of any kind related to the home based business; f. The use may increase vehicular traffic flow and parking by no more than one additional vehicle at a time. Depending on the individual circumstances of each application, an additional off-street parking space may be required; and g. No use shall create noise, dust, vibration, smell, smoke, glare, electrical interference, fire hazard or any other hazard or nuisance to any greater or more frequent extent than that usually experienced in an average residential occupancy in the district in question under normal circumstances wherein no home based business exists. 4. Notice of Intent to Operate an Accessory Home Based Business. Any individual applying for a business license, with the intent of operating the business from his/her home, shall acknowledge by signature his/her understanding of the requirements and conditions of this title. C. Home Based Business as Conditional Use. 1. Purpose. The use shall be secondary to the use of the lot for residential purposes and shall not be incompatible with the character of the zoning district thereof or adversely affect the principal uses permitted in the residential district of which it is a part. When a home based business has been established through the CUP process, it means that the owner, lessee or other persons who have a legal right to the use of the dwelling also have the right to conduct the home based business whether in the principal or an accessory structure. The home based business shall comply with the standards of subsection C.3 below. 2. Conditional Use. It is the intent of this section to provide, through the conditional use process established in Chapter 18.34, BMC, opportunities for home based businesses which are more intensive in nature than those which would be allowed as an accessory use. In general, a home based business approved through the conditional use process is an accessory use which complies with the requirements of this title and is subordinate to the primary use of the particular lot for residential purposes. The standards for home based businesses included in this section are intended to insure compatibility with other permitted uses and with the residential character of the neighborhood. A secondary, but not incidental, status in relation to the residential use of the main building is the criteria for determining whether a proposed use may, under certain circumstances, qualify as a home based business which may be approved by the conditional use process. As stated in §18.34.010, BMC, conditional uses start from the presumption that they are incompatible with the zoning district but may under specific and limited conditions become compatible. Unless such conditions are found, there is no right to the practice of a home based business which does not comply with the terms of an accessory home based businesses as listed in this section. 114 Ordinance # 1761. page 40-7 3. Necessary Conditions for Conditional Use. Home based businesses permitted through the conditional use permit process are allowed in residential districts only so long as all the following conditions are observed: a. Such home based business shall be conducted by resident occupants with not more than one on-premise halftime nonresident employee; b. No more than 30 percent of the gross area of all structures shall be used for such purpose; c. No use shall require internal or external alterations or involve construction features or the use of electrical or mechanical equipment that would change the fire rating of the structure beyond that allowed in a residential use; d. No home based business shall cause an increase in the use of any one or more utilities operated by the City of Bozeman so that the combined total use for dwelling and home based business purposes exceeds the average for residences in the neighborhood; e. There shall be no outside storage of any kind related to the home based business; f. No use shall create noise, dust, vibration, smell, smoke, glare, electrical interference, fire hazard or any other hazard or nuisance to any greater or more frequent extent than that allowed by this title; g. Home based business by conditional use permit may only be allowed on lots occupied by single-household detached dwellings; h. Such conditional use shall be subject to all conditions set forth in this title, except the provisions of §18.48.060, BMC, Landscape Performance Standards; and i. All permits required by the City, including, but not limited to, building permits and business licenses, shall be received prior to establishing the home based business. 4. Home Based Business Allowed Through a Conditional Use Permit. Any individual seeking to operate a home based business, which is greater in scope than that allowed by an accessory home based business, shall make application for a conditional use permit under the terms of Chapter 18.34, BMC. The Planning Director shall determine if a home based business requires a conditional use permit. D. Complaints. Complaints by citizens of Bozeman may be cause for termination of the home based business. However, should such complaint be filed, the operator is entitled to an appeal to the City Commission for a public hearingmeeting. The City Commission shall determine whether or not the filed complaint identifies sufficient violation of this title to warrant termination or modification of the home based business. E. Uses That Are Prohibited. The following uses, by the nature of their character or the investment of operation, have a pronounced tendency, once started, to rapidly increase beyond the limits permitted for home based businesses and thereby impair the use and value of a residentially zoned area for residential purposes. Therefore, the following uses shall not be permitted as home based businesses: adult businesses; auto repair, minor or major; carpentry work; dance instruction; dental offices; medical offices; mobile oil and lube services; painting of vehicles, trailers or boats; private schools with organized classes; radio or television repair; and upholstering. F. Appeal to City Commission. Any person may appeal the Planning Director’s action relating to a home based business to the City Commission as provided for by Chapter 18.66, BMC. 115 Ordinance # 1761. page 40-8 18.40.120 MANUFACTURED HOME COMMUNITIES Manufactured home communities are included in the state classification of land subdivisions by rent or lease. Therefore, applicants for such developments shall apply for and be reviewed under both site plan and subdivision procedures. These will be reviewed concurrently when appropriate. All standards of this title are applicable unless explicitly waived. A. State of Montana Requirements. All manufactured home communities developed under this section shall comply with Montana State Department of Public Health and Human Services, Department of Environmental Quality and any other applicable state regulations. Prior to final approval for a manufactured home community, copies of approval letters from relevant state agencies shall be submitted or compliance with all applicable regulations shall be certified by a professional civil engineer licensed by the State of Montana. B. Lot Improvements. The location of boundaries of each manufactured home lot for rent or lease shall be clearly and permanently marked on the ground with flush stakes, markers or other suitable means. The location marked must be closely approximate to those depicted on the approved plans. 1. Utility Hookup. Every manufactured home shall be permanently connected to electric power, water supply, sewage disposal, gas and telephone service lines in compliance with applicable City codes, and all utility distribution and service lines shall be installed underground. 2. Permanent Foundations and Anchoring. All manufactured homes shall be required to be tied or otherwise physically anchored to an approved permanent concrete foundation. Building permits for foundations and anchoring, issued through the City Building Department in accordance with the adopted International Building Code, are required. The method of anchoring and foundations shall be specified as part of the required preliminary development review. 3. Maintenance. a. There shall be no exposed outdoor storage of furniture (except lawn furniture), household goods, tools, equipment, or building materials or supplies. b. No manufactured home may be parked on a public or private street for more than twenty-four hours. c. An abandoned, burned or wrecked manufactured home must be secured against entry as directed by the Fire Marshall and may not be kept on a lot for more than forty-five days. d. Each manufactured home must bear an insignia which attests that the construction of the manufactured home meets regulation A 119.1 of the American National Standards Institute (adopted by the U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development), or be certified as meeting the Mobile Home Construction and Safety Standards of the U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development. e. Within twenty-one days of placement, standard manufactured home skirting of fire-resistive material similar in character to that of the manufactured home must be provided around the entire perimeter of the manufactured home between the bottom of the body of the manufactured home and the ground, except where the running gear has been removed and the manufactured home itself is attached directly to the permanent foundation. 116 Ordinance # 1761. page 40-9 f. All required front yards of lots for rent or lease for manufactured homes shall be fully landscaped. g. All private, commonly owned recreation areas not devoted to buildings, structures, surfaced courts, sand boxes, etc. shall be landscaped and irrigated. 4. Manufactured home lots for rent or lease shall be arranged to permit the practical placement and removal of manufactured homes. Every lot for rent or lease must front on a public or private street. C. Permits and Inspections. 1. Owner’s and Agent’s Responsibility. It shall be the responsibility of the individual property owners or, in the case of a rental community, the managers ofthe rental community to see that all sections of this article are complied with, including requirements relative to placement of manufactured homes, and all required permits. 2. Move In Permit Required. All manufactured homes moved into the City must be issued a move-in permit, pursuant to this section, and be inspected by the City Building Official, prior to gas and electric service being turned on by the servicing utility. A copy of the original sales contract shall be available for permit informational purposes. 3. City Inspection Required. a. The required inspections for manufactured homes shall include: onsite utilities requirements including gas, electric, sewer and water; setback requirements; and off-street parking requirements. Fees for these have been established by the City Commission by resolution. b. It is unlawful for any person, firm, corporation or agency to turn on, or allow to be turned on, any gas or electric service without an inspection and clearance from the City Building Official. 4. Non-Manufactured Home Improvements Subject to the International Building Code. Permits must be obtained for additions, alterations, canopies, carports, storage areas and detached refrigeration units that were not included in the original sale of the manufactured home unit, fees for which are set by the International Building Code and Uniform Mechanical Code. D. Plans. The preliminary and final plans shall accurately depict: 1. All proposed and required landscaping; 2. Locations of storage areas for recreational vehicles and other chattels of the residents; 3. A layout of typical lots for rent or lease showing the location and dimensions of the lot, manufactured home stand, driveway and parking spaces; 4. Mail delivery area; and 5. Foundation and anchoring details. E. A permanent enclosure for temporary storage of garbage, refuse and other waste material shall be provided for every manufactured home space. If trash dumpsters are to be used, they shall be centrally and conveniently located, shall not be located in any front yard, and shall otherwise comply with the requirements of this title. F. Landscaping may be required by the City Commission to provide a buffer between manufactured home communities and adjacent uses, and to enhance the appearance of the development. The landscaping may be interspersed with a fence or wall. Specific perimeter landscape/buffering treatments shall be determined on a case-by case basis, with the City 117 Ordinance # 1761. page 40-10 considering appropriate factors such as the nature of adjacent uses, noise and proximity to busy streets. G. Recreation Areas. At a minimum, the amount of land required to be dedicated under §18.50.020, BMC, shall be reserved as park or recreation area. Recreation areas may include space for community recreation buildings and facilities. 1. Public access through the recreation area may be required, through the provision of a written public access easement, if it is determined by the City commission that public access is necessary to ensure public access through the private recreational area from adjoining properties to nearby or adjacent public parks. H. Accessory Buildings. Accessory buildings for individual dwellings are subject to §18.38.050, BMC. 18.40.130 MANUFACTURED HOMES ON INDIVIDUAL LOTS A. Intent. It is the intent of this section to allow manufactured homes, as defined in Chapter 18.80, BMC, in specified zoning districts in which similar single-household dwellings constructed on the site are permitted subject to requirements and procedures set forth herein to assure acceptable similarity in exterior appearances between such manufactured homes and dwellings that have been or might be constructed under these and other regulations on adjacent lots in the same district or area. It is the intent of this section to permit only those manufactured homes certified as meeting the Mobile Home Construction and Safety Standards of the U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development. B. Application, Material to be Supplied. One copy of the application for the proposed manufactured home on the individual building lot shall be submitted to the Building Department in conjunction with the application for a building permit for the building foundation. The application shall include all information as deemed necessary by the Planning Director to make determinations as to conformity with subsection C of this section, and it shall include a minimum of color photographs of all sides of the manufactured home, of the nearest existing residences or other grounds or buildings on each side of the proposed site, and of existing residences or grounds fronting upon the same street as the proposed site and opposite thereto, and also including those within 150 feet of each corner of the proposed site. As a minimum requirement, it shall also include a description of siding and roofing material in sufficient detail as to make possible determination as to its appearance and durability. C. Standards for Determination of Acceptable Similarity in Exterior Appearance and Construction. The following standards shall be used in determinations of acceptable similarity in appearance and construction between manufactured homes with permanent foundations and residences constructed near the site to assure that such manufactured homes will be compatible in appearance with site built housing that has been or may be constructed in adjacent or nearby locations. 1. No manufactured homes shall have fenestration or other features that will be incompatible in the residential neighborhood. 2. The roof shall have sloping lines with eaves, such as gable, mansard and shed style roofs or shall be compatible with conventionally built homes in the surrounding areas. The pitch of the main roof shall not be less than 1 foot of rise for each 4 feet of horizontal run. Minimum distance from eaves to ridge shall be 10 feet. 3. The roofing material shall be shake, tile, composition shingle, or other materials commonly found on conventionally built homes in the surrounding areas. 118 Ordinance # 1761. page 40-11 4. The exterior covering material shall be similar or closely compatible to that found on conventionally built residential structures in the surrounding area. Reflection from such exterior shall not be greater than from siding coated with clean, white, gloss, exterior enamel. 5. The exterior covering material shall extend below the top of the foundation. 6. A solid concrete or masonry perimeter foundation shall be used. 7. The exterior covering and roofing materials of the garage(s), carport(s) and accessory buildings shall be compatible with the materials on the manufactured home. 8. The finished floor shall be a maximum of 24 inches above the exterior finished grade of the lot, or similar to the conventionally built homes in the surrounding area. 9. The manufactured home shall be located on the lot so that the home presents a primary entrance to the principal street frontage. Such primary entrance may be established by the presence of porches, overhanging gables, and similar architectural features consistent with the character of site built homes in the near vicinity. 10. Manufactured homes on permanent foundations shall meet all the property development standards for the zone in which they shall be located. These standards include, but are not limited to: lot area and dimension; area per dwelling unit; front, rear and side yard setbacks; building height, lot coverage, location of accessory buildings; and offstreet parking. 11. Manufactured homes located within the Neighborhood Conservation Overlay District shall be subject to review for a certificate of appropriateness under the same standards for architectural compatibility as other homes. 12. Manufactured homes shall be approved for location on individual building lots only if they have been certified as meeting the Mobile Home Construction and Safety Standards of the U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development. D. Actions by Planning Director. Upon receipt of an application as required by subsection B of this section, the Planning Director shall make a decision to approve or disapprove of the application within fifteen working days, or he may make referral to the City Commission. Referrals to the City Commission shall be placed on the agenda for its regular meeting. Within five working days after receipt of recommendations from the City Commission, the Planning Director shall make a determination as to conformity with subsection C of this section, notifying the applicants of approval or disapproval. In the case of disapproval, the reasons therefore shall be stated in writing. 18.40.140 MINI WAREHOUSES A. Minimum site size shall be one acre. B. On-Site Circulation, Drives and Parking. 1. Each mini warehouse site shall provide a minimum of 2 exits; 2. All one-way driveways shall provide for one 10-foot parking lane and one 12-foot travel lane. Traffic direction and parking shall be designated by signing or painting; 3. All two-way driveways shall provide for one 10-foot parking lane and two 10-foot travel lanes; and 4. The parking lanes may be eliminated when the driveway does not serve storage cubicles. 119 Ordinance # 1761. page 40-12 18.40.150 OUTDOOR SALES AND DISPLAY A. Merchandise which is offered for direct sale, rental or lease to the ultimate consumer or user may be displayed beyond the confines of a building in any commercial district, but the area occupied by such outdoor display shall not constitute a greater number of square feet than 10 percent of the ground floor area of the building housing the principal use, unless such merchandise is a type customarily displayed outdoors such as automobiles and garden supplies. In such cases, the maximum area for outdoor sales and display shall not exceed 50 percent of the total lot area. B. Outdoor sales and display areas shall not be located in any required yard and is also subject to §18.42.160, BMC. 18.40.160 PORTABLE CARRY - OUT FOOD AND BEVERAGE BUILDINGS A. A $10,000 site bond must be secured on the property. In addition, evidence of liability insurance, with coverage of $1,000,000 per occurrence, shall be furnished by the owner. B. Electrical service must be installed underground, in compliance with all electrical service codes, subject to approval by the Building Department. C. Structures shall not exceed 80 square feet in size. All structures must be on an improved asphalt or concrete surface, be anchored to resist accidental movement, be placed upon approved footings and have a fully electrically bonded frame. No structure shall have an axle. Enclosed trailers must remove the axle, be secured to resist accidental movement, with all related supports cosmetically covered with an approved material. D. Not more than one portable structure may be placed on a zone lot (individual property or contiguous properties held in common ownership). Portable structures shall be placed in a manner so as not to interfere with normal vehicle and pedestrian circulation patterns or required emergency access. Nor shall such structures be placed in a manner that eliminates or interferes with the use of required parking spaces. E. Requests for special temporary use permits shall be subject to review and must be approved by the appropriate City department representatives, including but not limited to City Engineer, Fire Marshal, City Building Official and Planning Director. Permit coordination and final issuance shall be by the Planning Director. A Special Temporary Use Permit for Portable Carry-Out Food and Beverage buildings shall be valid for a period of one year, and may be renewed annually thereafter only if all regulations and requirements are strictly complied with on a continuing basis. F. Operations shall be subject to all licensing requirements of the Gallatin City-County Health Board. Documentation of such licensing, including a copy of plans for water supply and disposal, shall be provided to the planning director prior to permitting. G. The City of Bozeman reserves the right to revoke or terminate this permit at any time by giving 30 days written notice of such revocation or termination, except that the City may, at its election, revoke or terminate the permit at any time without giving any notice if the owner fails to comply with or abide by each and all of the terms and conditions of the permit. H. Portable food and beverage buildings as described herein shall not be subject to certificate of appropriateness requirements for the neighborhood conservation and entryway corridors overlay districts. 120 Ordinance # 1761. page 40-13 18.40.170 RECREATIONAL VEHICLE PARK AND OVERNIGHT CAMPGROUND Recreational vehicle parks and overnight campgrounds are included in the state classification of land subdivisions by rent or lease. Therefore, applicants for such developments shall apply for and be reviewed under both site plan and subdivision procedures. A. Recreational vehicle parks shall be screened from view of any adjacent residential development. B. Internal circulation roads shall be paved with a concrete or asphaltic concrete surface. C. Individual recreational vehicle parking pads shall be plainly marked and maintained with a dust free surface. D. Individual recreational vehicle parking pads shall be set back at least 30 feet from the perimeter of the park and 30 feet from any public street right-of-way. E. Approved trash disposal, bathroom and laundry facilities, including facilities for the handicapped, shall be provided for use of overnight campers. F. Recreational vehicles spaces shall be separated by no less than 15 feet and shall be no less than 1,500 square feet in area. G. Land proposed for use for a recreational vehicle park must have a R-S, Residential Suburban District or a RMH, Residential Manufactured Home Community District zoning designation. Recreational vehicle parks are a principal use in the RMH district and a conditional use in the R- S district. 18.40.180 LARGE SCALE RETAIL, SIZE LIMITATIONS AND DESIGN AND SITE DEVELOPMENT GUIDELINES AND REQUIREMENTS A. Purpose. 1. The purpose of this section is to establish general development standards for large scale retail developments. These standards are intended and designed to assure compatibility of uses; to prevent urban blight, deterioration and decay; and to enhance the health, safety and general welfare of the residents living within the City of Bozeman. 2. These standards are also intended to be used as guidelines for evaluating and assessing the quality and design of proposed large scale retail developments. The particulars of any large scale retail developments will be evaluated against their respective standards contained in this chapter. It is expected that the quality and design of the large scale retail developments, while not necessarily complying with the exact standards of this chapter, will meet or exceed the intent behind these standards. 3. Applicability. All uses listed in this chapter shall be subject to the specific standards described for each use, in addition to all other applicable standards which may apply. B. Limitations on Size of Retail Stores. 1. No retail building, utilized by a single tenant, shall exceed 75,000 square feet. 2. Retail development consisting of one or more single tenant building(s) greater than 40,000 square feet may offer for direct sale to the public merchandise, which is displayed outdoors, but the area occupied by such outdoor sales and storage, exclusive of warehouses, shall not exceed 25 percent of the total square footage of the retail building(s) and shall also comply with §18.40.150, BMC. 3. Notwithstanding §18.40.180.B.1 and §18.40.180.B.2, BMC, when an otherwise lawful retail building, in excess of 75,000 square feet, exists as of March 21, 2003, such building shall be considered a development nonconformity. Said building may be continued, structurally altered, repaired or reconstructed so long as it is not increased, extended or 121 Ordinance # 1761. page 40-14 enlarged beyond the gross floor area of the building that existed on March 21, 2003. To the extent practicable, the design and site development guidelines of this section shall be applied to any alteration, reconstruction or repair that takes place after March 21, 2003. 4. The following principal uses are exempt, as they pertain to outdoor sales and storage: a. Recreation vehicle sales and auto sales; b. Agricultural implement sales; i.e., tractors, cultivators, balers, etc.; and c. Plant nursery. C. Design and Site Development Guidelines for Certain Retail Developments. 1. Retail development consisting of a single tenant building greater than 40,000 square feet shall be subject to the design and site development criteria and development standards contained in subsection 5 and 6 below. These guidelines shall be applied as part of the review and approval process for use permits and detailed applications. For developments in the entryway corridor, which are also subject to the design guidelines in Chapter 18.30, BMC, if there is any conflict between the guidelines, the more restrictive guideline shall apply. The guidelines in this section shall not be applied to any development or portion of a development that is covered by an approved use permit as of March 21, 2003, unless modifications to the use permit are proposed by the applicant. 2. Intent and Purpose. All new construction of retail buildings described in subsection A above will be subject to design review. It is the intent and purpose of this section to ensure the quality of retail development will enhance the impression and enjoyment of the community both by guiding development and change that occurs after the adoption of the ordinance codified in this section, and by stimulating and assisting, in conjunction with other provisions of this title, improvements in signage, landscaping, access and other contributing elements of retail development appearance and function. It is further the intent of this section to establish design criteria, standards and review procedures that will allow the City and its advisory boards and agencies to review and direct, in a fair and equitable manner, the development and redevelopment of future and existing properties and facilities governed by this section. The recommendations of the Design Review Board or administrative design review staff shall be given careful consideration in the final action of any agency, board or commission involved in decisions involving retail developments governed by this chapter. 3. The Design Review Board and administrative design review staff shall have the powers and duties provided by this title in considering applications subject to this chapter. 4. Certificate of Appropriateness. A certificate of appropriateness, received from the City Commission, with a recommendation by the Design Review Board, shall be required as a condition of site plan approval for any development governed by this section. Application, review and public notice procedures for proposals governed by this section are set forth in Chapter 18.76, BMC, Noticing, and Chapter 18.34, BMC, Review Procedures for Site Development. A denial of a certificate shall be accompanied by a written statement of reasons for the denial. 5. Design Criteria and Development Standards. In addition to all other applicable review procedures and design criteria, all development governed by this section shall exceed design criteria and development standards contained in Chapter 18.30, BMC, Entryway Overlay District, including the general design objectives and guidelines contained in the adopted or updated Design Objectives Plan, regardless of location or zoning district. Said design criteria and development standards shall be exceeded through design practices such as additional architectural detailing, exceptional landscape design, 122 Ordinance # 1761. page 40-15 improved public spaces, use of renewable energy and/or recycled construction materials, and provisions for alternative modes of transportation. The City Commission shall determine whether established design criteria and development standards have been exceeded based on a recommendation from the Design Review Board. 6. Adaptability for Reuse/Compartmentalization. The building design shall include specific elements for adaptation for multi-tenant reuse. Such elements may include but are not limited to compartmentalized construction, including plumbing, electrical service, heating, ventilation and air conditioning. The building design shall also allow for: a. The interior subdivision of the structure into separate tenancies; b. Facades that readily adapt to multiple entrances and adapt to entrances on all but one side of the building; c. Parking lot schemes that are shared by establishments or are linked by safe and functional pedestrian connections; d. Landscaping schemes that complement the multiple entrance design; and e. Other elements of design which facilitate the multi-tenant reuse of the building and site. 7. Appeals. Appeals may be taken as provided for in Chapter 18.66, BMC. D. Additional Criteria and Site Development Guidelines for Certain Retail Developments. 1. Applications for large scale retail development shall include a renewal plan that will afford maximum opportunity, consistent with the sound needs of the municipality as a whole, for the rehabilitation or redevelopment of the structure in the event of closure or relocation by the original occupant. Such plan will be approved if the City Commission finds that: a. The plan conforms to the City’s growth policy and the requirements of this title or parts thereof for the municipality as a whole; b. A sound and adequate plan exists for said redevelopment; c. The plan affords maximum opportunity for rehabilitation or redevelopment of the structure by both private enterprise and the City; and d. The renewal plan provides a maintenance plan for normal repairs and upkeep of property, including but not limited to building, parking lot and surfacing, landscaping, signage and elimination of legible impressions, images, or remnants of signs remaining on a building or sign surface after the use for which the sign was permitted ceases to operate. 2. The City may enter into a development agreement with the owner of the real property and undertake activities, including the acquisition, removal or demolition of structures, improvements or personal property located on the real property, to prepare the property for redevelopment. A development agreement entered into in accordance with this section must contain provisions obligating the owner to redevelop the real property for a specified use consistent with the provisions of this title and offering recourse to the City if the redevelopment is not completed as determined by the City. E. Review. The provisions of this section shall be reviewed by the Commission in five years and updated as needed. 18.40.190 STABLE, COMMERCIAL A. The minimum property size shall be ten acres. 123 Ordinance # 1761. page 40-16 B. Structures or facilities used for stabling, storing, showing or training of animals shall be set back a minimum of 100 feet from any adjacent privately owned property. Dwelling units, accessory structures incidental to dwelling units and irrigated pasturage may occur within the 100-foot setback area subject to the setback requirements of the applicable zoning district. C. There shall be at least a 20-foot yard adjacent to any street. D. There shall be no shows or other activities which would generate more traffic than is normal to a residential area, unless the proposed site has direct access from an arterial street as set forth in the Bozeman growth policy. Permission for such shows and activities shall be obtained from the City. Notification shall be provided in a letter that explains the nature and duration of the activity, and accommodations for spectators, traffic control and additional parking for cars and trailers. This letter shall be submitted to the Planning Director at least one month prior to the date of the show or activity. E. All pasture and animal storage areas shall be enclosed with fences or walls of a minimum of 4 feet, 6 inches in height. The design of these enclosures shall be shown on drawings submitted with the conditional use permit application. F. All laws applicable to the public health and appropriate care of animals must be complied with for the entire period of operation of the stable. G. All activity and pasture areas that are not grassed shall be treated for dust control as approved by the Planning Director. H. Adequate parking for daily activities shall be shown on the site plan and improved to City parking standards. Additional parking, improved as determined by the Planning Director, shall be provided for shows or other special events. 18.40.200 TENNIS AND RACQUET CLUB A. The use will be compatible with any adjacent neighborhood and will not be detrimental to the same due to: 1. Increased automobile traffic; 2. Noise generated from within the site. B. Perimeter fencing of the site may be required, fencing of outdoor courts shall not exceed 16 feet in height, and fencing may be required to be opaque by the Planning Director or City Commission. C. When the club is located within a residential zoning district, there shall be no shows, tournaments or other activity which would generate more traffic than is normal to a residential area, unless access is provided from an arterial street as set forth in the Bozeman growth policy. If access is not provided from an arterial street, permission for such shows and activities shall be obtained from the City Commission. Permission shall be requested in a letter with a site sketch that explains the nature and duration of the activity and accommodations for spectators, additional parking and traffic control. This letter shall be submitted to the Clerk of the Commission for City Commission consideration. D. There shall be a landscaped 50-foot buffer strip adjacent to any residential zoning district, or as otherwise determined by the ADR or DRB. E. Hours of operation may be controlled by the City Commission. 18.40.210 COMMUNITY CENTER A. Within residential districts, Tthere shall be public street access on to an arterial or collector standard street within one block 600 feet of the entrance to a community center site. 124 Ordinance # 1761. page 40-17 B. There shall be a 20 foot landscaped yard adjacent to any residential property Community Centers located within residential districts shall, when any individual structure exceeds 5,000 square feet in gross floor area or exceeds the district’s allowed maximum height, provide a 20 foot landscaped yard between the building and adjacent residential uses. A structure separated from the adjacent residential uses by a parking lot, public street, watercourse, public open space, or similar separation is exempt from the additional yard width requirement. C. Each community center site with more than 40 parking spaces shall provide a minimum of 2 ingress/egress points which comply with Section 18.44.090. 125 Ordinance # 1761 page 42-1 CHAPTER 18.42 DEVELOPMENT STANDARDS 18.42.010 GENERAL STANDARDS A. Conformance. The design and development of all land uses shall conform to this title, adopted growth policies, any relevant adopted neighborhood or subarea plan, and other resolutions and regulations, including any and all amendments thereto. B. Natural Environment. The design and development of all land uses shall be properly related to topography, and should, to the extent possible, preserve the natural terrain, natural drainage, existing topsoil, trees and other existing vegetation. C. Lands Unsuitable for Development. Land which the Planning Director or City Commission has found to be unsuitable for development because of potential hazards such as flooding, land slides, excessive slope, rock falls, subsidence, high water table, presence of wetlands; or because of unreasonable burdens on the general public such as requirements for the excessive expenditure of public funds, environmental degradation, or congestion in the streets or roads shall not be used for building or residential purposes unless the hazards or excessive public burdens are eliminated or will be overcome by appropriate design and construction plans. Slopes of 25 percent or greater shall be presumed unbuildable unless proved otherwise by the developer. 18.42.020 NEIGHBORHOOD CENTERS To provide a neighborhood focal point, all residential subdivisions or planned unit developments, that are 10 net acres in size or greater, shall have a neighborhood center. Developments may be exempted from this requirement if every lot within the development is within one-half mile of an existing neighborhood center. Generally, the center shall be no less than one acre in size. The center shall be comprised of a park, square, green, plaza, transit stop, neighborhood commercial center, civic use or any combination of these. The following requirements shall apply to all neighborhood centers: A. The geographic center point of the neighborhood center shall be no further than 600 feet from the geographic center point of the development. This requirement may be waived in the following circumstances: 1. The development would create parcels that are all nonresidential; 2. The center is a neighborhood commercial center or is adjacent to a neighborhood commercial center; 3. The site is constrained by the presence of critical lands; 4. The site is part of an approved subarea plan that shows the center in a different location; or 5. The topography of the site presents physical constraints on the property. B. With the exception of civic and neighborhood commercial center uses, the developer shall be responsible for installing all center-related improvements as part of the required development improvements. Improvements shall be installed with each phase when a multi-phase project is developed. Required improvements shall be based on the definition of each feature found in Chapter 18.80, BMC, and/or City standards. C. The neighborhood center shall have frontage along 100 percent of its perimeter on public or private streets or roads. The City may consider and approve the installation of streets along 126 Ordinance # 1761 page 42-2 less than 100 percent, but not less than 50 percent, of the perimeter in accordance with Section 18.50.060. D With the exception of civic and neighborhood commercial center buildings and grounds, the center shall be considered a common area to be owned and maintained by the property owners or a property owners association. The property owners association could establish an improvement district to collect assessments to pay for the maintenance. E. Areas within neighborhood centers used for park, square, green and/or square, that meet the following criteria, may count towards park land dedication requirements subject to review and approval by the City Commission, after receiving a recommendation from the Bozeman Recreation and Parks Advisory Board: 1. The area is predominantly open space with enhanced natural features, but may contain amenities such as sidewalks, seating, drinking and ornamental fountains and public art; and 2. The area provides active and/or passive recreation opportunities. F. The neighborhood center may be used for limited stormwater retention/detention facilities if reviewed and approved by the City Engineer. However, any part of the center used for stormwater management shall not count towards park dedication requirements. 18.42.030 LOT A. Dimensions and Orientation. Lot size, width, shape and orientation shall be appropriate for the location and contemplated use of the development. In residential developments, a variety of lot sizes shall be provided to facilitate housing diversity and choice, and to meet the projected requirements of people with different housing needs. Lot designs with irregular shapes, narrow necks, points and flag shapes shall be permitted only when the developer can demonstrate that the proposed lot designs are necessary due to topography or other physical constraints. Each lot shall contain a satisfactory building site adequate for the uses permitted in its zoning district. Each lot shall conform to this title, any growth policies, any relevant neighborhood or subarea plan, where officially adopted, and to any applicable regulations of the Montana Department of Environmental Quality. B. Division by Rights-of-Way. No single lot shall be divided by a public street, alley, or public or private utility right-of-way or easement, which would reduce the amount of buildable land to less than the minimum lot size required by this title for the applicable zoning district. C. Double/Through and Reverse Frontage. Double/through frontage and reverse frontage lots shall be avoided except where essential to provide separation of residential development from arterial streets; to provide access to development adjacent to limited access streets; to overcome topography or other physical conditions; or to overcome specific disadvantages of existing design and orientation. Lots fronting on a street and an alley shall not be considered double/through or reverse frontage lots. D. Corner Lots. Corner lots shall have sufficient width to permit appropriate building setbacks from both streets and provide acceptable visibility for traffic safety. 1. Generally, homes on corner lots shall have the same orientation as homes on lots on the interior of the block, unless otherwise approved through an overall development plan. Covenants shall contain information regarding the orientation for all corner lots. E. Width. Lots shall have a width sufficient to allow normal construction without the construction encroaching on property lines, and shall comply with the building setback requirements of this title. 127 Ordinance # 1761 page 42-3 F. Depth. Except for individual lots for individual townhomes, lots used to meet the requirements of Chapter 17.02, BMC, and for modular lots as allowed by subsection 18.42.030.K of this chapter, no lot shall have an average depth greater than three times its average width. G. Side Lot Lines. Side lot lines shall be at substantially right angles to street or road lines and radial to curved street or road lines. I. Frontage. Unless otherwise allowed by this title, all lots will have frontage in compliance with §18.44.090.B, BMC to provide, among other things, adequate room for snow removal, lot access and utility easements. J. Civic Uses. If lots are reserved or identified for civic uses, these lots must be prominent sites at the termination of street vistas, or in the neighborhood center. K. Modular Lotting. To promote the development of diverse residential and commercial land uses, and to provide consumer choice and flexibility, a modular lotting system may be used when subdividing land. If a modular lotting system is used, the following requirements apply: 1. Lots shall generally be 25 feet in width; 2. Lots shall be no less than 125 feet and no more than 175 feet length; and 3. A water and sewer service shall be provided to every other lot, unless attached townhomes on individual lots are constructed, then a water and sewer services shall be provided for every lot. 4. Modular lots created under the provisions of this chapter shall remain in an ownership so that they comply with required zoning standards for area, width, etc. as required by §18.60.030, BMC. L. Exceptions. Commonly owned lots used for accessory uses (i.e., stormwater management, open space, utilities) are exempt from the provisions of this section. 18.42.040 BLOCKS A. Size and Orientation. Blocks shall be designed to assure a high level of multimodal connectivity, traffic safety, and ease of traffic control and circulation; to accommodate the special needs of the use contemplated; and to take advantage of the limitations and opportunities of the topography. B. Block Length. Block length shall not be designed, unless otherwise impractical, to be more than 400 feet in length or less than 300 feet in length. Block lengths can be longer than 400 feet if necessary due to topography, the presence of critical lands, access control, or adjacency to existing parks or open space. In no case shall a block exceed 1,320 feet in length. C. Block Width. Blocks shall not be less than 200 feet or more than 400 feet in width, except where essential to provide separation of residential development from a traffic arterial or to overcome specific disadvantages of topography and orientation. D. Rights-Of-Way for Pedestrians. Rights-of-way for pedestrian walks, not less than 10 feet wide, shall be required where deemed necessary to provide circulation or access to parks, open space, schools, playgrounds, shopping centers, transportation, and other community facilities. In addition, no continuous length of block shall exceed 600 feet without intersecting a street or pedestrian walk. Pedestrian walks shall also be installed at the end of cul-de-sacs where deemed appropriate. 1. Yards adjacent to pedestrian rights-of-way less than 30 feet wide shall be treated as corner side yards. Yards adjacent to pedestrian rights-of-way 30 feet wide or greater shall be treated as side yards; 128 Ordinance # 1761 page 42-4 2. The pedestrian walks shall be maintained by the adjacent property owner(s) or by the property owners association. The party responsible for maintenance of pedestrian walks shall be identified in the preliminary plat application; and 3. Pedestrian walks shall be constructed as a City standard sidewalk, and the provisions of §18.44.080, BMC shall apply. E. Developments which have clearly delineated blocks shall use block numbers or letters, and each block shall contain its own grouping of lot numbers. 18.42.050 UTILITIES A. Utilities shall be placed underground, wherever technically and economically feasible. Underground utilities, if placed in a street right-of-way, shall be installed after the street has been brought to grade and before it is surfaced. B. If overhead utility lines are used, they shall be located at the rear property line. C. Utility facilities shall be designed by utility firms in cooperation with the developer. The facilities are subject to all applicable laws, rules and regulations of the appropriate regulatory authorities. D. The developer shall provide adequate and appropriate utility easements in compliance with §18.42.060 of this chapter. 18.42.060 EASEMENTS A. Required Easements. Where determined to be necessary, public and/or private easements shall be provided for private and public utilities, drainage, vehicular or pedestrian access, etc. 1. In subdivisions, all easements shall be described, dimensioned and shown on the final plat in their true and correct location. 2. In all other developments, the proper easements documents shall be prepared for review and approval by the City of Bozeman, and filed at the County Clerk and Recorder’s Office. The easement documents shall be accompanied by an exhibit indicating the dimensions, and true and correct location, of all easements. 3. No lot shall be encumbered by a public or private utility easement in a way that would decrease the amount of buildable land to less than the area required by this title for the applicable zoning district. B. Private Utility Easements. Private utilities include, but are not limited to, natural gas, electricity, telephone, cable and fiber optic lines. The developer shall provide private utility easements necessary to extend private utilities to the development, and to provide for the construction and maintenance of private utilities within the development. 1. General. a. Building setbacks shall be coordinated with all provided utility easements. If a utility easement will be greater than the building setback required by this title, a note to that effect shall be placed on the final plat and/or final site plan as appropriate. b. Where a utility easement is to be located in an existing, dedicated right-of-way, an encroachment permit must be obtained from the local or state street or road department having jurisdiction. c. If placed in a City right-of-way, easements shall be in a location required by and agreed upon in writing by all of the appropriate utility companies and the City Commission. 2. Easement Size. 129 Ordinance # 1761 page 42-5 a. Front Yard Utility Easements. Front yard utility easements shall be 10 feet wide, and shall always be provided unless written confirmation is submitted to the Planning Department from ALL utility companies providing service indicating that front yard easements are not needed. b. Rear Yard Utility Easements. The provision of rear yard utility easements is not mandatory unless they are required by any or all of the utility companies to adequately serve the development. If provided, rear yard utility easements on each lot shall be 6 feet wide if adjacent to a public alley and 10 feet if not adjacent to a public alley. c. Side Yard Utility Easements. The provision of side yard utility easements is not mandatory unless they are required by any or all of the utility companies to adequately serve the development. If provided, the width of the side yard utility easement shall be determined on a case-by-case basis based on the needs of the utility companies. 3. Private Utility Plans. a. When the concurrent construction option will be used, based on the provisions of §18.74.030.D, BMC of this title, private utility plans shall be included with the preliminary PUD submittal. b. Private utility plans shall be provided with any plans and specifications submittals for the construction of new water, sewer or street infrastructure as specified in the City’s Design Standards and Specifications Policy. 4. No building shall be constructed that encroaches on a private utility easement unless written approval from ALL utility companies is provided to the Planning Department. C. Public Utility Easements. Public utilities include water, sewer and stormwater facilities that are dedicated to and maintained by the City of Bozeman. 1. A public utility easement shall be granted for all public utility mains not located within public street right-of-way. An easement shall be at least 30 feet wide for either one or two utility mains. An additional 10 feet of width is required for each additional main that occupies the easement. Wider easements may be required at the discretion of the City of Bozeman for large utility lines. 2. Public utility easements shall be provided for all meter pits and fire hydrants maintained by the City of Bozeman. 3. No permanent structures shall be placed within public utility easements unless an encroachment permit has been obtained from the City of Bozeman. D. Easements for Agricultural Water User Facilities. 1. Except as noted in subsection 2 below, the developer shall establish appropriate irrigation facility easements that: a. Are in locations of appropriate topographic characteristics and sufficient width to allow the physical placement and unobstructed maintenance of active open ditches or below ground pipelines. The easement shall facilitate the delivery of water for irrigation to persons and lands legally entitled to the water under an appropriated water right or permit of an irrigation district or other private or public entity formed to provide for the use of the water right; (1) The easements shall ensure the conveyance of irrigation water through the land to be developed to lands adjacent to or beyond the 130 Ordinance # 1761 page 42-6 development’s boundaries in quantities and in a manner that are consistent with historic and legal rights; and (2) A minimum easement width of 10 feet is required on each side of irrigation canals and ditches. b. Are a sufficient distance from the centerline of the irrigation facility to allow for construction, repair, maintenance and inspection of the ditch or pipeline; and c. Prohibit the placement of structures or the planting of vegetation other than grass within the irrigation facility easement without the written permission of the facility owner. 2. The developer need not establish irrigation facility easements as provided above if the following provisions were met or will be met via the subdivision process: a. The average lot size is one acre or less and the subdivider provides for disclosure, in a manner acceptable to the City Commission, that adequately notifies potential buyers of lots that are classified as irrigated land and may continue to be assessed for irrigation water delivery even though the water may not be deliverable; or b. The water rights are removed or the process has been initiated to remove the water rights from the subdivided land. If the water rights have been or will be removed from the land within the development it shall be denoted on the preliminary plat. If removal of water rights is not complete upon filing of the final plat, the subdivider shall provide written notification to prospective buyers of the intent to remove the water right and shall document that intent, when applicable, in agreements and legal documents for related sales transactions. 3 The realignment or relocation of active irrigation ditches or pipelines is discouraged. If an irrigation facility or points of diversions thereon is proposed to be realigned or relocated, the developer’s professional engineer shall certify, prior to final plat or final plan approval, that the water entering and exiting the realigned or relocated irrigation facility is the same quality and amount of water that entered or exited the facility prior to realignment or relocation. 4. Stormwater from a development shall not be discharged to an irrigation facility. 5. As land is converted from agricultural to urban uses, and irrigation ditches are no longer in use, the ditches shall be abandoned and filled. E. Other Easements. Public access easements for streets and trails shall be provided in accordance with the provisions of Chapters 18.44 and 18.50, BMC. 18.42.070 MUNICIPAL WATER, SANITARY SEWER AND STORM SEWER SYSTEMS A. General. All municipal water supply, sanitary sewer and storm sewer system facilities shall comply with the following requirements: 1. The developer shall install complete municipal water and sanitary sewer system facilities, or a system allowed by §18.38.030.D, BMC, and may be required by the City to install municipal storm sewer system facilities. These systems shall be installed in accordance with the requirements of State Department of Environmental Quality and the City of Bozeman, and shall conform with any applicable facilities plan. The City of Bozeman’s requirements are contained in the Design Standards and Specifications Policy and the City of Bozeman Modifications to Montana Public Works Standard Specifications, and by this reference these standards are incorporated into and made a part of these regulations. The developer shall submit plans and specifications for the proposed facilities to the City, and to the State Department of Environmental Quality, and shall 131 Ordinance # 1761 page 42-7 obtain their approvals prior to commencing construction of any municipal water, sanitary sewer or storm sewer system facilities. 2. The cutting of any City street shall be done in compliance with the City’s street cut policy. 3. When a proposed development adjoins undeveloped land, and municipal infrastructure mains would reasonably pass through the new development to the undeveloped land, municipal infrastructure mains shall be arranged to allow the suitable development of the adjoining undeveloped land. Municipal infrastructure mains within the proposed development shall be constructed to the boundary lines of the tract to be developed, unless prevented by topography or other physical conditions, in which case a subdivision variance must be approved by the City Commission. B. Municipal Water Supply System - Additional Requirements. Municipal water supply system facilities shall also apply with the following requirements: 1. When the City’s municipal water main is extended, the length of a dead end water main typically shall not exceed 500 feet in length, unless approved in writing by the City Engineer and the Water and Sewer Superintendent. 2. The length of service lines from the main to the structure may not exceed 150 feet in length, unless approved in writing by the City Engineer and Water and Sewer superintendent. 18.42.080 GRADING AND DRAINAGE A. The developer shall install complete drainage facilities in accordance with the requirements of the State Department of Environmental Quality and the City of Bozeman, and shall conform with to any applicable facilities plan and the terms of any approved site specific stormwater control plan. The City of Bozeman’s requirements are contained in the Design Standards and Specifications Policy and the City of Bozeman Modifications to Montana Public Works Standard Specifications, and by this reference these standards are incorporated into and made a part of these regulations. The developer shall submit plans and specifications to the City of Bozeman and to the State Department of Environmental Quality (if applicable), and shall obtain their approvals prior to commencing construction of any drainage system facilities. B. Provisions shall be made for the control and drainage of surface water around buildings. Generally, all lots and street boulevard areas shall be graded no lower than the back of curb or level of street, whichever is applicable, prior to final plat or final occupancy approval as appropriate. Exceptions may be granted by the City Engineer when adequate drainage facilities are provided. All drainage plans shall comply with the requirements of the International Building Code and International Residential Code as adopted by the City, and by this reference these standards are incorporated into and made a part of these regulations. C. Drainage systems shall not discharge into any sanitary sewer facility or agricultural water user facility. D. Stormwater retention or detention ponds may be located within public park land, but such areas shall not count towards the park land dedication requirement. Any stormwater ponds located on park land shall be designed, constructed and/or added to so as to be conducive to the normal use and maintenance of the park. Stormwater ponds serving multiple lots in separate ownership shall not be located on private lots or public right of way. Stormwater retention or detention ponds shall be maintained by the property owners association. E. The City Commission may require the developer to establish easements or other perpetual controls to prevent encroachment or disruption of drainageways or facilities. 132 Ordinance # 1761 page 42-8 F. Stormwater facilities shall generally not occupy more than one-third of a required front yard. G. All finish grades in landscaped areas shall comply with the provisions set forth in §18.48.050.L, BMC. H. Stormwater retention/detention facilities in landscaped areas shall be designed as landscape amenities. They shall be an organic feature with a natural, curvilinear shape. The facilities shall have 75 percent of surface area covered with live vegetation appropriate for the depth and design of the retention/detention facility, and be lined with native grasses, indigenous plants, wet root tolerant plant types and groupings of boulders to create a functional yet, natural site feature. A cross section and landscape detail of each facility shall be submitted with the final landscape plan for review and approval. Facilities with a slope up to and including 10% grade may be grassed and irrigated to blend into the adjacent landscaped area. 18.42.090 FIRE PROTECTION REQUIREMENTS All developments shall be planned, designed, constructed and maintained so as to minimize risk of fire and to permit the effective and efficient suppression of fires in order to protect persons and property. A. The placement of structures shall minimize the potential for flame spread and permit adequate access for fire fighting equipment; and B. Adequate fire fighting facilities shall be provided, including an adequate and accessible water supply and water distribution system. 1. National Fire Protection Association (NFPA) standards for hydrant systems shall be met. 2. City of Bozeman’s requirements as contained in the Design Standards and Specifications Policy and the City of Bozeman Modifications to Montana Public Works Standard Specifications shall apply. 18.42.100 WATERCOURSE SETBACK Where a development is crossed by or is adjacent to a watercourse, the developer shall mitigate the impacts of the development on the watercourse. This mitigation may not be less restrictive than the requirements of the Bozeman Floodplain Regulations or any other applicable regulation of this title. The purpose of this mitigation is bank stabilization; sediment, nutrient and pollution removal; and flood control. A. Setback for Developments Granted Preliminary Plan or Plat Approval Prior to July 10, 2002. These provisions shall apply to all developments granted preliminary plan or plat approval prior to July 10, 2002, including applicable subdivision exemptions: 1. Setbacks. A minimum 100-foot setback shall be provided along both sides of the East Gallatin River. A minimum 35 foot setback shall be provided along both sides of all other watercourses. a. A portion of the required setback, immediately adjacent to the ordinary high water mark, shall be left in a natural vegetative state as follows: (1) East Gallatin River – 50 feet (2) Other Watercourses – 5 feet b. No fence, residential or commercial structure, fill material, parking or other similar improvements shall be located within required watercourse setbacks. c. All watercourse setbacks shall be measured from the ordinary high water mark as defined in §18.80.2160, BMC. When no ordinary high water mark is discernible, setbacks shall be measured from the top of the streambank. 133 Ordinance # 1761 page 42-9 B. Setbacks for Developments Granted Preliminary Plan or Plat Approval On or After July 10, 2002. These provisions shall apply to all developments granted preliminary plat or plan approval on or after July 10, 2002. 1. In the event a site with an existing development, that is subject to §18.42.100.A, BMC, is submitted to the City for a review subject to Chapters 18.34, 18.36 and 18.60, BMC after July 10, 2002, the proposed development shall comply with §18.42.100.B, BMC to the extent reasonably feasible given the existing site conditions. The final approval body for the proposed development shall determine the extent that is reasonably feasible, subject to any appeal provisions that may apply. Such administrative relief shall not reduce setbacks below those provided for in Section A. It is the intent of this subsection that full compliance with the terms of §18.42.100.B, BMC shall be achieved over time without unduly burdening existing development. 2. In addition to any relaxation of watercourse setbacks provided by subsection 18.42.100.B.1 of this section, nothing in this section shall prohibit an owner of affected property from: a. Applying for a variance to dimensional standards of the watercourse setbacks as allowed by and subject to the requirements of Chapter 18.66, BMC; b. When applicable, seeking a deviation to dimensional standards of the watercourse setback as allowed by and subject to the requirements of Chapters 18.28, 18.30 or 18.36, BMC; c. Combining two or more lots to assemble a larger and more usable parcel; d. Petitioning the Montana Department of Fish, Wildlife and Parks and the Gallatin County Water Conservation District to seek the reclassification of the relevant watercourse as an irrigation facility not subject to the requirements of this section; e. After receipt of required permits relocating the watercourse; or f. Pursuing any other lawful means of relief from the effects of this section. 3. Setbacks. Unless otherwise specified in §18.42.100.B.5, BMC, the following setback requirements shall be met: a. East Gallatin River. A minimum 100-foot setback shall be provided along both sides of the East Gallatin River. b. Sourdough/Bozeman Creek and Bridger Creek. A minimum 75-foot setback shall be provided along both sides of Sourdough/Bozeman and Bridger Creeks. c. Other Watercourses. A minimum 50 foot setback shall be provided along both sides of all other watercourses. d. All required watercourse setbacks shall be extended as necessary to address these additional requirements. (1). The setback shall extend to the edge of any delineated 100-year floodplain if the floodplain is larger than the setbacks established in §18.42.100.B.3, BMC; (2). The setback shall include immediately adjacent wetlands (i.e. fringe). The buffer width shall be extended by the width of the wetland; (3). Areas with a slope greater than 33% do not count towards the width of the setback; and 134 Ordinance # 1761 page 42-10 (4) The setback shall include connected wetlands. The buffer width shall be extended by a minimum of 50 feet beyond the perimeter of the connected wetlands. e. All watercourse setbacks shall be measured from the ordinary high water mark as defined in §18.80.2160, BMC. When no ordinary high water mark is discernible, setbacks shall be measured from the top of the streambank. 4. No newly constructed residential or commercial structure, addition to an existing structure, fence, deck, fill material (other than that required for exempt uses), parking lot or other impervious surfaces, or other similar improvements shall be located within required watercourse setbacks, unless approved through, and in conformance with, a variance or deviation process as authorized in this title. 5. Exceptions. The watercourse setback is divided into two zones. Zone 1 consists of the 60 percent of the setback closest to the watercourse, and Zone 2 consists of the 40 percent of the setback furthest from the watercourse. a. On-site stormwater treatment facilities may be located in Zone 2. b. Trails and trail-related improvements may be placed within the required watercourse setback subject to the following provisions: (1) Trails, and trail-related improvements such as benches and trail signage, may be placed in Zone 2; (2) Limited, non-looping developed spur trails to the water’s edge may cross all zones. Benches and limited informational/interpretive signage may be placed in Zone 1 at the terminus of spur trails; (3) Due to topography, avoidance of wetlands, or other geographical constraints portions of non-spur trails may need to be placed within Zone 1. Trail construction within Zone 1, inclusive of watercourse crossings and spur trails, per each side of the watercourse may not exceed the length of 300 percent of the width of the applicable watercourse setback per 500 lineal feet of watercourse; (4) All trails must be constructed to minimize bank instability, sedimentation, nutrient and pollution runoff. Trails shall be aligned to minimize damage to plant and wildlife habitat; and (5) Trails crossing the watercourse and trail-related bridge structures may be located within all zones provided that the appropriate local, state and federal permits are obtained. c. Streets, sidewalks, utility lines or similar public construction may be permitted within all zones for the purpose of crossing a watercourse or protecting public health and safety. The following practices shall be observed: (1) Crossings shall be minimized to the greatest extent feasible; (2) Crossings with direct angles (90 degrees) shall be used to the greatest extent feasible instead of oblique crossing angles; (3) Construction shall be capable of withstanding 100-year flood events; (4) The subdivision grading and drainage plan shall be designed to prevent the discharge of untreated stormwater into a watercourse; and (5) A bank stabilization plan for all public construction watercourse crossings shall be prepared and approved by the City prior to site preparation and installation of the improvement(s). 135 Ordinance # 1761 page 42-11 d. Outlets from stormwater treatment facilities may pass through all zones in order to discharge to the receiving watercourse, provided that all required permits are obtained. e. Control of noxious weeds is required and activities required within limits outlined in any approved noxious weed control plan may occur in all zones. 6. Setback Planting. A setback planting plan shall be prepared by a qualified landscape professional, and shall be reviewed and approved by the Planning Department prior to the commencement of development or site preparation. The plan shall include a schedule, and plantings shall be depicted on the plan as follows: a. Zone 1: Zone 1 shall be planted with new or existing native materials suited for a riparian area based on the following calculations. One hundred percent of the disturbed areas of Zone 1 shall be planted with a ground cover of native riparian sedges, forbs and grasses suited for the area. In addition, a minimum of one shrub for every 10 linear feet and one tree for every 30 linear feet of the watercourse shall be required along each side of the watercourse. Grouping or clumping of trees and shrubs as appropriate in a riparian area is encouraged. Species that are appropriate to the soil hydrologic conditions (wetness of soil and depth to the water table) should be used. Tree and shrub species selected shall be suitable for the climate and for planting in a riparian area with an emphasis on native species. The Natural Resources Conservation Service (NRCS), the Montana Native Plant Society and the Gallatin Local Water Quality District (LWQD) are good sources of landscaping materials and/or landscaping information. b. Zone 2: Disturbed areas of Zone 2 shall be planted with new or existing native grasses suited for the area c. Maintenance of the watercourse setback landscaping is required. If it can be demonstrated that irrigation is present for the trees and shrubs, and fencing is provided for the trees and shrubs, the number of required trees may be reduced to one tree for every 60 linear feet and one shrub for every 20 linear feet of the watercourse along each side of the watercourse. d. Planting materials are exempt from the size requirements of §18.48.050.G.3 of this title. e. To prevent soil erosion and the invasion of noxious weeds, the watercourse setbacks on all land proposed for development shall be covered with existing vegetation or shall be seeded with native grasses as soon as seasonally feasible or prior to commencement of any site development or site preparation work. f. Native shall mean those plants which are native to the Gallatin Valley. g. Use native grasses, forbs, sedges and other herbaceous plants in areas of disturbance (e.g. bridges, culverts, utilities installation, trails) within the watercourse setback. Native woody plantings are required in all zones in disturbed and undisturbed areas. 7. Except for as otherwise allowed in §18.42.100.B.5 and 6, BMC, no disturbance of soils and existing vegetation shall occur in all zones. C. Other Provisions. 1. The watercourse setback shall be depicted on all preliminary and final plats and plans. 136 Ordinance # 1761 page 42-12 2. These provisions do not apply to agricultural uses, including lands enrolled in the conservation reserve program (CRP), activities, and structures that existed prior to the effective date of these regulations. Any agricultural uses, activities or structures established after the effective date of these regulations shall comply with these regulations. An agricultural use, activity or structure shall be considered abandoned if not used for agricultural purposes for more than 180 consecutive days. 18.42.110 RIDGELINES AND VIEWSHEDS For the purpose of having structures blend more naturally into the landscape rather than being a prominent focal point, ridgeline protection areas are established. These areas are defined in Chapter 18.80 and are identified and designated based on topographic characteristics. The Bozeman Ridgeline Map identifies areas with a high likelihood of meeting the standards for ridgelines. A. All buildings located within a ridgeline protection area shall be set back from the ridgeline a distance not less than 3 times its height above grade. The distance of the setback shall be measured perpendicular from the ridgeline. 1. Exception. In the event a building permit is sought for a lot approved or created prior to the effective date of this ordinance, January 1, 2004, the proposed development shall comply with this section to the extent reasonably feasible given the lot dimensions, orientation, and other characteristics. The final approval body for the proposed development shall determine the extent that is reasonably feasible and may relax the special setback required by this section, subject to applicable appeal provisions. Such administrative relief shall not reduce setbacks below those required elsewhere in this title. 18.42.120 MAIL DELIVERY If mail delivery will not be to each individual lot within the development, the developer shall provide an off-street area for mail delivery within the development in cooperation with the United States Postal Service. It shall not be the responsibility of the City to maintain or plow any mail delivery area constructed within a City right-of-way. 18.42.130 FENCES, WALLS AND HEDGES A. Location and Height. Except as provided in §18.44.100, BMC, fences, walls and hedges, in any district may be located on lot lines provided such fences, walls and hedges comply with the following height requirements: 1. Do not exceed 6 feet in height in any required rear or required side yard. Fences exceeding 6 feet in height shall be subject to the minimum yard requirements of the district in which such fences are located. Decorative post caps may exceed the height limit by no more than 1 additional foot. Fences in excess of 6 feet in height require a building permit before installation may commence. Fences may not exceed 8 feet in height. 2. Do not exceed 4 feet in height in any required front yard or any portion of a required corner side yard that is forward of the rear edge of the building facade nearest the corner side yard. 3. Fences used in an agricultural pursuit to retain stock animals or for public safety shall be excepted. 4. The height of fences located in the B-3 district shall meet the requirements of this section for any provided, not required, yards. B. Relation to Linear Parks. Fences located in the rear or side yard setback of properties adjoining any Bozeman linear park shall have a maximum height of 4 feet. 137 Ordinance # 1761 page 42-13 C. Construction and Maintenance. Every fence or wall shall be constructed in a substantial, workman-like manner and of substantial material reasonably suited for the purpose for which the fence or wall is proposed to be used. Every fence or wall shall be maintained in a condition of reasonable repair and shall not be allowed to become and remain in a condition of disrepair, damage or unsightliness, or constitute a nuisance, public or private. Any such fence or wall which is, or has become, dangerous to the public safety, health or welfare, or has become unsightly through improper maintenance or neglect is a public nuisance and the Building Official shall commence proper proceedings for the abatement thereof. D. Barbed Wire and Electric Fences. 1. No barbed wire or similar sharp fencing or electric fences shall be permitted, except in R-S districts; except that barbed wire or other similar sharp fencing materials may be used on the top of security fences in M-1 and M-2 districts. 2. When electrically charged fences are used in an R-S district, such fences shall be posted with warning signs at intervals not to exceed 150 feet where such fences are adjacent to public rights-of-way. E. Measuring Fence and Wall Height. In case of a fence erected on top of a retaining wall, the height shall be measured from the grade of the high side of the wall. F. “Finished” Side Out. Any fence or wall constructed so as to have only one elevation “finished,” which shall be defined as not having its supporting members significantly visible, shall be erected such that the finished elevation of the fence is exposed to the adjacent property. G. Fencing of Utilities and Outdoor Storage Areas. 1. All utility substations, wells, storage facilities or other utilities shall be screened from view by a wall, fence, hedge or landscape screen. 2. All storage for commercial operations shall be conducted within a completed enclosed building or within an area completely enclosed, except for access points, by a wall, fence, hedge or landscape screen at least 6 feet in height. 18.42.140 OFF-STREET LOADING BERTH REQUIREMENTS A. Affected Uses. Every hotel/motel with restaurant, conference center, restaurant, department store, freight terminal or railroad yard, hospital or sanitarium, industrial plant, manufacturing establishment, retail establishment, storage warehouse or wholesale establishment, and all other structures devoted to similar mercantile or industrial pursuits, which has an aggregate gross floor area of 15,000 square feet or more shall provide off-street truckloading or unloading berths in accordance with the following table: 1. Any office building 100,000 square feet or larger shall have at least one off-street loading berth. Table 42-1 Square Feet of Aggregate Gross Floor Area Devoted to Such Use 15,000 square feet up to and including 40,000 square feet 1 40,001 square feet up to and including 100,000 square feet 2 For each additional 100,000 square feet 1 additional B. Standards for Off-Street Loading Facilities. All off-street loading facilities shall conform to the following standards: 138 Ordinance # 1761 page 42-14 1. The first loading berth shall be at least 70 feet in length. Additional berths required shall be at least 45 feet in length unless certified by the property owner in writing that additional loading activity will take place exclusively with small delivery vans in which case the berth(s) shall be at least 25 feet in length. All loading berths shall be at least 12 feet in width and 14 feet in height, exclusive of aisle and maneuvering space. 2. Such space may occupy all or any part of any required yard space, except front and exterior side yards, and shall not be located closer than 50 feet to any lot in any residential zone unless separated from such zone, except at the accesses, by screening not less than 8 feet in height. 3. Sufficient room for turning and maneuvering vehicles shall be provided on the site so that vehicles shall cross a property line only by driving forward. 4. Each loading berth shall be accessible from a street or alley or from an aisle or drive connecting with a street or alley, without traversing a residential district. 5. The loading area, aisles and access drives shall be paved so as to provide a durable, dustless surface and shall be so graded and drained so as to dispose of surface water without damage to private or public properties, streets or alleys. 6. Bumper rails shall be provided at locations where needed for safety or to protect property. 7. No regular repair work or servicing of vehicles shall be conducted in a loading area. 8. Off-street loading facilities shall be located on the same site with the use for which the berths are required. 9. If more than one use is located on a site, the number of loading berths provided shall be equal to the sum of the requirements prescribed in this title for each use. If more than one use is located on a site, and the gross floor area of each use is less than the minimum for which loading berths are required, but the aggregate gross floor area is greater than the minimum for which loading berths are required, off-street loading berths shall be provided as if the aggregate gross floor area were used for the use requiring the greatest number of loading berths. 10. Off-street loading facilities for a single use shall not be considered as providing required off-street loading facilities for any other use. 11. At the time of initial occupancy, major alterations or enlargement of a site, or of completion of construction of a structure or of a major alteration or enlargement of a structure, there shall be provided off-street loading berth requirements subject to the provisions of Chapter 18.74, BMC. The number of loading berths provided for a major alteration or enlargement of a site or structure shall be in addition to the number existing prior to the alteration or enlargement. 12. Space allocated to any off-street loading berth shall not be used to satisfy the space requirements for any off-street parking facility. 18.42.150 LIGHTING A. Purpose. 1. Provide lighting in outdoor public places where public health, safety and welfare are potential concerns; 2. Protect drivers, bicyclists and pedestrians from the glare of non-vehicular light sources that shine into their eyes and thereby impair safe travel; 139 Ordinance # 1761 page 42-15 3. Protect neighbors and the night sky from nuisance glare and stray light from poorly aimed, placed, applied, maintained or shielded light sources; 4. Protect and maintain the character of Bozeman; 5. Prevent excessive lighting and conserve energy; and 6. Provide adequate lighting for safe pedestrian and bicycle travel. B. General. 1. With the exception of street lighting, lighting is not required. If installed, all lighting shall comply with the requirements of §18.42.150, BMC. 2. Unless otherwise approved through a planned unit development, this ordinance shall apply to all lighting for subdivisions, land uses, developments and buildings. In addition, any site modification that requires a certificate of appropriateness, site plan review or reuse application will necessitate compliance for all existing and proposed lighting on the site. 3. The provisions of this section are not intended to prevent the use of any design, material or method of installation or operation not specifically prescribed herein, provided any such alternate has been approved by the Planning Director. The Planning Director may approve any such proposed alternate provided he/she finds that it: a. The lighting provides at least approximate equivalence to the applicable specific requirements of this section; and b. The lighting is otherwise satisfactory and complies with the intent of this section. C. Street Lighting. Street lighting consists of street lighting and pathway intersection lighting, and shall comply with the following requirements: 1. General. a. All street lighting shall be operated and maintained through the creation of a new SILD, through the annexation to an existing SILD or through some other equivalent means approved by the City of Bozeman. The application to create or annex to an existing SILD shall be submitted to the City within 2 months of preliminary approval of the development. The approval to create or annex to an SILD shall be granted prior to final plat for a subdivision or Occupancy if a final plat is not required. b. Street lighting shall be installed per 18.74.030.B, BMC. c. Individual yard lights on private property shall not be used for street lighting. 2. Street Lights at Intersections. a. Illumination Requirements. (1) Single Installation. The illumination requirement for an intersection street light, where only one light is required, shall be determined from Table 42-2 based on the functional classification of the street upon which the light is located. (2) Multiple Installation. For all intersections where more than one street light is required, all lights shall be within the same range for measured lumens. The illumination requirement shall be determined from Table 42-2 for the functional classification of the leg of the intersection with the highest requirement. 140 Ordinance # 1761 page 42-16 b. Non-Signalized Intersections. A street light shall be installed at each non- signalized street intersection with the exceptions contained in subsections (1) and (2) below. (1) At intersections where the width of one or more of the approaches is greater than or equal to 50 feet, as measured to the back of curb or edge of pavement, then two street lights shall be installed on diagonally opposite corners. (2) At the intersection of two local streets a street light may be omitted if its installation would violate the spacing criteria contained in Table 42-2. c. Signalized Intersections. At signalized intersections where all approaches are narrower than 50 feet, as measured to the back of curb or edge of pavement, two street lights shall be installed on the diagonally opposite corners. At signalized intersections where the width of one or more of the approaches is greater than or equal to 50 feet, four street lights shall be installed, one on each corner. 3. Spacing of Street Lights. In addition to intersection locations, street lights shall be spaced along streets in accordance with Table 42-2. Table 42-2 Functional Classification Through Lanes Pedestrian Conflict Maintained Lumens (Minimum Maintained Average Values) Spacing Arterial 4/2 High 33000-22500 225/225 4/2 Low 22500-13500 300/275 Collector 4/2 High 22500-13500 250/225 4/2 Low 22500-8000 300/275 Local 2 Low 9500-8000 N/A1 Arterial - Commercial Center 4/2 High 33000-22500 200/175 Collector - Commercial Center 4/2 High 22500-13500 225/175 Local -Commercial Center 2 High 9500-8000 150 1Street lights are only required at intersections on local streets. 4. Street Light Location and Placement of Equipment. In addition to spacing requirements, the following layout criteria shall be used: a. When a street light location falls near an unlit intersection, the light shall be located at the intersection; b. Street lights shall be located at property lines to the greatest extent possible, but not in conflict with other utility service providers; c. Pole spacing along a street may vary from the criteria of Table 42-2 by up to 15 percent. For the uniformity of appearance, the variance in spacing between adjacent spans should not be more than 15 percent; d. All proposed streets within the proposed subdivision, having a curve of 300 feet or longer in length, shall have a street light in the middle of the horizontal curve or as required by the City Engineer; e. A street light shall be placed at the terminal ends of center median islands having trees and/or other fixed objects not having a breakaway design for speeds of 25 miles per hour or greater; f. Wiring for street lights shall be underground; 141 Ordinance # 1761 page 42-17 g. Additional street lights may be required by the City Commission when potential traffic hazards are identified during plan review; and h. For streets that are wider than 70 feet (from back of curb) the required street lights shall alternate on either side of the street. 5. Street Light Support Structures. The ballasts; pole type, strength and anchor bolts; and pole foundation shall be appropriate for the proposed lighting and shall be installed per the manufacturer’s recommendations. Mounting heights shall be measured from grade and shall comply with the requirements of Table 42-3. Table 42-3 Maintained Lumens (Minimum Maintained Average Values) Mounting Height 9500-8000 25 feet 22500-9500 35 feet 33000-22500 38 feet 6. Pathway Intersection Lighting. Pathway lights shall be installed at all intersections of pathways and streets, located within the proposed development or along existing streets or roads abutting the development, if said intersection is located in areas other than lighted intersections. All pathway lights shall comply with City of Bozeman specifications. Table 42-4 Average Horizontal Illuminance at Pathway in Maintained Footcandles Mixed vehicle and pedestrian 2.0 Pedestrian only 1.0 Source: Roadway Lighting (RP-8-00), Illuminating Engineering Society of North American, 2000. D. Site Lighting. 1. Parking Lot Lighting. Table 42-5 Basic1 Security2 Minimum Horizontal Illuminance in Maintained Footcandles 0.2 0.5 Minimum Vertical Illuminance in Maintained Footcandles 0.1 0.25 Uniformity Ratio, Maximum : Minimum 20:01 15:00 Source: Parking Lot Lighting, Illuminating Engineering Society of North American, 1998. 1Basic lighting provides for the safety of customers and employees during business hours, and for the security of on-site, outside storage of goods and/or materials. 2Security lighting provides for the safety of employees during nonbusiness hours, and for the security of on-site, outside storage of goods and/or materials. 2. Building Entrances. Illuminance for building entrances (including commercial, industrial, institutional and municipal) shall average 5.0 maintained footcandles. 3. Car Dealership Lighting. Table 42-6 Area Maximum Illuminance on Pavement (in Maintained Footcandles) Uniformity Ratio Maximum : Minimum Main Business Districts Adjacent to roadway 10 - 20 5:01 142 Ordinance # 1761 page 42-18 Other rows 5 - 10 10:01 Entrances 5 - 10 5:01 Driveways 2 - 3 10:01 Secondary Business Districts Adjacent to roadway 5 - 10 5:01 Other Rows 2.5 - 5 10:01 Entrances 2.5 - 5 5:01 Driveways 1 - 2 10:00 Source: Lighting for Exterior Environments, Illuminating Engineering Society of North American, 1998. 4. Service Station or Gas Pump Area Lighting. Table 42-7 Area Description Average Illuminance on Described Area (in Maintained Footcandles) Approach with dark surroundings 1.5 Driveway with dark surroundings 1.5 Pump island area with dark surroundings 5 Building facades with dark surroundings 2 Service areas with dark surroundings 2 Landscape highlights with dark surroundings 1 Approach with light surroundings 2 Driveway with light surroundings 2 Pump island area with light surroundings 10 Building facades with light surroundings 3 Service areas with light surroundings 3 Landscape highlights with light surroundings 2 Source: Lighting for Exterior Environments, Illuminating Engineering Society of North American, 1998. 5. Site Lighting Support Structures. The ballasts; pole type, strength and anchor bolts; and pole foundation shall be appropriate for the proposed lighting and shall be installed per the manufacturer’s recommendations. Height shall be measured from grade. Except as allowed in Sections E and G, light poles for parking lot lighting shall not exceed 25 feet. 6. Site Lighting Installation and Maintenance. a. For new installations, electrical feeds for fixtures mounted on poles shall be run underground, not overhead. b. Poles supporting lighting fixtures for the illumination of parking areas and located directly behind parking spaces, shall be placed a minimum of 5 feet outside the paved area, or on concrete pedestals at least 30 inches high above the pavement, or suitably protected by other approved means. c. Lighting fixtures and ancillary equipment shall be maintained so as always to meet the requirements of this ordinance. 7. Miscellaneous Site Lighting Specifications. Except as otherwise allowed in Sections E and G, all lighting shall comply with the following requirements: a. All outdoor lighting, whether or not required by this ordinance, shall be aimed, located, designed, fitted and maintained so as not to present a hazard to drivers or pedestrians by impairing their ability to safely traverse and so as not to create a nuisance by projecting or reflecting objectionable light onto a neighboring use or property. 143 Ordinance # 1761 page 42-19 b. All outdoor lighting fixtures shall be shielded in such a manner that no light is emitted above a horizontal plane passing through the lowest point of the light emitting element, so that direct light emitted above the horizontal plane is eliminated. c. Except for residential lights, street lighting, pathway intersection lighting and security lighting, all lighting shall be turned off between 11:00 p.m. and 6:00 a.m. Exceptions shall be granted to those businesses which operate during these hours; such lighting may remain illuminated only while the establishment is actually open for business. d. Vegetation screens shall not be employed to serve as the primary means for controlling glare. Rather, glare control shall be achieved primarily through the use of such means as cutoff fixtures, shields and baffles, and appropriate application of fixture mounting height, wattage, aiming angle and fixture placement. e. All outdoor lighting shall be designed and located such that the maximum illumination measured in footcandles at the property line shall not exceed 0.3 onto adjacent residential properties and 1.0 onto adjacent commercial properties and public rights-of-way. f. Externally illuminated wall-mounted and pole signs shall be lighted by fixtures mounted at the top of the sign and aimed downward; ground-mounted sign lighting may only be used for monument style signs. Fixtures used to illuminate signs shall be aimed so as not to project their output beyond the sign. g. Floodlights, spotlights or any other similar lighting shall not be used to illuminate buildings or other site features unless approved as an integral architectural element on the development plan. On-site lighting may be used to accent architectural elements but not to illuminate entire portions of buildings. Where accent lighting is used, the maximum illumination on any vertical surface or angular roof surface shall not exceed 5.0 average maintained footcandles. Building façade and accent lighting shall not be approved unless the light fixtures are carefully selected, located, aimed and shielded so that light is directed only onto the building façade and spillover light is eliminated. (1) Directional fixtures used to illuminate flagpoles (State, United States and/or foreign nations) may project their output beyond the flagpole. h. Lights that flash, move, revolve, rotate, scintillate, blink, flicker, vary in intensity or color, or use intermittent electrical pulsation are prohibited. i. Translucent awnings and canopies used for building accents over doors, windows, etc., shall not be internally lit (i.e., from underneath or behind). j. Search lights, laser source lights or any similar high-intensity light shall not be permitted, except in emergencies by police and fire personnel or at their direction, for meteorological data gathering purposes, or for special events if a permit is obtained from the Planning Director. E. Sports and Athletic Field Lighting. Lighting for sports and athletic fields may need to exceed illumination standards for general recreational needs in order to meet higher standards required for play. The City Commission may approve relaxations of these lighting standards provided that the following minimum standards are met: 1. Fixtures shall be at least 70 feet in mounted height measured from grade. 144 Ordinance # 1761 page 42-20 2. If floodlights are used, they shall not be aimed above 62 degrees and should use internal louvers and external shields to help minimize light pollution. 3. Fixtures shall be designed and aimed so that their beams fall within the primary playing area and the immediate surroundings, so that off-site direct illumination is significantly restricted (spillover levels at the property line shall not exceed 0.3 footcandles). 4. Lighting shall be extinguished no later than 1 hour after the event ends. F. Lighting Specifications for All Lighting. Light fixtures and standards shall be compatible with the surrounding area, the subdivision or site design, and the development’s character and/or architecture. 1. Luminaires (Light Fixtures). Except as otherwise allowed in Sections E and G, all luminaires shall comply with the following requirements: a. In all light fixtures, the light source and associated lenses shall not protrude below the edge of the light fixture, and shall not be visible from adjacent streets or properties. b. Fixtures shall be of a type and design appropriate to the lighting application. c. For lighting horizontal areas such as roadways, sidewalks, entrances and parking areas, fixtures shall meet IESNA “full-cutoff” criteria (no light output emitted above 90 degrees at any lateral angle around the fixture). d. As needed, fixtures shall be equipped with or be modified to incorporate light directing and/or shielding devices such as shields, visors, skirts, internal louvers or hoods to redirect offending light distribution and/or reduce direct or indirect glare. e. The installation of any mercury vapor light fixture or lamp for use as outdoor lighting is prohibited, except that until November 21, 2006 (the fifth anniversary date of the effective day of this ordinance), this provision shall not apply to any replacement bulb. G. Historic Lighting. The City Commission may relax lighting standards and requirements, with the exception of illumination levels, for the provision of historic lighting in the neighborhood conservation overlay district. Historic lights shall be proposed as an integrated part of an overall development plan. The historic preservation planner shall review and approve the proposed lighting for historic appropriateness. H. Post Installation Inspection. The City of Bozeman reserves the right to conduct post- installation nighttime inspections to verify compliance with the requirements of this ordinance, and if appropriate, to require remedial action at no expense to the City. I. Compliance Monitoring. If the City of Bozeman finds that a lighting installation creates a safety or personal security hazard, the person(s) responsible for the lighting shall be notified in writing and required to take remedial action within 30 days. J. Nuisance Glare and Inadequate Illumination Levels. When the City of Bozeman finds that a lighting installation produces unacceptable levels of nuisance glare, skyward light, excessive or insufficient illumination levels, or otherwise varies from this ordinance, the City may notify the person(s) responsible for the lighting and require appropriate remedial action within 30 days. K. Nonconforming Lighting. With the exception of street lighting, security lighting fixtures or a security lighting installation in use on January 1, 2004, that does not conform to this ordinance and that is not otherwise required to be brought into compliance pursuant to this ordinance, shall be required to be in compliance 5 years after the date of enactment of this ordinance. Any other lighting fixture or lighting installation existing on the effective date of this ordinance that 145 Ordinance # 1761 page 42-21 does not conform to the requirements of this ordinance shall be considered as a legal conformance. 18.42.160 OUTDOOR STORAGE A. All materials, supplies, merchandise or other similar matter not on display for direct sale, rental or lease to the ultimate consumer or user shall be stored within the confines of a 100 percent opaque wall or fence not less than 6 feet tall. B. No storage of any type shall be permitted within any required yard, and shall be subject to § 18.40.150, BMC. C. All areas designated for vehicle and equipment storage shall be screened from view from the street and adjacent properties as per subsection A above. Vehicle and equipment storage areas shall not be subject to parking lot paving or landscape requirements, but shall be subject to drainage detention requirements and appropriate dust control requirements. 18.42.170 TRASH AND GARBAGE ENCLOSURES A permanent enclosure for temporary storage of garbage, refuse and other waste materials shall be provided for every use, other than single-household dwellings, duplexes, individually owned townhouse or condominium units, in every zoning district, except where a property is entirely surrounded by screen walls or buildings. Trash enclosures shall be constructed so that contents are not visible from a height of 5 feet above grade from any abutting street or property. Trash enclosures shall comply with the following regulations: A. Location. Trash enclosures, surrounding standard steel bins (dumpsters), shall be located on the site for convenient pickup service, and the location shall be shown on required site plans. Trash enclosures shall not be located in required front yards, and shall be situated so that containers can be pulled straight out of the enclosure or so the sanitation truck can back straight into it. The location of all trash enclosures shall be subject to review and approval by the City Sanitation Department. B. Construction. Trash enclosures shall be constructed of solid or ornamental pierced masonry walls or other appropriate materials, with a solid concrete floor sloped for drainage and maintenance of sanitary conditions. Enclosures shall be architecturally compatible with the principle structure. Enclosures shall be of sufficient height to conceal contents, including containers, but in no case shall be less than 4 feet in height above grade. C. Exception. A garbage enclosure is not required for dumpsters accessed via an alley. 18.42.180 PROVISION OF RESTRICTED SIZE LOTS AND UNITS A. Purpose. This section establishes the requirements relating to the creation of lots for provision of moderate and low income housing. 1. The City’s adopted growth policy indicates the City’s desire to have a well balanced community with a range of housing available to its citizens. This includes housing for persons of low and moderate incomes. 2. The 2003 Housing Needs Assessment established the need for additional low and moderate income housing opportunities. 3. The City Commission has adopted an affordable housing policy giving direction for certain actions to help ensure the opportunity for affordable housing. 4. The City intends to create opportunities for greater low and moderate income housing opportunities by ensuring a supply of lots meeting minimum size requirements and providing other related means of addressing housing need. 146 Ordinance # 1761 page 42-22 5. Development of the minimum sized lots shall largely depend on the actions of the private land development process. 6. It is the intention of the City to establish certain complimentary financial programs to aid qualifying parties to obtain housing. These programs are separate from the requirements of this title. 7. Compliance with this section meets the requirements of annexation agreements enacted prior to the date of this ordinance that require the provision of affordable housing. B. Applicability. Lands subdivided after the effective date of this ordinance shall meet the requirements of this section and shall have not less than a minimum net density of six units per acre when subdivided if: 1. The total area of such lands being subdivided for residential purposes in all phases is five acres or more in size; or 2. The land being subdivided is not intended for final development under the provisions of the R-S, Residential Suburban zoning district described in §18.16.010, BMC. C. Number of Restricted Size Lots Required. Every residential subdivision meeting the requirements of subsection B above shall have a minimum of 10 percent of the buildable net acreage dedicated to Restricted Size Lots (RSLs). A RSL shall not be greater than 5,000 square feet for single household detached dwellings and 3,000 square feet for single household attached dwelling units. The RSL designation shall be recorded with the final subdivision plat in a manner that will appear on a title search and include reference to the sunset provisions of this section. The requirements of this section may be met through any one or a combination of the following options. The option or combination of options shall be specified at the time of preliminary plat. A change of option affecting more than two lots after the preliminary plat has been approved shall constitute a material change to the subdivision and shall require reapproval of the subdivision by the City. 1. After creation of lots through the subdivision process and recording of the RSL restrictions with the final plat, offering for sale to any willing buyer the RSL lots for development as housing. 2. In lieu of designating the required number of RSLs for market sale with the final plat, the owner may provide a fee-simple transfer of title of buildable RSLs to the City. For the purpose of determining the number of RSLs required by this subsection the fee simple transfer of one RSL shall be equivalent to providing three RSLs for market sale. The City will utilize donated RSLs or the proceeds of sales of donated RSLs only for affordable housing. a. A fee simple transfer RSL can be provided within the annexed land being subdivided or may be provided off-site as allowed by subsection 3 below. The subdivision containing the off-site fee simple transfer RSL cannot be comprised on more than 50 percent RSLs without prior City Commission approval. The off-site fee simple transfer RSL shall be established and transferred to the City not later than the time of final plat approval of the subdivision responsible for creating the fee simple transfer RSL. 3. In lieu of designating RSLs within the land being subdivided, the owner may provide for comparable off-site RSLs at a ratio of 1:1. The subdivision containing the off-site RSLs shall not be comprised of more than 50 percent RSLs without prior City Commission approval. The off-site RSLs shall be established not later than the time of final plat approval of the subdivision responsible for creating the RSLs. 147 Ordinance # 1761 page 42-23 4. At time of final plat, in lieu of supplying the required number of RSLs, the owner may pay a “cash in lieu” fee to the City. The payment shall be calculated as the appraised value per square foot of developed land within that specific subdivision at a time not sooner than 30 days prior to the time of final plat approval. The cost per square foot shall be multiplied by 5,000 in single household districts and by 3,000 in multi-household districts when smaller or multi-household aggregated lot for each required RSL. The appraisal cost shall be born by the owner of land being subdivided. The City will use payments in lieu of RSLs only for affordable housing. 5. Within multi-household zoning districts and with approval from the City Commission the area required may be assembled into larger lots to allow construction of affordable housing complexes. D. Restrictions on Building Size. Dwellings constructed on RSLs are subject to the size restrictions of §18.16.030.C, BMC. Dwellings built on RSLs shall be known as Restricted Size Units (RSU). E. Automatic Termination Provisions. The provisions of this section shall be of no more effect after November 24, 2008, unless such date is extended by the City Commission by amendment to this section to establish a new date. 148 Ordinance #1761. page 46-1 CHAPTER 18.46 PARKING 18.46.010 GENERAL PROVISIONS The purpose of these standards is to provide functional parking areas adequate to the needs of users, create shaded areas within parking lots, reduce glare and heat build up, provide visual relief within paved parking areas, emphasize circulation patterns and enhance the visual environment. In achieving these purposes this chapter interacts with the requirements of Chapter 18.48, BMC The design of off-street parking shall primarily be the responsibility of the developer and shall consider traffic circulation, intended landscaping, pedestrian access and circulation, and other purposes of this title. A. Floor Area. 1. The term “floor area,” for the purpose of calculating the number of off-street parking spaces required, shall mean 85 percent of the gross floor area, as defined in Chapter 18.80, BMC. However, at the election of the property owner, floor area shall mean the gross floor area, as defined in Chapter 18.80, BMC, minus the following: a. Window display areas; b. Storage areas; c. Areas used for incidental repair of equipment used or sold on the premises; d. Areas occupied by toilets and restrooms, kitchens or breakrooms; e. Areas occupied by public utility facilities; f. Areas occupied by dressing rooms, fitting or alteration rooms incidental to the sale of clothing; g. Areas occupied by stairways and elevators; and h. Corridors connecting rooms or suites of rooms. Such election shall be made in writing to the Planning Director, shall be signed and acknowledged by the owner, and shall be filed with the Planning Director prior to the issuance of a building permit for such building. The owner shall also be responsible for certifying other information upon which parking requirements may be based, such as seats, and the number of employees on maximum working shift. 2. Where applicable, the number of spaces required in §18.46.040 of this chapter will be the total of the spaces required for the component activities of certain uses, each calculated separately. B. Change of Use or Occupancy of Buildings. With any change of use or occupancy of any building or buildings, including additions to buildings, that may require more parking, an occupancy permit is required and shall not be issued until such additional parking spaces, as required by this title, are provided for. C. Improvement Schedule. All parking area improvements to include surfacing, drainage, walkways, lighting, landscaping, screening, traffic control, etc. shall be installed according to the provisions of Chapter 18.74, BMC. D. Stacking of Off-Street Parking Spaces. Required parking spaces shall be located so as to preclude stacking of off-street parking spaces, with the exception of single household dwellings and individual townhouse units, and duplexes with physically separated individual driveways. Physical separation is provided when at least one of these options are provided: individual garage doors for each interior parking space, a vegetated planter not less than four feet in width between the 149 Ordinance #1761. page 46-2 parking spaces in the driveway area, or a wall not less than four feet in height and length is provided between the parking area in the driveway and dividing the garage entrance. Generally, not more than two cars may be stacked. E. No Parking Permitted in Required Front or Side Yards. Required parking spaces shall not be located in any required front or side yard, except that detached single household dwellings and townhouses, and duplexes with physically separated individual driveways, may have one space located within a driveway area in the required front yard for each parking space located directly in front of the driveway area and outside of the required front yard. F. Parking is permitted within required rear yards. 18.46.020 STALL, AISLE AND DRIVEWAY DESIGN A. Parking Dimensions. The following shall be the minimum parking space dimensions: See also Figure 18.46.020, Appendix A. Table 46-1 Width1 Length Angle Standard Disabled6 Compact5 Standard Disabled Compact5 Aisle Width 90 9' 13' 8' 18/202 18/202 16' 263 60 9' 13' 8' 18/202 18/202 16' 18/234 45 9' 13' 8' 18/202 18/202 16' 15/234 Notes: 1As measured by a line perpendicular to the stall line at a point on the outside end of the stall, except when the stall is on the inside edge of a curve, in which case the point of measurement shall be on the inside end of the stall. 2Eighteen feet if measured from a curb on the inside edge of the stall; 20 feet if measured from a painted line on the inside edge of the stall. Stall length variations are subject to approval by the City Engineer. 3For 90-degree parking, aisles are two-way; 4First number refers to one-way traffic and the second number to two-way traffic. If the aisle is needed as a fire lane, a 20-foot minimum is required. 5Unless otherwise approved, all parking spaces shall be of standard width and length. In any parking facility containing 20 or more parking spaces, a maximum of 25 percent of the provided parking spaces may be reduced in size for small cars, provided these spaces shall be clearly identified with a sign permanently affixed immediately in front of each space containing the notation, “Compacts Only.” Where feasible, all small car spaces shall be located in one or more contiguous areas and/or adjacent to ingress egress points within parking facilities. Location of compact car parking spaces shall not create traffic congestion or impede traffic flows. 6The first disabled accessible parking stall shall meet the standards of 18.46.040.D.2.a. 7If parking stalls within the interior of an individual residential garage space are counted toward a development’s required parking needs, then they shall meet the standard parking stall width of 9 feet and the standard parking stall length of 20 feet with a minimum of one foot clear on all exterior sides of the stall. B. Within Structures. The off-street parking requirements may be furnished by providing spaces so designated within the principal building or accessory parking structure. However, no building permit shall be used to convert the parking structures into a dwelling unit or living area or other activity until other adequate provisions are made to comply with the required off-street parking provisions of this title. C. Circulation Between Bays. Except in the case of one- to three-household dwellings and individual townhouse units, parking areas shall be designed so that circulation between parking bays occurs within the designated parking lot and does not depend upon a public street or alley. Turning radii between bays and additional backup length for dead end aisles shall conform with requirements of the Uniform Fire Code. 150 Ordinance #1761. page 46-3 D. Backing Requirements. All required parking must have adequate back-up maneuverability as specified in Table 46-1. The aisle width calculation may incorporate the width of the public right-of-way. Except in the case of one- to four-household dwellings and individual townhouse- style units with individual garages, parking area design which requires backing into the public street is prohibited. With the exception of residential development, parking area design which requires backing into the public alley is prohibited. E. Parallel Parking Spaces. Parallel parking spaces shall be a minimum of 24 feet in length and 7 feet in width measured from the inside edge of a curb or the inside edge of the asphalt if curbing is not present. F. Surfacing. Except for one-household development on individual lots, all areas intended to be utilized for permanent parking space and driveways shall be paved with concrete or asphaltic concrete, or approved pavers, to control dust and drainage. All proposed parking areas and driveway improvements shall require a grading and drainage plan approved by the City Engineer. Areas shall be paved with concrete or asphaltic concrete or approved pavers; or an alternative surfacing method such as pervious pavement may be used subject to review and approval by the City Engineer. Surfacing methods which minimize stormwater runoff and provide for functional parking and circulation are encouraged. 1. However, paving shall not be required for permitted and conditional uses in the R-S zoning districts when all of the following circumstances exist: 1a. The use is required to provide fewer than fifteen parking spaces and no loading spaces under the provisions of this section; 2b. The lot or tract on which the use is located is not adjacent to a paved street or road; and 3c. The applicant shall enter into an improvements agreement with the City agreeing that the lot shall be paved within nine months of the time an adjacent roadway is paved. G. Striping. Except for one- to three-household dwellings and individual townhouse units, aAll parking stalls shall be marked with white or yellow painted lines not less than 4 inches wide, except for one- to three-household dwellings and individual townhouse units,. H. Lighting. Any lighting used to illuminate an off-street parking area shall be in complyiance with the lighting restrictions in standards of §18.42.150, BMC. I. Signs. No sign shall be so located as to which restricts the sight lines and orderly operation and traffic movement within any parking area. All signs shall conform to the requirements of Chapter 18.52, BMC. J. Parking Lot Curbing. 1. Except for individual townhouse units and one- to three-household dwellings, aAll open off-street parking areas and driveways shall have a 6-inch by 6-inch perimeter concrete curb around the entire parking lot, including driving access ways, except for individual townhouse units and one- to three-household dwellings. Continuous concrete curbing shall be built according to standards provided by the City Engineer. Unless otherwise approved, the perimeter curb shall be six inch by six inch concrete. 2. Concrete pindown wheel stops may be permitted as an alternative to continuous concrete curbing in front of parking spaces which front on the perimeter of the parking lot. However, continuous concrete curbing as described above shall be provided in all situations where deemed necessary by the City Engineer to control drainage and soil erosion. 151 Ordinance #1761. page 46-4 3. Alternative perimeter treatment may be permitted adjacent to snow storage areas subject to the approval of the City Engineer. 4. Requirements for perimeter curbing shall not preclude opportunities for shared access between adjacent parking lots. K. Protruding Vehicles. All onsite parking stalls which abut property lines shall be designed and constructed such that parked vehicles shall not protrude over property lines. L. Pedestrian Facilities in Parking Lots. Concrete sidewalks a minimum of 3 feet in width shall be provided between any existing or proposed building and adjacent parking lot. Where sidewalk curbs serve as wheel stops, an additional 2 feet of sidewalk width is required. M. Snow Removal Storage Areas. Snow removal storage areas shall be provided sufficient to store snow accumulation on site. Such areas shall not cause unsafe ingress/egress to the parking areas, shall not cause snow to be deposited on public rights-of-way, shall not include areas provided for required parking access and spaces, and shall not be placed in such a manner as to damage landscaping. All snow removal storage areas shall be located and designed such that the resultant stormwater runoff is directed into landscaped retention/detention and water quality improvement facilities as required by the Engineering Department, or in compliance with any adopted storm drainage ordinance or best practices manual. N. Parking and Stacking for Drive In/Drive Through Facilities. Required parking and stacking spaces for waiting automobiles shall provide a minimum of 2 stalls and 6 spaces for stacking per lane unless a traffic summary shows that fewer spaces may be required. These spaces shall not in any manner inhibit on-site or off-site vehicular circulation. O. Ownership/Leasehold. Required parking lots shall be owned or leased by the owner or lessee of the building or use being served by such parking. Such parking lots shall be maintained as a parking lot so long as the building and/or use served is in operation or until another approved parking area is established for such building or use. P. Storm Water Drainage. Storm water drainage from parking lots shall be directed into landscaped detention/retention facilities and water quality improvement facilities as required by the Engineering Department, or in compliance with any adopted storm drainage ordinance and/or best practices manual adopted by the City. 18.46.030 MAINTENANCE OF PARKING AREAS It shall be the joint and separate responsibility of the lessee and owner of the principal use, uses or building to maintain in a neat and adequate manner, the parking space, accessways, striping, landscaping and required fences or screening. A. Use of Required Parking Areas for Parking Only. Required off-street parking spaces in any district shall not be utilized for open storage, sale or rental of goods, storage of inoperable vehicles, except when permitted as a temporary use. B. Parking Spaces Identified and Maintained. All residential occupancies shall provide required off- street parking spaces. When enclosing a carport or garage for storage or living purposes, an affidavit shall be submitted to the Planning Director identifying the required parking spaces necessary to comply with §18.46.040, BMC below. 18.46.040 NUMBER OF PARKING SPACES REQUIRED The following minimum number of off-street, paved parking spaces for motor vehicles and bicycles shall be provided and maintained by ownership, easement and/or lease for and during the life of the respective uses hereinafter set forth. When calculation of the required parking results in a fraction of a parking space being required, a whole space shall be provided. 152 Ordinance #1761. page 46-5 A. Residential Uses. 1. Minimum Requirements. The number of spaces shown in table 46-2 shall be provided. In addition to the number of spaces required from the table 46-2, the required number of disabled parking stalls shall also be provided as required by table 46-6. All site plans submitted for permit purposes shall identify parking space allocations. a. One parking space for each 24 uninterrupted linear feet of available street frontage usable for on-street parking directly adjacent to a lot may be deducted from the total parking spaces required for a development. The number of on- street spaces calculated shall not exceed the number of dwellings on the lot. The width of drive accesses, designated non-parking areas, vision triangles, and similar circumstances shall not be considered to be available for the purpose of on-street parking space. Table 46-2 Dwelling Types Parking Spaces Required per Dwelling Accessory dwelling unit 1 Efficiency unit / Lodginghouse 1.25 One-bedroom 1.5 Two-bedroom 2 Three-bedroom 3 Dwellings with more than three bedrooms 4 Group homes and community residential facilities 1 space per potential guest room Bed and breakfast 1 space/rental unit Manufactured Home 2 2. Adjustments to Minimum Requirements. a. Affordable Housing. When calculating the amount of required parking for affordable housing, as defined in Chapter 18.80, BMC, if the project is guaranteed for use as affordable housing for a minimum period of 20 years and the use as affordable housing is subject to long term monitoring to ensure compliance and continued use as affordable housing, Required parking spaces shall be calculated based on number of bedrooms outlined in Table 46-2, but shall not exceed 2 spaces per unit. b. Residential Uses in Mixed-use Projects. In order to utilize this section, the long term availability of the nonresidential parking spaces upon which the use of this section was based shall be assured to the residents of the project. For the purposes of this section, residential parking shall be calculated as if on-street parking were available for all dwellings. The use of this section does not preclude the use of other sections of this title which may have the effect of reducing the required amount of parking. When calculating the amount of required parking for residential uses within a mixed-use project the amount of parking may be reduced subject to one of the following provisions: (1) A reduction of not more than 50 percent of the required number of spaces for residential uses may be taken, provided that the number of spaces which are reduced do not exceed 30 percent of the total spaces 153 Ordinance #1761. page 46-6 provided for the total project uses. Not withstanding the provisions of this subsection a minimum of 0.75 parking space per dwelling unit shall be provided; or (2) If the nonresidential portions of the project provide 300 percent or more of the number of off-street parking spaces required by the residential units, then the number of off-street parking spaces required per residential unit shall be zero, provided that the occupants of the residential units are permitted use of the provided nonresidential parking spaces. B. Nonresidential Uses. 1. Minimum Requirements. The number of spaces shown in table 46-3 shall be provided. Spaces are not required to be provided free to the user. In addition to the number of spaces required from table 46-3, the required number of disabled parking stalls required by table 46-6 shall also be provided. All site plans submitted for permit purposes shall identify parking space allocations. When a use is not included in table 46-3, the Planning Director shall determine the appropriate classification for the purpose of required parking. 2. Maximum Parking. Provision of parking spaces in excess of 125 percent of the minimum number of spaces required for the net floor area in §18.46.040.B, BMC is not permitted. Table 46-3 Use Type Off-Street or Off-Road Parking Spaces Required Automobile sales 1 space per 200 square feet of indoor floor area; plus 1 spaces per 20 outdoor vehicle display spaces Automobile service and/or repair station 2 spaces per service stall, but no less than 4 spaces Automobile washing establishment a. Automatic drive-through b. Self-service a. 3 spaces or 1 for each employee on maximum shift; plus stacking space b. 2 spaces per stall not including washing or drying spaces Bank, financial institutions 1 space per 300 square feet of floor area Bowling alley 42 spaces per alley; plus 2 spaces per billiard table; plus Church 1 space per 4 six persons of maximum occupancy load (as identified in the International Building Code) for main assembly hall, public assembly areas and classrooms Community or recreation center 1 space per 200 square feet of floor area Court clubs (racquetball, handball, tennis) 1 space per 200 square feet of floor area; plus 3 spaces per court Dancehalls, skating rinks or similar uses 1 space per 300 square feet of floor area Day care centers 1 space per 200 square feet of floor area staff member plus 1 space per 15 children permitted Elderly (senior citizens) housing 1 space per unit Furniture stores over 20,000 square feet 3 spaces per 1,000 square feet of floor area 154 Ordinance #1761. page 46-7 Use Type Off-Street or Off-Road Parking Spaces Required Golf courses 1 space per 200 square feet of main building floor area; plus 1 space for every 2 practice tees in driving range; plus 4 spaces per each green in the playing area Hospitals 1 space per bed Medical and dental offices 4 spaces for each full time equivalent doctor or dentist; plus 1 space for each full time equivalent employee Manufacturing and industrial uses 1 space per 1,000 square feet of floor area, plus 1 space per 2 employees on maximum working shift Motels, Hotels Restaurants, bars, dining rooms b. Commercial area c. Public assembly areas 1.1 spaces per each guest room; plus 1 space per employee on maximum shift; plus spaces for accessory uses as follows: a. 1 space per 60 square feet of floor area b. 1 space per each 400 square feet of floor area c. 1 space for each 5 seats based upon design capacity, except that total off-street or off-road parking for public assembly may be reduced by 1 space for every 4 guest rooms Nursing homes, rest homes or similar uses 4 spaces; plus 1 space for each 3 beds; plus 1 space for each employee on maximum shift Offices (except medical and dental) 1 space per 250 square feet of floor area with a minimum of 4 Outdoor sales (plant nurseries, building materials, equipment rental and similar) 1 space per 500 square feet of sales and /or display area. The size of the sales and/or display area shall be determined on a case by case basis. Restaurants, cafes, bars and similar uses 1 space per 50 square feet of indoor public serving area; plus 1 space per 100 square feet of outdoor (patio) area Retail store and service establishments 1 space per 300 square feet of floor area Sales sites; model homes 1 space per 150250 square feet of model floor areas; plus 1 space per employee Schools Elementary and/or Junior High 1.5 spaces for each classroom, library, lecture hall and cafeteria; plus 1 space for each 3 fixed seats in the area of public assembly, or 1 space for each 2125 square feet of area available for public assembly if fixed seats are not provided Schools a. Senior High b. Business or similar school a. 1.5 spaces for each classroom or lecture hall; plus 1 space per each 5 students; plus 1 space for each non-teaching employee; plus 1 space per each 3 fixed seats in the area of public assembly, or 1 space per 2125 square feet of area available for public assembly if fixed seats are not provided b. 1 space for each 1.25 students Theater, Auditorium or similar 1 space per 4 seats based upon place of assembly design capacity Warehousing, storage or handling of bulk goods 1 space per 1,000 square feet of floor area devoted to storage of goods; plus appropriate spaces to suport accessory office or retail sales facilities at 1 space per 300 square feet of floor are 3. Adjustments to Minimum Requirements. To implement the City’s adopted growth policy, adjustment of parking requirements within certain areas of the City is desired. Use of this section shall not be considered as joint use of parking or off-site parking regulated by §18.46.050 and §18.46.060, BMC nor shall the use of this section preclude the use of other sections of this title which may have the effect of reducing the required amount of on-site parking. a. Neighborhood Commercial. Within zoning districts implementing a Neighborhood Commercial growth policy designation or the B-3 zoning district, the parking requirements for non-residential uses may be reduced. Table 46-4 155 Ordinance #1761. page 46-8 Use Maximum Allowable Reduction Retail 40 percent Restaurant 50 percent Office 20 percent All Others 30 percent Transit Availability An additional 10 percent reduction may be taken in circumstances where the development is within 4800 feet of a developed and serviced transit stop. b. Community Commercial. Within zoning districts lying within a commercial node, as defined in Chapter 18.80, and implementing a Community Commercial growth policy designation, the parking requirements for nonresidential uses may be reduced. Table 46-5 Use Maximum Allowable Reduction Retail 1020 percent Restaurant 2030 percent Office 10 percent All Others 10 percent Transit Availability An additional 10 percent reduction may be taken in circumstances where the development is within 4800 feet of a developed and serviced transit stop. C. Exceptions to These Parking Requirements. Because some situations (i.e., existing lots which have no landscaping, irregular lots, lots with topographic difficulties, etc.) would benefit from an alternative to the required maximum parking areas; because the community’s appearance could benefit from additional landscaping, streetscaping and sculptural elements; and because parking exceptions and/or landscaping would encourage development within existing City boundaries; the following alternatives may be permitted. These alternatives may be proposed by the developer for review by the ADR staff. Such proposals may be approved based on a determination that such alternatives meet the following requirements and will not create a congested on-street parking situation in the vicinity of the proposal. 1. Landscaping in Lieu of Parking. Except in the B-3 district, property owners have the option of requesting the deletion of up to 5 required spaces or 10 percent of the required parking spaces, whichever is less, if 350 square feet of landscaping, trees or streetscaping is installed on the property for each space so deleted. This shall not decrease the amount of landscaping that would have been required with full parking, but shall be in addition to such landscaping. This option shall be approved by the ADR staff. These improvements must be placed in the public right-of-way or yards directly facing the right-of-way. 2. Exceptions and Modifications to Parking Requirements in B-3 District. Where all or part of the required parking spaces can not be provided for a proposed use in the B-3 District, either through ownership or lease of the necessary land, the petitioner may satisfy the parking requirements by providing an equivalent cash-in-lieu payment according to the following provisions: a. No building permit shall be issued, nor shall any use of property be initiated, unless a satisfactory cash-in-lieu payment is received by the Department of Finance; 156 Ordinance #1761. page 46-9 b. The Parking Commission shall review and consider all requests for cash-in-lieu payments and furnish a written and dated certificate, signed by the Parking Commission Chairman, authorizing cash-in-lieu payments. A copy of this certificate shall be presented to the Chief Building Official and Planning Director before a building permit is issued or the use instituted; c. For each required parking space not provided, payment shall be made to the City Finance Department as specified by standard payment requirements established by the Bozeman Parking Commission; d. All real property assessed by special improvement district (SID) No. 565, or other similarly adopted improvement districts designed to provide additional parking spaces within the B-3 district, shall not be required to provide additional parking spaces beyond those required at the time of the SID adoption, provided the use of the real property and improvements remains unchanged from the initial assessments of SID No. 565, or other similarly adopted improvement districts; (1) In the event that a new use or an expansion is initiated on any portion of real property or improvements subsequent to the assessments for SID No. 565 or other similarly adopted improvement districts, then parking space requirements shall be satisfied prior to initiation of those new or expanded uses. D. Disabled Accessible Parking Spaces. 1. Disabled parking spaces shall be provided subject to federal standards enumerated in the Americans with Disabilities Act (ADA) dated January 26, 1992, and Federal Standard 795, (Uniform Federal Accessibility Standards) dated April 1, 1988, Chapter 4 (Accessible Elements and Spaces: Scope and Technical Requirements). Each disabled parking space shall also be accompanied by a sign stating “Permit Required $100 Fine”. See Figure 18.46.040.D in Appendix A. 2. All parking lots and facilities shall be subject to current International Building Code guidelines for accessibility, and shall contain a minimum number of disabled accessible parking spaces as set forth in the table below: Table 46-6 Total Parking in Lot Required Minimum Number of Accessible Spaces Total Parking in Lot Required Minimum Number of Accessible Spaces 1 to 25 1 201 to 300 7 26 to 50 2 301 to 400 8 51 to 75 3 401 to 500 9 76 to 100 4 501 to 1000 2 percent of total 101 to 150 5 1001 and over 20 plus 1 for each 100 over 1000 151 to 200 6 a. The first accessible parking stall provided, and one in every eight accessible spaces provided thereafter, shall have an aisle 8 feet wide (rather than 5 feet) and shall be signed “van accessible.” b. Accessible spaces shall be located as near as practical to a primary entrance(s) and shall be designated as those spaces closest to the primary entrance(s) to a facility. Parking spaces and access aisles shall be level with slopes not exceeding 1:50 in all directions and shall be maintained in an ice and snow free condition. c. The minimum number of accessible parking spaces shall be in addition to any other required parking spaces. 157 Ordinance #1761. page 46-10 3. All accessible parking spaces shall be designated as reserved for the disabled by a sign showing the symbol of accessibility at each space. Such signs shall not be obscured by a vehicle parked in the space. Signs and symbols painted on the pavement as the only means of identification do not meet this requirement. See Figure 18.46.040.D in Appendix A. a. Raised signs shall be located at a distance no greater than 5 feet from the front of each accessible space and shall be subject to review and approval by the Planning Department. 4. Provision of an accessible path of travel from each disabled accessible parking space to the entrance of the facility shall include ramped access where necessary and an unencumbered minimum 3-foot wide walk, sidewalk or ramps. The accessible path of travel shall be a paved, smooth surface, free of defects or design features that would restrict, inhibit or unreasonably impede the movement of a physically disabled individual. a. The least possible slope shall be used for any ramp. The maximum slope of a ramp in new construction shall be 1: 12, cross slopes shall not exceed 0.25 inch per foot. The maximum rise for any run shall be 30 inches. 5. Exceptions: Group R occupancies, per the most recently adopted International Building Code definition, containing three or less dwelling units or congregate residences accommodating ten persons or less. 6. Prior to occupancy, the applicant or their representative shall certify compliance with the requirements of subsection D of this section. E. Bicycle Racks Parking Required. All site development, exclusive of those qualifying for sketch plan review per Chapter 18.34, BMC, shall provide adequate bicycle parking facilities to accommodate bicycle-riding residents and/or employees and customers of the proposed development. The number of bicycle parking spaces shall be at least 10 percent of the number of automobile parking stalls required by Tables 46-2 and 46-3 but shall in no case be less than two. 1. Bicycle parking facilities will be in conformance with standards recommended by the Bozeman Bicycle Advisory Board City’s long range transportation plan. 2. Required bicycle parking shall be provided in a safe, accessible and convenient location. Directional signage shall be installed when bicycle parking facilities are not readily visible from the street, sidewalk, or main building entrance. Installation of bicycle parking shall allow for adequate clearance for bicycles and their riders. 3. Bicycle parking may be provided in a common area to serve multiple buildings. The common area must be within 100 feet of each served building. 4. Covered bicycle parking is encouraged. 18.46.050 JOINT USE OF PARKING FACILITIES A. Up to 80 percent of the parking facilities required by this chapter for a church, civic center, performing arts center, or for an auditorium incidental to a public or parochial school may be supplied with the off-street parking facilities of the following daytime uses: banks, business offices, retail stores, personal service shops, household equipment or furniture shops, clothing or shoe repair or service shops, manufacturing, wholesale and similar uses. B. Shared parking may be requested if parking can be provided to serve two (2) or more individual land uses without conflict or encroachment. The Planning Director may make a determination for shared parking arrangements based on a traffic survey or traffic impact study for the site(s) based on the following: 158 Ordinance #1761. page 46-11 1. At a minimum, a traffic survey or traffic impact study must examine for all potential uses: trip generation, hours of operation, quantity of required parking spaces, quantity of spaces that will be filled during peak hour periods, and any unusual events that may occur during the year that will exceed the average parking requirement. The study must indicate that adequate parking exists to meet the demand of potential uses served as well as meet technical requirements as specified by the Planning Director. 2. The parties sharing parking spaces shall enter into a long-term joint use agreement revocable with City Commission approval, running with the term of the designated uses. C. Conditions Required for Joint Use. 1. The building or use for which application is being made to utilize the off-street parking facilities provided by another building or use shall be located within 1,000 feet of such parking facilities as measured by the route of travel from the nearest parking space to the commonly used entrance of the principal use served; 2. The applicant shall show that there is no substantial conflict in the operating hours of the two buildings or uses for which joint use of off-street parking facilities is proposed; and 3. A properly drawn legal instrument, executed by the parties concerned for joint use of off-street parking facilities, duly approved as to form and manner of execution by the City Attorney, shall be filed with the Clerk of the Commission and recorded with the County Clerk and Recorder. 18.46.060 OFF-SITE PARKING Any off-site parking which is used to meet the requirements of this title shall be reviewed by the Planning Director for compliance with this title and shall be subject to the conditions listed below. A. Off-site parking shall be developed and maintained in compliance with all requirements and standards of this title; B. Reasonable access from off-site parking facilities to the use being served shall be provided; C. The site used for meeting the off-site parking requirements of this title shall be under the same ownership as the principal use being served, under public ownership, or shall have guaranteed permanent use by virtue of a perpetual lease filed with the Clerk of the Commission and the County Clerk and Recorder; D. Off-site parking for one-household and two-household dwellings shall not be permitted; E. Off-site parking for multiple household dwellings shall not be located more than 100 feet from any commonly used entrance of the principal use served; F. Off-site parking for nonresidential uses shall not be located more than 1,000 feet from the commonly used entrance of the principal use as measured by the route of travel from the nearest parking space to the commonly used entrance of the principal use served and shall not be located in residential districts; and G. Any use which depends upon off-site parking to meet the requirements of this title shall maintain ownership or provide evidence of a long-term lease agreement, revocable with City Commission approval, running with the term of the designated use, for parking utilization of the off-site location. 159 Ordinance #1761. page 46-12 G. Any use which depends upon off-site parking to meet the requirements of this title shall maintain ownership or provide evidence of a long-term lease agreement, revocable with City Commission approval, running with the term of the designated use, for parking utilization of the off-site location. 160 Ordinance #1761. page 52-1 CHAPTER 18.52 SIGNS 18.52.010 INTENT AND PURPOSES It is the intent and purpose of this chapter to promote the health, safety and welfare of the residents and visitors of the City of Bozeman by regulating and controlling the size, location, type, quality of materials, height, maintenance and construction of all signs and sign structures not located within a building for the following reasons: A. To preserve the Bozeman area’s natural scenic beauty; B. To contribute to inviting entrances into Bozeman by eliminating clutter associated, in part, with the unrestricted proliferation of signs, lights and stringed devices; C. To encourage area beautification through creative, interrelated design of signage, landscaping, buildings, access and parking that enhances the community’s built and natural environment; D. To give all businesses an equal opportunity to have a sign that will help people find the services they need; and E. To ensure that pedestrians and motorists are protected from damage or injury caused or partly attributable to the distractions and obstructions which are caused by improperly situated signs. The City Commission intends to provide a reasonable balance between the right of an individual to identify their business and the right of the public to be protected from the visual discord that results from the unrestricted proliferation of signs. Sections 18.28.070 and 18.30.080, BMC establish certain exemptions, and alternative procedures utilizing design review. The deliberations and decisions of the design review shall be directed to accomplish the intent and purpose of this section. It is determined that the regulations contained herein are the minimum necessary to further the interests of this title. 18.52.020 SIGN PERMIT REQUIREMENTS If a sign requiring a permit under the provision of this chapter is to be placed, constructed, erected or modified on a zone lot, the owner of the lot shall secure a sign and building permit prior to the construction, placement, erection or modification of such a sign. Furthermore, the property owner shall maintain in force, at all times, a permit for such sign. No permit of any kind shall be issued for an existing sign or proposed sign unless such sign is consistent with the requirements of this chapter. 18.52.030 PROHIBITED SIGNS All signs not expressly permitted under this chapter, or exempt from regulation, are prohibited in the City. Such signs include, but are not limited to: A. Portable signs (except as allowed under Title 12, Chapter 22, BMC); B. Roof signs; C. Revolving signs; D. Beacons, spot lights; E. Flashing, blinking, or animated signs, or LED or other electronic messaging signs except for time and temperature or incidental signs as defined in Chapter 18.80, BMC; F. Pennants, streamers, wind socks, pinwheels, or similar items; G. Stringed flags; H. Inflatable signs and tethered balloons (except as permitted per §18.52.040, BMC); and 161 Ordinance #1761. page 52-2 I. Signs located in public rights-of-way (except for those permitted in §18.52.050.C and §18.52.060.D.4, BMC). 18.52.040 PERMITTED TEMPORARY AND SPECIAL EVENT SIGNS Temporary and special event signs, such as banners, tethered balloons and inflatable signs, but excluding those subject to §18.52.050, BMC, shall be allowed only as follows: A. Special event signs are permitted in the zones described in §18.52.060.A and §18.52.060.B, BMC. B. Applicants for temporary signs shall apply for, and have approved, a temporary sign permit C. All temporary signs shall comply with size, height, and location requirements of this chapter. D. For special commercial events, temporary signs shall be displayed for a consecutive period not to exceed fifteen days, for a maximum of thirty days per calendar year, from January 1 to December 31. There shall be a period of at least seven days between each fifteen day display period. E. Grand opening temporary signs may be may be displayed for an period not to exceed 60 days, additional temporary signs shall not be allowed until the next calendar year. Only one grand opening temporary shall be permitted for the life of the business. A subsequent grand opening banner may be permitted when business ownership has transferred to another owner, or when the business moves to a new location on a different zone lot. F. Temporary signs that identify a new business may be displayed until the business erects a permanent sign, only if the business is in the process of obtaining a permanent sign, or 60 days, whichever comes first. If the business has had a temporary sign in this instance, the business will be allowed 30 more days of temporary signage, but not a grand opening temporary sign. G. Itinerant vendors shall receive information about allowable temporary signs at the time they apply for a business license, but no permit is required if the itinerant vendor is operating less than 7 days. H. Temporary signs that are seasonal in nature, such as garden greenhouses, boat showrooms, or ski rental, may apply for a long term temporary sign which may be approved for a period not to exceed 180 days. I. Businesses may promote events in the community, such as the County Fair or Sweet Pea, by applying for and receiving a temporary sign permit for their location. When notice of the event and non-sponsorship related information occupies more than 75 percent of the banner area, such a temporary sign will not count in their temporary and special event signage limit of 30 days a year. 18.52.050 SIGNS EXEMPT FROM PERMIT REQUIREMENTS The following signs shall be exempt from the permitting requirement but must comply with the criteria for signs allowed by this sectiontitle: A. Residential Zones ( R-S, R-1, R-2, R-3, R-4, RMH). 1. Temporary, nonilluminated, real estate sale, political campaign and other noncommercial speech signs that do not exceed 9 square feet in total area and, if freestanding, 5 feet in height. No more than one such sign per street frontage. 2. Businesses working at a residentially zoned lot, such as landscapers or window treatment installers, may post an identifying sign only when they are physically at the residence, and the sign shall be removed immediately when the working party leaves the property. Such sign shall not exceed 9 square feet in total area and, if free standing shall not exceed five feet in height. Not more than one such sign per street frontage per lot is allowed. 162 Ordinance #1761. page 52-3 B. Commercial and Manufacturing Zones (R-O, B-1, B-2, B-3, M-1, M-2, BP, PLI, HMU). 1. Window signs painted on the window or physically affixed to the interior of a window, provided that such signs do not occupy more than 25 percent of the area of the window in which it is displayed. If it exceeds 25 percent of the area of the window, it will be classified as a wall sign. 2. Signs within a structure or building or other enclosed area of property when such signs are not legible when viewed from outside the structure or property. 3. Temporary non-illuminated, real estate sale, for rent or lease, political campaign, noncommercial speech signs shall not exceed 32 square feet in size, shall be no more than 5 feet high and shall be at least 5 feet from the property line. Only one sign of each candidate or other type and subject per street frontage per lot is allowed. 4. Political signs may be erected 60 days prior to the scheduled date of the primary election and must be removed not later than 7 days after the candidate is unsuccessful, withdraw, or the general election, whichever comes first. 5. Development and Construction Signs shall not exceed 32 square feet in size, shall be no more than 5 feet high and shall be at least 5 feet from the property line. All parties to the development, including but not limited to, banks, architects, contractors, developers, future occupants of the lot, real estate agent, landscape company shall be on a single sign per street frontage per lot. 6. Four on-premises directional signs not exceeding 4 square feet in area and 5 feet in height which shall not contain any commercial messages. C. All Zones. 1. Government and Public Utility Signs. Directional, warning, street, building identification, traffic control, informational or temporary special event signs that are erected, installed or placed by or on behalf of any federal, state, county or city government. Public utility signs showing locations of underground facilities or public telephones, and safety signs on construction sites, are included within this exemption. 2. Incidental Signs. A sign, generally informational, that has a purpose secondary to the use of the zone lot on which it is located, such as “no parking,” “entrance,” “loading only,” and other similar directives. No sign with a commercial message, which is designed with the intent to be legible from a position off the zone lot on which the sign is located, shall be considered incidental. 18.52.060 SIGNS PERMITTED UPON THE ISSUANCE OF A SIGN PERMIT The following on-premise signs are permitted in the indicated zones subject to a sign permit: A. Commercial, Manufacturing, and Public Land Zones ( B-2, B-3, M-1, M-2, BP, PLI, HMU). A lot in a B-2 district is permitted total signage not to exceed 400 square feet. The maximum allowable total signage in the other districts listed herein shall not exceed 250 square feet per lot. A comprehensive sign plan is required for all commercial centers consisting of two or more tenant spaces on a lot and shall be designed in accordance with §18.52.070, BMC. 1. Freestanding Signs. One freestanding sign is permitted per zoned lot. The maximum area for a freestanding sign shall be 32 square feet. A low profile freestanding sign shall be set back a minimum of 5 feet with a maximum height of 5 feet. A pole-style freestanding sign shall be set back a minimum of 15 feet with a maximum height of 13 feet. The pole- style sign will maintain at least an 8-foot minimum vertical clearance from the ground. 163 Ordinance #1761. page 52-4 2. Wall Signs. Wall signs are not to exceed a total signage allowance of 1.5 square feet per linear foot of building frontage minus any area devoted to freestanding or projecting signs. Canopy, window and awning signs shall be classified as wall signs. Wall signs shall not project above the top of a wall or parapet. Lots fronting on two or more streets shall be permitted an additional 35 percent of the already permitted wall sign area for each subsequent building frontage. 3. Projecting Signs. One projecting sign per tenant. Projecting signs shall not exceed 8 square feet in area nor extend more than 4 feet from the building. In the B-3 district, projecting signs shall not exceed 12 square feet in area nor extend more than 6 feet from the building. Projecting signs shall provide a minimum sidewalk clearance of 8 feet. B. Business and Office Zones (B-1, R-O). The maximum allowable total signage for a lot with one building shall not exceed 80 square feet in a B-1 district or non-residentially planned R-O district, the maximum allowable total signage for a lot with two or more buildings shall not exceed 160 square feet in a B-1 district or non-residentially planned R-O district and 32 square feet in a residential planned R-O district. A comprehensive sign plan is required for all commercial centers consisting of two or more tenant spaces on a lot. Such plans shall be designed in accordance with this section. 1. Low Profile Freestanding Signs. One low profile sign not to exceed 32 square feet in area in the B-1 district, and 12 square feet in area in the R-O district. In both the B-1 and the R-O districts, the low profile sign shall have a minimum setback of 5 feet and a maximum height of 5 feet. Pole-style freestanding signs are not permitted in the B-1 and R-O zones. 2. Wall Signs. Wall signs in the B-1 district are not to exceed a total signage allowance of 1 square foot per linear foot of building frontage minus any area devoted to freestanding or projecting signs. Wall signs in the R-O district are not to exceed a total signage allowance of 0.5 of a square foot per linear foot of building frontage minus any area devoted to freestanding and/or projecting signs. Canopy, window and awning signs shall be classified as wall signs. Wall signs shall not project above the top of a wall or parapet. Lots fronting on two or more streets shall be permitted an additional 35 percent of the already permitted wall sign area for each subsequent building frontage. 3. Projecting Signs. One projecting sign per tenant. Projecting signs shall not exceed 8 square feet in area nor extend more than 4 feet from the building. Projecting signs shall provide a minimum sidewalk clearance of 8 feet. 4. Subdivision Identification Signs. For residential subdivisions consisting of more than four residential units, one low profile, freestanding, neighborhood identification sign per development entrance is allowed. Each sign shall not exceed 16 square feet in area or 5 feet in height from the finished grade. The sign must be setback at least 5 feet from the property line. 5. Residential Building Identification Signs. For properties used for multi-household residential buildings, one residential identification wall sign per street frontage. Each sign shall not exceed 8 square feet in area. C. Residential Zones (R-S, R-1, R-2, R-3, R-4, RMH). 1. Subdivision Identification Signs. For residential subdivisions consisting of more than four residential units, one low profile, freestanding, neighborhood identification sign per development entrance is allowed. Each sign shall not exceed 16 square feet in area or 5 feet in height from the finished grade. The sign must be setback at least 5 feet from the property line. 164 Ordinance #1761. page 52-5 2. Residential Building Identification Signs. For properties used for multi-household residential buildings, one residential identification wall sign per street frontage. Each sign shall not exceed 8 square feet in area. 3. Signs Appurtenant To Residential Principal and Conditional Uses and Home Occupations. a. Principal residential uses and home occupations shall be permitted commercial message signage not to exceed 4 square feet in area and shall not be located in any required setback area. In addition, home occupations shall be permitted 1 square foot signs on a mailbox or lamp post or 1.5 square feet of freestanding signage located a minimum of 5 feet from the property line. b. Principal residential uses shall be permitted noncommercial speech signs which do not exceed 30 square feet in area nor 5 feet in height. Such sign(s) must be setback at least 15 feet from the property line. c. Conditional nonresidential type uses, such as churches, veterinary uses, golf courses, day care centers and schools shall be permitted signage as if the underlying zoning were B-1. Conditional residential type uses such as bed and breakfast homes, and fraternity and sorority houses, shall be permitted signage as if the underlying zoning were R-O. Such signs may only be illuminated during the hours of operation. 4. Planned Unit Developments. Commercial establishments within planned unit developments where the underlying zoning is residential shall be permitted signage as if the lot were in a B-1 zone. D. Special Districts And Zones. The guidelines for the underlying zoning districts apply unless otherwise addressed below. 1. Neighborhood Conservation Overlay District. Within this district, all signage is subject to issuance of a Certificate of Appropriateness. If the applicant is not requesting sign deviations, the sign application will be reviewed by ADR staff. If the applicant is requesting deviations, the sign application shall be subject to review by the Design Review Board and the City Commission. 2. Entryway Overlay District. Signage may exceed the underlying zoning district limitations by up to 20 percent upon review and approval of a deviation by the City Commission, upon the recommendation of the Design Review Board, and upon receipt of a Certificate of Appropriateness. 3. Interchange Zone. Signage may exceed the maximum total sign area permitted by §18.52.060, BMC by up to 25 percent upon review and approval of a deviation by the City Commission, upon the recommendation of the appropriate design review advisory body, and upon receipt of a Certificate of Appropriateness. Each lot shall be permitted one freestanding sign. a. Low Profile Signs. One low profile sign per zoned lot. The maximum area for a low profile sign shall be 40 square feet. The sign shall be setback a minimum of 5 feet with a maximum height of 8 feet. b. Pole-Style Signs. A pole-style freestanding sign shall be set back a minimum of 15 feet and will maintain at least an 8-foot minimum vertical clearance. Pole-style signs shall not exceed a total area of 40 square feet or 16 feet in height, provided however, that for every 2 feet said sign is set back from 15 feet beyond the street right-of-way, the height measured at grade may be increased 1 foot, not to exceed a total of 32 feet, and the area may be increased by 2.5 square feet for 165 Ordinance #1761. page 52-6 every 2 feet that said sign is set back 15 feet beyond the street right-of-way up to a maximum of 120 square feet. 4. Main Street Historic District. Permits for signs that encroach into the public right-of-way shall be obtained from the City Manager’s office in City Hall. 18.52.070 COMPREHENSIVE SIGN PLAN A comprehensive sign plan shall be submitted for all commercial, office, industrial and civic uses consisting of two or more tenant or occupant spaces on a lot or two or more lots subject to a common development permit or plan. A comprehensive sign plan shall not be approved unless it is consistent with this chapter, the underlying zoning regulations applicable to the property and any discretionary development permit or plan for the property. The plan should include the size and location of buildings and the size and location of existing and proposed signs. The purpose of the plan is to coordinate graphics and signs with building design. The coordination shall be achieved by: A. Using the same type of cabinet supports or method of mounting for signs of the same type; using the same type of construction for components, such as sign copy, cabinet and supports; using other types of integrating techniques, such as common color elements, determined appropriate by the Planning Director. B. Using the same form of illumination for all signs, or by using varied forms of illuminations determined compatible by the Planning Director. 18.52.080 MULTITENANT COMPLEXES WITH LESS THAN 100,000 SQUARE FEET OF GROUND FLOOR AREA The guidelines for the underlying zoning districts apply unless otherwise addressed below: A. The maximum permitted wall sign area allowed for each tenant space shall be the percentage of the total floor area on the zoned lot that the tenant occupies multiplied by the wall area allowed by §18.52.060.A.2 or §18.52.060.B.2, BMC. If the lot has more than one building frontage, the individual tenant space may derive sign area only from the frontage(s) which the space faces. Lots under this section shall be allowed a low profile sign that identifies the complex, which otherwise conforms to this chapter, in addition to the sign area already permitted under §18.52.060.A.2or §18.52.060.B.2, BMC. 18.52.090 MULTITENANT COMPLEXES WITH MORE THAN 100,000 SQUARE FEET OF GROUND FLOOR AREA The guidelines for the underlying zoning districts apply unless otherwise addressed below: A. Freestanding Signs. 1. Pole-style Signs. One pole-style sign per street frontage not to exceed 48 square feet in area or 16 feet in height. The sign area computed for a pole-style sign shall not be subtracted from the maximum allowable wall signage permitted for the entire complex. 2. Low Profile Signs. One low profile sign shall be permitted at each secondary entrance of the complex, provided each sign shall not exceed 32 square feet in area, not 5 feet in height, and must be setback a minimum of 5 feet from the property lines. All low profile signs shall only identify the complex and must display the street number address in figures which are at least 6 inches high. Low profile signs complying with these regulations will not be factored when calculating the maximum permitted wall sign area. B. Wall Signs. Each tenant shall be permitted wall signage square footage calculated from 1.5 times the linear store frontage. For the maximum allowable total signage, please see §18.52.060.A or §18.52.060.B, BMC. 166 Ordinance #1761. page 52-7 18.52.100 INDOOR SHOPPING MALL COMPLEXES WITH MORE THAN 100,000 SQUARE FEET OF GROUND FLOOR AREA The guidelines for the underlying zoning districts apply unless otherwise addressed below: A. Freestanding Signs. l. Pole-style Signs. One pole-style sign per street frontage not to exceed 48 square feet in area or 16 feet in height. The sign area computed for a pole-style sign shall not be subtracted from the maximum allowable wall signage permitted for the entire complex. 2. Low Profile Signs. One low profile sign shall be permitted at each secondary entrance of the complex, provided each sign shall not exceed 32 square feet in area, nor 5 feet in height, and must be setback a minimum of 5 feet from the property lines. All low profile signs shall only identify the complex and must display the street number address in figures which are at least 6 inches high. Low profile signs complying with these regulations will not be factored when calculating the maximum permitted wall sign area. B. Wall Signs. Each anchor tenant occupying 20,000 square feet or more shall be permitted 300 square feet of wall signage. Each tenant with an exclusive outdoor customer entrance shall be permitted wall signage square footage calculated from 5 percent of the ground floor area. 18.52.110 ILLUMINATION A. Illumination, if any, shall be provided by artificial light which is constant in intensity and color. Internally illuminated “can signs” are acceptable provided background and copy are coordinated to avoid excessive light output. Neon and other gas type transformers shall be limited to 60 milliamperes and fluorescent transformers shall be limited to 800 milliamperes to soften light output. Additionally, neon and other gas type signs with exposed tubing shall be equipped with dimmers. B. Externally illuminated wall-mounted and pole signs shall be lighted by fixtures mounted at the top of the sign and aimed downward; ground-mounted sign lighting may only be used for monument style signs. Fixtures used to illuminate signs shall be aimed so as not to project their output beyond the sign. 18.52.120 STREET VISION TRIANGLES Signs shall not be placed in sight vision triangles as they are established in §18.44.100, BMC. 18.52.130 REQUIRED ADDRESS SIGNS Street numbers shall be required for all residential, commercial, industrial, and civic uses in all zones, consistent with the requirements of the Fire Department. All freestanding signs shall display the address of the lot in 6-inch numbers. 18.52.140 BILLBOARDS AND OTHER OFF-PREMISE ADVERTISING Off-premises commercial advertising signs are not permitted within the Bozeman City limits except as permitted by state or federal law. A. Exception: Off-premises signs may be placed on the interior of transit shelters reviewed and approved by the City of Bozeman and served by an active fixed route transit service. Signage within a transit shelter shall not distract drivers of vehicles nor be legible from the driving lanes. 18.52.150 SIGNS ERECTED IN CONJUNCTION WITH NONPROFIT ACTIVITIES ON PUBLIC PROPERTY Signs erected on public property in support of nonprofit activities, such as signs advertising sponsors of youth and sports activities, shall be allowed only as follows: 167 Ordinance #1761. page 52-8 A. The sign(s) shall be permitted only at developed facilities in public parks or other publicly owned lands. B. The sign(s) may be erected two weeks prior to the commencement of the activity and shall be removed within two weeks after the cessation of the activity for which the sign(s) were erected. C. Each individual sign shall be no larger than 32 square feet. Freestanding signs must be setback a minimum of 15 feet from the property line with a maximum height of 5 feet. Signs attached to walls or scoreboards shall not be subject to the 5 foot height limitation. However, signs attached to walls or scoreboards shall not exceed the height of the wall or scoreboard to which they are attached. All signs shall be oriented towards spectators attending the activity who are at the facility. D. The sign(s) shall not: 1. Advertise alcoholic beverages or tobacco products; 1.2. Be individually illuminated; nor 2.3. Be placed in sight vision triangles or otherwise impede or obstruct the view of the traveling public. E. Applicants for such sign(s) must apply for, and have approved, a special temporary sign permit detailing the nature of the sign(s) to be erected and the duration the sign(s) will remain in place. Applications and review procedures shall be made as per §18.52.170, BMC. 18.52.160 HISTORIC OR CULTURALLY SIGNIFICANT SIGNS Signs which have historical or cultural significance to the City but do not conform to the provisions of this chapter, maybe permitted provided that the City Commission adopts findings supporting the historical or cultural significance of the sign and issues a sign permit. Such findings shall be adopted by resolution of the City Commission. 18.52.170 APPLICATION An application for a sign shall be made on forms provided by the Planning Department. The application shall contain sufficient information and plans to permit review pursuant to this chapter, including but not limited to: building elevations; photographs; proposed locations of signs on building elevations; sign design layout showing number, types and dimensions of all signs; and a site plan showing proposed location of all signs. An applicant may appeal the denial of permit request pursuant to the provisions of Chapter 18.66, BMC. 18.52.180 MAINTENANCE OF PERMITTED SIGNS All signs shall be continuously maintained in a state of security, safety and repair. Abandoned signs and sign support structures shall be removed. If any sign is found not to be so maintained, or is in need of repair or has been abandoned, it shall be the duty of the owner and the occupant of the premises to repair or remove the sign within fourteen calendar days after receiving written notice to do so from the Planning Director. If the sign is not so repaired or removed within such time, the Planning Director shall cause the sign to be removed at the expense of the owner of the premises. 18.52.190 NONCONFORMING SIGNS A. The eventual elimination of existing signs that are not in conformity with the provisions of this chapter is as important as the regulation of new signs. Except as otherwise provided herein, the owner of any zone lot or other premises on which exists a sign that does not conform with the requirements of this chapter and for which there is no prior, valid sign permit shall remove such sign. 168 Ordinance #1761. page 52-9 B. All signs which were legally permitted prior to June 22, 1997 are considered legal, permitted signs under this chapter. Except as provided for in subsection C of this section, said sign, if nonconforming with this chapter, may not be: 1. Replaced except with a conforming sign; 2. Changed in copy (except for signs specifically designed to be changed in copy, such as readerboards with changeable letters); 3. Structurally altered to extend its useful life; or 4. Expanded, moved or relocated. C. No legal, nonconforming sign may be altered or enlarged in any way which increases its nonconformity, but any existing signage, or portions thereof, may be altered by decreasing its nonconformity (except as provided in subsection D below). D. Any lot with a nonconforming sign may not add additional signage until all signs on the lot are brought into conformance with this chapter. Any site modification that requires a certificate of appropriateness, site plan review or reuse application will necessitate compliance for all existing and proposed signage on the lot. E. Notwithstanding any other provision of this chapter, no sign shall be subject to any limitation based on the content of the message contained on such sign. Any sign authorized in this chapter may contain noncommercial copy in lieu of any other copy. 169 Ordinance #1761. page 56-1 CHAPTER 18.56 BOZEMAN WETLAND REGULATIONS 18.56.010 TITLE AND APPLICABILITY These regulations shall be known as the Bozeman wetland regulations and may be cited as the wetlands regulations. These wetland regulations shall govern areas in compliance with the 1987 U.S. Army Corps of Engineers Wetland Delineation Manual of the U.S (1987 Corps Manual), or the most current wetland delineation manual sanctioned by the Army Corps of Engineers (ACOE)-Omaha District. This manual provides specific guidelines and methods to identify whether an area is a wetland and to determine the boundary between wetlands and uplands. Bozeman’s wetland regulations will pertain to wetlands with a direct hydrologic connection to “waters of the U.S.” (those wetlands that connect to a federally- regulated stream or river directly or via a series or watercourse, wetlands or ditches), and also to isolated wetlands with no direct connection to a water of the U.S. and exhibit positive wetland indicators for all three wetland parameters. The provisions contained in these regulations do not apply to wetlands created by a wholly man-made water source used for irrigation purposes or stormwater control. 18.56.020 INTENT AND PURPOSE A. Wetlands perform many important ecological functions. It is the intent and purpose of this chapter to protect, preserve and enhance wetlands to provide the following functions: 1. Aquifer recharge; 2. Water storage; 3. Regional stream hydrology (discharge and recharge); 4. Flood control and storage; 5. Sediment control (filter for waste); 6. Nutrient removal from urban runoff; and 7. Erosion control. B. Wetlands provide important values that enhance the quality of life of community residents. It is the intent of this chapter to protect, preserve and enhance wetlands to provide the following values: 1. Habitat for fish, wildlife and plants (including endangered and threatened); 2. Recreation; 3. Open space; 4. Visual and aesthetic; 5. Education and research; and 6. Historical, cultural and archeological resources. C. Wetlands can present significant constraints to development. Wetlands typically form in areas characterized by poor drainage conditions which are ill-suited for most types of development. Development in these areas often involves extra expense resulting from considerations for site drainage, flood protection and facility maintenance. In addition, wetlands are characterized by hydric soils that are unstable for most types of development. Hydric soils tend to compress under the weight of structures and decompose when drained. Therefore, costs of development may be greater due to complex engineering design requirements, or the need to excavate and replace the soils. It is the intent of these regulations to protect public and private facilities and 170 Ordinance #1761. page 56-2 structures from damage, and to minimize public and private development and maintenance costs. D. It is not the intent of this chapter to prohibit all activities within regulated areas and associated buffers, but rather to encourage the avoidance of regulated activities within the regulated areas and to require best management practices in regulated areas. E. Nothing in this chapter shall be construed to prevent irrigation companies from diverting and carrying water under historic water rights or owners of such rights from exercising those historic rights. F. Nothing in this chapter shall be construed to prevent compliance with applicable state or federal statutes and regulations. 18.56.030 APPLICATION OF WETLAND REGULATIONS A. These regulations shall apply to any regulated activity which may impact wetlands as indicated defined in Section 18.80.3170, BMC on the Bozeman Area Wetland Map orknown prior to or discovered through the development review process, and verified through a site-specific wetlands boundary determination. When any regulated activity is proposed, and the Bozeman Area Wetland Map indicates that wetlands are present on the subject tract or if wetlands are discovered through the development review process, a wetlands boundary determination shall be conducted. If the determination finds that there are no wetlands present on the subject tract, these regulations shall not apply. If, however, wetlands are found on the subject tract the proposal shall be subject to these regulations. The provisions of this chapter shall be applied in addition to any other applicable regulations of this title. 1. The wetlands boundary determination shall be prepared in accordance with the Federal Manual for Identifying and Delineating Jurisdictional Wetlands (January, 1987).1987 U.S. Army Corps of Engineers Wetland Delineation Manual of the U.S (1987 Corps Manual), or the most current wetland delineation manual sanctioned by the Army Corps of Engineers (ACOE)-Omaha District by a qualified wetland professional. 2. A qualified wetland professional is an individual with a minimum of a bachelor’s degree in a water resource related field, five years experience, and/or a Professional Wetland Scientist certification. B. Isolated wetlands with a size of less than 400 square feet, regardless of property boundaries, are exempt from this chapter unless the wetland provides habitat for the following species: 1. Plant, animal or other wildlife species listed as threatened or endangered by the United States Fish and Wildlife Service; and/or 2. Plant, animal or other wildlife species listed as a Species of Concern, Species of Potential Concern, or Species on Review by the Montana Department of Fish, Wildlife and Parks and the Montana Natural Heritage Program. C. Any development for which the watercourse setback requirements of §18.42.100, BMC are provided is considered to have addressed the concerns of this chapter and is exempt from this chapter. D. This chapter is not intended to repeal, abrogate, supersede or impair any existing federal, state, or local law, easement, covenant or deed restriction. However, if this chapter imposes greater or more stringent restrictions, the provisions of this chapter shall prevail. Specifically, if a regulated activity pursuant to this chapter also requires authorization under Section 404 of the Clean Water Act from the US Army Corps of Engineers, the applicant shall meet any greater or more stringent restrictions set forth in this chapter in addition to and independent of the restrictions of such permit. 171 Ordinance #1761. page 56-3 18.56.040 WETLANDS REVIEW BOARD POWERS AND DUTIES In addition to the duties established by Chapter 18.62, BMC, the WRB shall have the following powers and duties: A. Prepare Review wetland delineation boundaries and functional assessments for wetlands that may be impacted by regulated activities; B. Based on wetland functional assessments and other submittal materials, make recommendations to the Planning Director, Board of Adjustment (BOA), or City Commission to allow or disallow the regulated activity; C. Recommend to the Planning Director, BOA, or City Commission appropriate wetland buffer widths based on the wetland delineation, functional assessment, and other submittal materials; D. Recommend to the Planning Director, BOA, or City Commission additional conditions on regulated activities that are reasonably necessary to carry out the purpose and intent of this chapter; E. Provide assistance recommendations to applicants regarding alternatives to design of developments that minimize impacts to wetlands and other aquatic resources; and F. Testify as needed before all boards, commissions and agencies on any matter affecting wetlands. 18.56.050 WETLANDS MAPPING A. The Bozeman Area Wetlands Map shall be adopted by resolution and shall, in addition to the submittal materials of Section 18.78.130, BMC, be used to implement this chapter. B. The Bozeman Area Wetlands Map may be amended by resolution by means of the performance of a wetland boundary determination. Wetland boundary determinations shall be performed in accordance with the procedures specified in the Federal Manual for Identifying and Delineating Jurisdictional Wetlands (January, 1987). 1. A CD-ROM containing the wetland boundary determination and raw survey data (if applicable) shall be provided for use in amending the Bozeman Area Wetland Map. The data shall be reported in UTM Zone 12 coordinates and NAD83 datum. C. Prior to annexation, wetland boundary determinations and functional assessments shall be prepared for all wetlands on the property to be annexed. 18.56.060 REGULATED ACTIVITIES A. No person shall conduct any of the following regulated activities within a regulated wetland area, as described in §18.56.030 of this chapter, without first having the proposed activity reviewed by the WRB and approved by the Planning Director, BOA, or City Commission as appropriate. Any activity in a regulated area which reduces the size of a wetland or reduces the degree to which a wetland performs any function is subject to the requirements of this chapter, including but not limited to: 1. Placement of any material, including without limitation any soil, sand, gravel, mineral, aggregate, organic material or water; 2. Construction, installation or placement of any obstruction or the erection of a building, trail, boardwalk or other structure; 3. Removal, excavation or dredging of solid material of any kind, including without limitation any soil, sand, gravel, mineral, aggregate or organic material; 4. Removal of any existing vegetation or any activity which will cause any loss of vegetation in a wetland; 172 Ordinance #1761. page 56-4 5. Alteration of the water level or water table by any means, including without limitation draining, ditching, trenching, impounding or pumping; and 6. Disturbance of existing surface drainage characteristics, sedimentation patterns, flow patterns, or flood retention characteristics by any means, including without limitation grading and alteration of existing topography. B. The following activities are permissible in a regulated wetland area, without review by the WRB and approval by the Planning Director or City Commission, if they activities do not reduce the size of a wetland or significantly reduce the degree to which a wetland performs any function and in compliance with any other applicable state or federal law: 1. Maintenance of an existing and lawful public or private road, structure or facility, including but not limited to drainage facilities, water conveyance structures, dams, fences or trails, or any facility used to provide transportation, electric, gas, water, telephone, telecommunications or other services provided that these activities do not materially change or enlarge any road, structure or facility; 2. Maintenance of an existing farm or stock pond, irrigation ditch, agricultural fence or drainage system; 3. Weed control consistent with a Noxious Weed Management and Revegetation Plan approved by the Gallatin County Weed Control District; 4. Continuation of existing agricultural practices such as the cultivation and harvesting of hay or pasturing of livestock, or change of agricultural practices which has no greater impact on wetland function; 5. Conservation or preservation of soil, water, vegetation, fish and other wildlife; 6. Outdoor recreational activities, such as fishing, birdwatching, hiking, rafting and swimming which do not harm or disturb the wetland; 7. The harvesting of wild crops; 8. Education and scientific research; 9. Minor improvements and landscape maintenance within a required wetland buffer but outside the boundaries of a delineated wetland, including but not limited to the pruning of trees, mowing of grass, and removal of dead vegetation and debris; and 10. Activities in a wetland set forth in §18.56.090 of this chapter, including but not limited to removal of debris and maintenance of vegetation and wildlife habitat. 18.56.070 APPLICATION REQUIREMENTS AND PROCEDURES FOR REGULATED ACTIVITIES IN REGULATED WETLAND AREAS A. Review. All proposals for regulated activities in regulated wetland areas shall be reviewed by the WRB. The WRB applicant shall prepare a functional assessment for all reviewed regulated wetland areas. Based on the prepared functional assessment and other submittal materials, the WRB shall forward a recommendation of approval, conditional approval or denial to the Planning Director or City Commission. B. Approval. All proposals for regulated activities in regulated wetland areas shall be reviewed and approved, or conditionally approved, or denied by the Planning Director or the City Commission in accordance with Chapters 18.06, 18.08, 18.34 and 18.36, BMC prior to commencement of the regulated activity. 1. If a regulated activity is proposed for a regulated wetland area, but the regulated activity is not proposed in conjunction with a land development proposal, the applicant shall 173 Ordinance #1761. page 56-5 submit a sketch plan application for review and recommendation by the WRB, and review and approval by the Planning Director. C. Submittal materials. The information required in §18.78.130, BMC shall be submitted for all regulated activities proposed for regulated wetland areas. D. Noticing. The review of regulated activities proposed for regulated wetland areas shall comply with the noticing requirements of Chapter 18.76, BMC. 18.56.080 REVIEW STANDARDS The Planning Director or City Commission may approve, conditionally approve or deny a regulated activity in a regulated wetland area based on a recommendation from the WRB, and if: A. The applicant has demonstrated that all adverse impacts on a wetland have been avoided; or B. The applicant has demonstrated that any adverse impact on a wetland has been minimized; the activity will result in minimal impact or impairment to any wetland function, and the activity will not result in an adverse modification of habitats for, or jeopardize the continued existence of, the following: 1. Plant, animal or other wildlife species listed as threatened or endangered by the United States Fish and Wildlife Service; and/or 2. Plant, animal or other wildlife species listed as a Species of Concern, Species of Potential Concern, or Species on Review by the Montana Department of Fish, Wildlife and Parks and the Montana Natural Heritage Program; or C. The applicant has demonstrated that the project is in the public interest, considering having considered and documented: 1. The extent of the public need for the proposed regulated activity; 2. The functionsal and values as determined by a State of Montana accepted method of functional assessment of the wetland that may be affected by the proposed regulated activity; 3. The extent and permanence of the adverse effects of the regulated activity on the wetland and any associated watercourse; 4. The cumulative adverse effects of past activities on the wetland; and 5. The uniqueness or scarcity of the wetland that may be eaffected. 18.56.090 WETLAND PERMIT CONDITIONS The WRB may recommend conditions of approval for proposed regulated activities, and the Planning Director or City Commission may conditionally approve proposed regulated activities, subject to the following conditions: 1. Requiring the provision of a wetland buffer of a size appropriate for the particular proposed activity and the particular regulated wetland area; 2. Requiring that structures be appropriately supported and elevated on piles and otherwise protected against natural hazards; 3. Modifying waste disposal and water supply facilities; 4. Requiring deed restrictions or covenants regarding the future use and subdivision of lands, including but not limited to the preservation of undeveloped areas as open space and restrictions on vegetation removal; 5. Restricting the use of an area, which may be greater than the regulated wetland area; 6. Requiring erosion control and stormwater management measures; 174 Ordinance #1761. page 56-6 7. Clustering structures or development; 8. Restricting fill, deposit of soil and other activities which may be detrimental to a wetland; 9. Modifying the project design to ensure continued water supply to the regulated wetland; and 10. Requiring or restricting maintenance of a regulated wetland area for the purpose of maintaining wetland functions. 11. A yearly Mitigation Monitoring Report to be submitted to the WRB on a yearly basis, with the due date to be determined on a case-by-case basis. 12. A Deed Restriction to be filed with the Gallatin County Clerk stating the measures that will be taken to protect all water resources, mitigation, and buffer areas in perpetuity. 13. That all reasonable effort has been made to limit indirect impacts to vegetation, faunal interspersion and connectivity, and hydrological connectivity in the site design. (e.g. any structures, boardwalks, viewing platforms, bridges, constructed within wetlands will have at least a 2-foot space between the bottom chord of structure and the wetland surface elevation to limit shading impacts wetland vegetation to persist). 14. The WRB may recommend conditions to mitigate for locally-regulated (wetlands not connected to a water of the U.S.), infringement upon watercourses, buffers, or negative indirect or direct affects on the functionality of wetlands, watercourses or buffers. 18.56.100 APPEALS Depending upon the application procedure involved, decisions related to the approval or denial of regulated activities proposed for regulated wetland areas may be appealed in accordance with the provisions of Chapter 18.66, BMC. 18.56.110 ENFORCEMENT This chapter shall be enforced in accordance with the provisions contained in Chapter 18.64, BMC. 175 Ordinance #1761. page 62-1 CHAPTER 18.62 DEVELOPMENT REVIEW COMMITTEE (DRC), DESIGN REVIEW BOARD (DRB), ADMINISTRATIVE DESIGN REVIEW STAFF (ADR), WETLANDS REVIEW BOARD (WRB), BOARD OF ADJUSTMENT (BOA) 18.62.010 PURPOSE OF DRC, DRB, ADR, WRB, AND BOA A. Purpose. The Development Review Committee (DRC), Design Review Board (DRB), Administrative Design Review staff (ADR) and Wetlands Review Board (WRB) are established to coordinate, expedite and assure fair and equitable implementation of this title. The objective, to be implemented through their procedures and deliberations, shall be to encourage development quality that will enhance both the natural and built environments, with consideration to present and future property values, and to carry out the purposes of this title. All bodies authorized under this chapter may call upon any City staff or other persons with technical expertise, and may testify before any board, commission or other body upon the subjects for which they have responsibility. 1. DRC. The DRC is established to evaluate all proposals subject to the provisions of this title. The DRC is the body charged with reviewing items relating to public health and safety. a. The DRC shall act as an advisory body to the Planning Director for site plans when no variance or deviation is requested; and b. The DRC shall act as an advisory body to the City Commission for larger and more complex proposals including conditional use permits, planned unit developments, all site plans involving variances or deviations, divisions of land, zone map amendments, annexations and other actions as requested by staff or the City Commission. 2. DRB. The DRB is established to evaluate aesthetic considerations of larger and more complex proposals which are likely to produce significant community impact and to provide recommendations regarding such proposals to the Planning Director or City Commission, subject to the provisions of this title. a. The DRB shall act as an advisory body to the Planning Director for site plans within overlay districts meeting one or more of the thresholds of §18.34.040.C, BMC when no variance or deviation is requested; and b. The DRB shall act as an advisory body to the City Commission regarding: (1) Site plans within overlay districts meeting one or more of the thresholds of §18.34.040.C, BMC when variances or deviations are requested; (2) Conditional use permits located within overlay districts, but excluding conditional use permits for the purpose of accessory dwelling units and conditional use permits which do not create additional building area; (3) Planned unit developments; (4) Appeals from ADR decisions; and (5) Review of applications for Large Scale Retail. c. The DRB may develop, and after adoption by the City Commission, apply specific guidelines related to such concerns as architectural appearance, landscape design and signage for the construction and/or alteration of structures, sites or areas; 176 Ordinance #1761. page 62-2 d. The DRB may review applicable development proposal applications for zoning text amendments, or applications for moving, demolition or any other kind of permit that may affect properties located within entryway corridors. e. The DRB has responsibility for projects subject to §18.34.040.C, BMC. 3. ADR. The ADR staff is established as the review body for aesthetic considerations of smaller and less complex proposals which are less likely to produce significant community impact and to provide recommendations regarding such proposals to the Planning Director and City Commission, subject to the provisions of this title. a. The ADR staff shall act as the approval authority for sketch plans within overlay districts when no variance or deviation is requested; b. The ADR staff shall act as an advisory body to the Planning Director for site plans within overlay districts not meeting one or more of the thresholds of §18.34.040.B when no variance or deviation is requested; c. The ADR staff shall act as an advisory body to the Planning Director regarding reuse/further development permits within overlay districts; and d. The ADR staff shall act as an advisory body to the City Commission regarding all sketch plans and site plans not meeting one or more of the thresholds §18.34.040.B within overlay districts when variances or deviations are requested, for conditional use permits for accessory dwelling units, conditional use permits where no additional building area will be created, and non-PUD divisions of land; e. The ADR may develop, and after adoption by the City Commission, apply specific guidelines related to such concerns as architectural appearance, landscape design and signage for the construction and/or alteration of structures, sites or areas; and f. The ADR may review applicable development proposal applications for zoning amendments, or applications for moving, demolition or any other kind of permit that may affect properties located within entryway corridors. 4. WRB. The WRB is established to review wetland related submittal materials, prepare functional assessments of regulated wetlands that may be impacted by proposed regulated activities, evaluate the impacts proposed regulated activities may have on delineated wetlands and to provide wetlands protection, mitigation and/or enhancement recommendations regarding such proposals to the Planning Director, Board of Adjustment, and City Commission, subject to the provisions of this title. a. The WRB shall act as an advisory body to the Planning Director for sketch plans and site plans when no variance or deviation is requested. b. The WRB shall act as an advisory body to the City Commission, or Board of Adjustment if applicable, for larger and more complex proposals including conditional use permits, planned unit developments, subdivisions, all site plans involving variances or deviations, divisions of land, zone map amendments, and other actions as requested by staff or the Commission. 5. BOA. The BOA is established to consider zoning variances, deviations, site plans which include variance or deviations, and conditional use permits, subject to the provisions of this title. Variances and deviations are subject to Chapter 18.66 and conditional use permits are subject to Chapter 18.34, in addition to the other relevant aspects of this title. 177 Ordinance #1761. page 62-3 B. Development Review Committee Procedures Established. To implement this purpose, certain procedures shall be adopted to include, but not be limited to, a regularly scheduled weekly or biweekly meeting attended by representatives of each of the City departments charged with development review. Each department shall have the ability and authority to require the DRC to make a recommendation of denial when in their view the project can not meet the requirements and review criteria of this title and acceptable conditions do not exist to cure the identified failings of the project. Written meeting reviews, in the form of staff reports or summary reviews prepared by the Planning Department, shall be made setting forth the DRC’s recommendation to the Planning Director or City Commission and reasons for requiring such conditions as may be deemed necessary by the DRC. These records shall be preserved as part of the official file for each development proposal. Lastly, the DRC shall generally follow “Robert’s Rules of Order” and may prepare and adopt supplemental procedural rules that will assure the accomplishment of the stated purpose and promote the efficiency and effectiveness of the developmental review process. 1. The DRC shall at a minimum be composed of the following personnel: City Engineer or designee, Fire Marshal or designee, the Streets Superintendent or designee, the Sanitation Superintendent or designee, the Water/Sewer Superintendent or designee, the Planning Director or designee and the Building Official or designee. When necessary, other members of the committee may include: the Director of Public Safety or designee, the Superintendent of Facilities and Public Lands or designee, the Superintendent of Recreation or designee, the City Manager or designee, with other individuals to be included as necessary at the Planning Director’s request. 2. When applicable, the DRC may solicit the input of non-City agencies and persons including, but not limited to, the county subdivision review officer or designee, the County Sanitarian or designee, the County Road Superintendent or designee, and state or federal agencies, with other individuals to be included as necessary. C. Design Review Board Procedures Established. To implement this purpose, certain procedures shall be adopted to include, but not be limited to, a regularly scheduled weekly or biweekly meeting attended by members of the DRB. Written meeting reviews setting forth decisions and findings shall be made. These records shall be preserved as part of the official proceedings for each developmental proposal. Lastly, the DRB shall generally follow “Robert’s Rules of Order” and may prepare and adopt supplemental procedural rules, upon the approval of the City Commission, that will assure the accomplishment of the stated purpose and promote the efficiency and effectiveness of the design review process. 1. The DRB shall consist of six professional and two nonprofessional members. Professional members shall be degreed in their respective disciplines and/or otherwise licensed or certified by their respective professional authorities. An appointment to a term of service on the DRB is for two years. The professional contingent shall consist of three architects and at least one architectural historian, and at least one landscape architect or landscape designer. At least one of the professional members shall have demonstrated expertise in urban design. Nonprofessional members shall be individuals with an interest in, or knowledge of, urban design or historic preservation. No member of the DRB shall serve concurrently as a member of the Planning Board or Zoning Commission. A quorum of the DRB shall be four voting members and one of the members constituting the quorum must be an architect. In the event a quorum of the DRB may not otherwise be attained, the ADR staff may serve as alternates to prevent delay in project reviews. 2. In selecting the members, the City Commission shall give preference to residents of the City of Bozeman. However, where a qualified professional resident is not available to 178 Ordinance #1761. page 62-4 serve, the City Commission may appoint a professional member who practices professionally, owns property or owns a business within the City. Where a nonprofessional resident is not available to serve, the City Commission may appoint a nonprofessional member who works, owns property or owns a business within the City. D. Administrative Design Review Staff Procedures Established. To implement this purpose, certain procedures shall be adopted for the administrative evaluation of a proposal without public notice or comment, unless a deviation from the underlying zoning is requested. After a proposal has been evaluated by the ADR staff, they shall issue a written decision that shall include findings and may include a notice of required corrections. The ADR staff may call a conference with the applicant to determine design alternatives, or the applicant may call a conference with the ADR staff for the same purpose. Any such conference shall be conducted prior to the issuance of a building permit for the proposal. 1. ADR staff shall consist of two Planning Department staff members. One member shall be degreed or otherwise licensed or certified by his/her respective professional authorities in an environmental design discipline such as architecture, landscape architecture or urban design. The second member shall be the Planning Director or his/her designee who may or may not be degreed in architecture. In the event that necessary ADR staff is not available, the DRB may act to provide design review services. E. Waiver of Design Review. In the event that neither the DRB nor the ADR staff as established in this chapter are able to complete a quorum or have the necessary personnel to conduct the reviews otherwise required by this title, the requirement for review by DRB or ADR is waived. Nothing in this section shall constitute a waiver of the required review criteria established in Chapters 18.28, 18.30, 18.36, and 18.56, BMC. F. Wetlands Review Board Procedures Established. The WRB will be convened as necessary to review proposals that involve regulated activities and may impact regulated wetlands based on the provisions contained in Chapter 18.56, BMC. To implement this purpose, certain procedures shall be adopted to include, but not be limited to, scheduling meetings as needed to be attended by members of the WRB. Written meeting reviews setting forth decisions and findings shall be made. These records shall be preserved as part of the official proceedings for each development proposal. Lastly, the WRB shall generally follow “Robert’s Rules of Order” and may prepare and adopt supplemental procedural rules, upon the approval of the City Commission, that will assure the accomplishment of the stated purpose and promote the efficiency and effectiveness of the wetland review process. 1. The WRB shall consist of six members. An appointment to a term of service on the WRB is for two years. Members shall be degreed in their respective disciplines and/or otherwise licensed or certified by their respective professional authorities. Members shall have experience in at least one of the following wetland and/or stream specializations: ecology, soils, botany, and/or hydrology. consist of at least one biologist, one soil scientist, one plant scientist, and one hydrologist. 2. In selecting the members, the City Commission shall give preference to residents of the City of Bozeman. However, where a qualified resident is not available to serve, the City Commission may appoint a member who practices professionally, owns property or owns a business within the City. G. Board of Adjustment Procedures Established. The BOA will be convened as necessary to review applications for variances or deviations or applications involving variances or deviations. The BOA will also review applications for conditional use permits. To implement this purpose, certain procedures shall be adopted which may include, without limitation, a regularly scheduled weekly or biweekly meeting attended by members of the BOA. A record of the reviews and 179 Ordinance #1761. page 62-5 decisions shall be made. These records shall be preserved as part of the official proceedings for each development proposal. Lastly, the BOA shall generally follow “Robert’s Rules of Order” and may prepare and adopt supplemental procedural rules, upon the approval of the City Commission, that will assure the accomplishment of the stated purpose and promote the efficiency and effectiveness of the review process. 1. The BOA shall consist of 7 members. The term of appointment is for 3 years, with staggered terms. Members shall be appointed by the City Commission. A member may be removed per Section 76-2-322, MCA. The concurring vote of four members of the board is required to take official action. 2. In selecting the members, the City Commission shall give preference to residents of the City of Bozeman. However, where a qualified resident is not available to serve, the City Commission may appoint up to one non-resident member who practices professionally, owns property or owns a business within the City. a. Preference should be given to applicants who have prior experience with local government, who will uphold the intent and purpose of the City’s land use regulations, and who will honor the purpose of a Board of Adjustment. 18.62.020 GENERAL PROCEDURES, NOTICE AND TIMING A. Informal Advice and Direction. A person or organization considering any construction, building or site alteration, rezoning or other development activity, may approach the DRC, DRB, ADR or WRB for informal advice and direction. Such discussion shall be treated as advisory by both parties and shall record only the fact that contact had been made. An informal review by the DRC and/or DRB may be requested by submitting a completed application form provided by the Planning Director along with any schematic development plans or written narrative at least one week prior to the next regularly DRC and/or DRB meeting. An informal review by the WRB may be requested by submitting a completed application form provided by the Planning Director along with a wetland delineation for the regulated wetland, development plans or written narrative describing the proposed regulated activity and a WRB meeting will be convened within two weeks of application submittal. The initial informal review by an applicant or owner for a specific parcel shall be conducted without a fee. A fee, set in accordance with the fee resolution adopted by the City Commission, shall be charged for a second or subsequent informal review requested by the same applicant and/or owner for the same real property as a prior informal review. No application is required for informal review or advice by the ADR staff. B. Formal Application. An application for DRC, DRB, ADR and/or WRB consideration of a development proposal must be submitted utilizing a form available from the Planning Director. Material to be submitted with the application shall include the elements set forth within the requirements for the type of proposal to be considered, i.e., sketch plan, site plan, conditional use permit, certificate of appropriateness, planned unit development, divisions of land, etc. as outlined in this title. It is recommended that the applicant discuss the application informally with the DRC, DRB, ADR or WRB prior to formal submission to help expedite the process. Depending upon the size of the proposed project, its location and type, the applicant may be directed to one or more agencies of the City for processing. C. Public Notice. Public notice for any proposal before the DRC, DRB, ADR or WRB that requires such notice shall be provided in accordance with Chapter 18.76, BMC. D. DRC, DRB, ADR or WRB Action. By no later than 30 working days from the date of the first regularly scheduled DRC and/or DRB meeting, or a meeting convened by the WRB, at which the applicants’ proposal was initially reviewed, the DRC, DRB or WRB shall take action to 180 Ordinance #1761. page 62-6 recommend approval, approval with conditions, table pending submission of revised or additional materials or recommend denial of the applicant’s proposal, unless the applicant grants a written extension to the review period. For proposals subject to ADR review, the ADR staff shall recommend approval, approval with conditions, delay pending submission of revised or additional materials or denial of the applicant’s proposal. E. BOA Action. After the applicants’ proposal is found sufficient for review, the schedule for BOA action to approve, approve with conditions, table pending submission of revised or additional materials, or deny the applicant’s proposal shall be established. 181 Ordinance #1761. page 64-1 CHAPTER 18.64 ADMINISTRATION, FEES AND PENALTIES 18.64.010 REVIEW AUTHORITY A. The City Commission has the right to review and require revisions to all development proposals subject to this title, and delegates that authority in certain circumstances as set forth below to the Planning Director and Board of Adjustment, reserving to itself the right to hear appeals from decisions of the Planning Director and informational hearings required by Section 76-2-402, MCA and Board of Adjustment. The purpose of this review is to prevent demonstrable adverse impacts of the development upon public safety, health or general welfare, or to provide for its mitigation; to protect public investments in roads, drainage facilities, sewage facilities, water facilities, and other facilities; to conserve the value of adjoining buildings and/or property; to protect the character of Bozeman; to protect the right of use of property; advance the purposes and standards of this title and the adopted growth policy; and to ensure that the applicable regulations of the City are upheld. B. The Planning Director shall, upon recommendation from the DRC, DRB, ADR or WRB as may be applicable approve, approve with conditions or deny all applications subject to this title, except master site plans, conditional use permits, planned unit developments and subdivisions, or any application involving deviations or variances. Decisions of the Planning Director are subject to the appeal provisions of Chapter 18.66, BMC, 1. Exception. The City Commission may, by an affirmative, simple majority, vote of its members at a regularly scheduled meeting reclaim to itself the final approval of a development normally subject to the approval of the Planning Director. The vote shall occur prior to the action of the Planning Director. C. The Board of Adjustment shall, upon recommendation from the DRC, DRB, ADR or WRB as may be applicable approve, approve with conditions or deny applications for all variances and deviations, site/sketch plans with variances or deviations, or conditional use permits subject to this title, except planned unit developments and subdivisions. Decisions of the BOA are subject to the appeal provisions of Chapter 18.66, BMC, 1. Exception. The City Commission may, by an affirmative vote of three of its members at a regularly scheduled meeting reclaim to itself the final approval of a development normally subject to the approval of the Board of Adjustment. The vote shall occur prior to the action of the Board of Adjustment. D. As detailed in Chapter 18.62, BMC, the City Commission authorizes the Development Review Committee, Design Review Board, administrative design review staff, and/or Wetlands Review Board, and other advisory bodies as applicable, to review and to make recommendations to the Planning Director, BOA, or City Commission regarding development proposals. E.. The City Commission or its designated representatives may require the applicant to design the proposed development to reasonably minimize potentially significant adverse impacts identified through the review required by these regulations. The City Commission or its designated representatives may not unreasonably restrict a landowner’s ability to develop land, but it is recognized that in some instances the unmitigated impacts of a proposed development may be unacceptable and will preclude approval of the development as submitted. Recognizing that the standards of this title are minimum requirements and the public health, safety, and general welfare may be best served by exceeding those minimums, the City Commission or Planning Director may require as a condition of approval, additional landscaping, screening, timing requirements, setbacks or other mitigation exceeding the minimums of this title. 182 Ordinance #1761. page 64-2 18.64.020 ADMINISTRATION AND ENFORCEMENT - PLANNING DIRECTOR AUTHORITY A. The Planning Director, or his/her designated representative, shall administer and enforce this title. He/she may be provided with the assistance of such other persons as the Planning Director may supervise and those assistants shall have essentially the same responsibilities as directed by the Planning Director. B. The Planning Director may in the administration of this title consult with other persons having expertise in relevant subject areas as in his/her opinion is necessary for the review of the proposed development or administration of the title. C. If the Planning Director shall find that any of the provisions of this title are being violated, he/she shall notify in writing the person responsible for such violations, indicating the nature of the violation and ordering the action necessary to correct it. He/she shall order discontinuance of illegal use of land, illegal additions, alterations or structural changes; discontinuance of any illegal work being done; or shall take any other action authorized by this title to ensure compliance with or prevent violation of its provisions. 18.64.030 ENFORCEMENT - PLANNING DIRECTOR This title shall be enforced by the Planning Director and his/her authorized representatives. No development approval, subdivision approval, building permit or business or occupational use license shall be issued, except in compliance with the provisions of this title. 18.64.040 STOP-WORK ORDER - PLANNING DIRECTOR, BUILDING OFFICIAL, CITY ENGINEER AUTHORITY Whenever any subdivision, development or building work is being done contrary to the provisions of this title, the Planning Director shall order the work stopped by notice in writing served on any person engaged in doing or causing such work to be done, and any such person shall forthwith stop such work until authorized by the Planning Director to proceed with the work. The Building Official or City Engineer may also issue a stop-work order when building work is being done contrary to the provisions of this title. 18.64.050 PERMISSION TO ENTER The City Commission, or its designated agents, may conduct such investigations, examinations and site evaluations as they deem necessary to verify the information supplied. The submission of material or a plat for review shall constitute a grant of permission to enter the subject property. The grant of permission shall continue until all final actions required by the approval process have been completed. 18.64.060 INACCURATE OR INCOMPLETE INFORMATION AND WAIVERS A. The City shall review each submitted application for completeness and sufficiency as described in §§ 18.06.040 and 18.34.070, BMC. B. The final approval body may withdraw approval or conditional approval of a preliminary plat or other development approval if they determine that information provided by the applicant, and upon which approval or conditional approval of the preliminary plat or other development was based, is inaccurate or incomplete. 1. Within thirty calendar days following approval or conditional approval of a preliminary plat or other development application, any person or agency that claims that information provided by the applicant is inaccurate or incomplete may submit the information and proof to the planning department. 183 Ordinance #1761. page 64-3 2. The Planning Department shall investigate the claim, the accompanying information and proof, and make a report to the final approval authority (City Commission or the Planning Director) within thirty working days after receipt of the information. If the final approval authority is the City Commission, the Commission shall consider the information and proof, and shall make a determination regarding the claim at a regular meeting. Notice of the meeting or presentation of the report shall be given to the claimant and the applicant. 18.64.070 COORDINATED REVIEWS When a proposed subdivision, development or use is also proposed to be annexed to the City of Bozeman, the City shall coordinate the development review and annexation procedures to minimize duplication of hearings, reports, and other requirements whenever possible. The City Commission shall also hold joint public hearings on the initial zoning and the annexation whenever possible. Based upon the circumstances of proposed development the City may require sequential review of applications. 18.64.080 DATE OF SUBMITTAL AND ASSOCIATED REVIEW STANDARDS A. Subdivision. Review and approval or disapproval of a subdivision under these regulations may occur only under those regulations in effect at the time a subdivision application for approval of a preliminary plat is deemed sufficient according to §18.06.040, BMC, or for an extension under Chapter 18.06, BMC is submitted to the City of Bozeman. B. Non-subdivision. Review of nonsubdivision applications shall be under such regulations as are in effect at the time an application for approval of a preliminary site plan is deemed complete according to § 18.34.070, BMC; except that an interim zoning ordinance adopted according to § 76-3-306, MCA shall apply to a nonsubdivision application without limitation to the date of completeness of the application until final action has been taken on the application. .An applicant may waive, in writing, the shield from changing ordinances established by this section. In the event that such waiver is provided, the non-subdivision application shall be reviewed under the ordinances in effect on the date of the final action on the application. 18.64.090 PLANNING DIRECTOR AND BUILDING OFFICIAL - PLAN APPLICATION CHECKING - NOTICE OF NONCOMPLIANCE A. It is the intent of this title that the Planning Director and Building Official, or their designees, shall check all development plans and applications for permits for compliance with this title both before and during construction. B. If, during this procedure, the Planning Director and/or the Building Official deems that the proposed plan or construction does not comply with this title, he shall inform the applicant of the infraction and shall stop all construction on the project until such time as the applicant, builder or principal revises his plan to conform to this title and/or fulfills the requirements of any mandated review procedure(s) as set forth in this title. 18.64.100 BUILDING PERMIT REQUIREMENTS No building or other structure shall be erected, moved, added to or structurally altered and no land use shall be changed without valid permits as prescribed in this chapter. A. Only minor site surface preparation and normal maintenance shall be allowed prior to conditional approval by the appropriate review authority and the issuance of a building permit, providing that such activity does not include excavation for foundations or the removal of mature, healthy vegetation. Minor site surface preparation means disturbing less than one-half acre, movement of 30 cubic yards or less of material, or a cut or fill of less than cumulative one foot whichever is less. Any excavation and site disturbance must be in conformance with an 184 Ordinance #1761. page 64-4 approved storm water control plan. Upon conditional approval by the appropriate review authority, excavation for foundations and the preparation of forms may occur. However, no concrete shall be poured and no further construction shall commence until final site or sketch plan approval has been granted and until building permits have been issued. Proceeding prior to building permit issuance is at the hazard of the landowner. 1. EXCEPTION: When construction and funding of public streets are occurring under the provisions of Chapter 18.36, BMC, Planned Unit Development (PUD), the issuance of building permits may be allowed prior to completion of infrastructure improvements, pursuant to the provisions established in Chapter 18.74, BMC. B. Building Permit. Within the limits of the City, building permits shall be obtained by following the latest version of the International Building Code (International Code Council, 5360 South Workman Mill Road, Whittier, California) adopted by the City. C. The building permit shall be obtained by application to the Building Official. Applications shall be accompanied by plans in duplicate, drawn to scale showing the actual dimensions and shape of the lot to be built upon; the legal description of the parcel; the exact sizes and location on the lot(s) of buildings already existing, if any; the location and dimensions of the proposed buildings or alternatives; and two copies of the approved site plan or sketch plan as approved under Chapters 18.34, 18.36, etc. of this title. D. One copy of the plans shall be returned to the applicant after the Building Official and Planning Director have marked each copy either as approved or disapproved and attested to same by their signatures. The second copy similarly marked shall be retained by the Building Department. E. Approval of any plan that has been granted based upon false information provided by the applicant shall be deemed void without requirement for further action by the City. F Based upon an approved sketch, site plan, certificate of appropriateness, conditional use permit or planned unit development (hereinafter referred to as “plan”), and after any appeals have been resolved, a building permit for the site may be requested and may be granted, provided such building permit is granted within one year of plan approval. Prior to lapse of one year, the applicant may seek an extension of one additional year from the Planning Director. In such instances, the Planning Director shall determine that the terms and circumstances have not significantly changed since the initial approval. 18.64.110 PERMIT ISSUANCE - CONFORMITY WITH REGULATIONS REQUIRED No permit or license of any type shall be issued unless in conformance with the regulations contained within this title. Permits issued on the basis of plans and applications approved by the Building Official and Planning Director authorize only the use, arrangement and construction set forth in such approved plans and applications, and no other use, arrangement or construction. Use, arrangement or construction at variance with that authorized shall be deemed a violation of this title, punishable as provided in this chapter. 18.64.120 PERMITS ISSUED CONTRARY TO TITLE DEEMED VOID Any authorization, including without limitation subdivision approval, site plan approval or building permit, issued, granted or approved in violation of the provisions of this title shall be null and void and of no effect without the necessity of any proceedings or a revocation or nullification thereof, and any work undertaken or use established pursuant to any such building permit or other authorization shall be unlawful. 185 Ordinance #1761. page 64-5 18.64.130 EXPIRATION OF PERMITS Every permit issued by the Building Official under the provisions of this title shall expire by limitation and become null and void if the building or work authorized by such permit has not commenced within 180 calendar days from the date of such permits, or if the building or work authorized by such permit is suspended or abandoned at any time after the work is commenced for a period of 120 calendar days. Before such work can be recommenced, a new permit shall first be obtained to do so, and the fee therefore shall be one-half the amount required for a new permit for such work, provided no changes have been made or will be made in the original plans and specifications for the work, and provided further that such suspension or abandonment has not exceeded one year. 18.64.140 FEE SCHEDULE A. The City Commission shall establish a schedule of fees, charges and expenses and a collection procedure for reviews, permits, appeals and other matters pertaining to this title. The schedule of fees for the procedures listed below shall be set from time to time by the City Commission by resolution. The fees shall be available in the office of the Planning Director and may be altered or amended only by the City Commission. B. No subdivision, permit, zone change, site plan, conditional use, special temporary use, planned unit development, deviation or variance shall be issued unless or until such costs, charges, fees or expenses have been paid in full, nor shall any action be taken on proceedings before the administrative design review staff, Development Review Committee, the Design Review Board, the Zoning Commission, the Planning Board or the City Commission until fees have been paid in full. 18.64.150 COMPLAINTS OF ALLEGED VIOLATIONS - FILING AND RECORDING Whenever a violation of this title occurs or is alleged to have occurred, any person may file a written complaint. Such complaint, stating fully the causes and basis thereof shall be filed with the Planning Director. He shall record properly such complaint and immediately investigate and take action thereon as provided by this title. 18.64.160 VIOLATION - PENALTY - ASSISTING OR ABETTING - ADDITIONAL REMEDIES A. Violation of the provisions of this title or failure to comply with any of its requirements including violations of conditions and safeguards established in connection with the grant of variances or conditional uses or any of the required conditions imposed by the Planning Director and/or City Commission shall constitute a misdemeanor. Any person who violates this title or fails to comply with any of its requirements shall upon conviction thereof be fined or imprisoned or both, as set forth in state law regarding subdivision and zoning, and in addition shall pay all costs and expenses involved in the case except as stated in subsection D of this section. 1. Each day such violation continues shall be considered a separate offense and punishable as such. 2. For violations relating to plats each sale, lease or transfer of each separate parcel of land in violation of any provision of these regulations or the Montanan Subdivision and Platting Act shall be deemed a separate and distinct offense. B. The code compliance officer is authorized to issue a notice to appear under the provisions of §46-6-310, MCA to any violator of this title. 186 Ordinance #1761. page 64-6 C. The owner or tenant of any building, structure, premises or part thereof, and any architect, builder, contractor, agent or other person who commits, participates in, assists or maintains such violation may each be found guilty of a separate offense and suffer the penalties herein provided. D. If transfers not in accordance with these regulations or the Montana Subdivision and Platting Act are made, the City Attorney shall commence action to enjoin further sales or transfers and compel compliance with all provisions of these regulations. The cost of the action must be imposed against the party not prevailing. E. When a violation has not been corrected by the property owner after written notice from the City, the enforcement officer or Planning Director may seek approval for filing at the Gallatin County Clerk and Recorder’s Office a Notice of Violation or Noncompliance. Such notice shall serve to advise potential purchasers of existing violations of this title or of on-going enforcement actions regarding a property. Such notice shall clearly state that the parcel or development on the parcel is in violation of this title and that correction of the violation must be made prior to the City approving additional development or redevelopment of the site. The notice shall also describe the nature of the violation and applicable citations to the relevant sections of this title. 1. When such a notice is to be filed the enforcement officer shall either: a. Through the office of the City Attorney bring an action for civil and/or injunctive relief that requests a court order to record a Notice of Violation or Noncompliance; or b. Schedule a public hearing meeting to be held before the City Commission with the intention of receiving an order from the City Commission confirming the validity of the violation and the need for correction, and authorizing the recording of the Notice of Violation or Noncompliance. Notice of such a hearing shall be provided as required by Chapter 18.76, BMC. 2. When a violation has been corrected for which a Notice of Violation or Noncompliance was filed, the City shall record a release of noncompliance indicating that the prior violation has been corrected. The property owner is responsible for notifying the Planning Department in writing of the correction of the violation or noncompliance. Upon receipt of such notification by the property owner, the enforcement officer shall conduct an inspection to verify correction prior to the recording of the release. F. The City may maintain an action or proceeding in a court of competent jurisdiction to compel compliance with, or to restrain by injunction the violation of, any provision of this title. G. Nothing herein contained shall prevent the City from taking such other lawful action as is nec- essary to prevent or remedy any violation. H. Violation of this Title is a municipal infraction and may be punishable by a civil penalty as provided in Section 1.24.040 BMC, in addition to other remedies of Section 18.64.160 except that the Court shall impose the following minimum civil penalties. 1. Each day such violation continues shall be considered a separate offense and punishable as such. The minimum civil penalty for violation of this title by the same person for the same violation within a 12 month period shall be: a. First citation $100.00 b. Second citation $150.00 c. Third and subsequent citations $200.00 d. The determining factor with respect to the civil penalty is the receipt of service of the citation and not the judgment. 187 Ordinance # 1761. page 72-1 CHAPTER 18.72 SUPPLEMENTARY DOCUMENTS 18.72.010 GENERAL When required, the supplementary documents described in this chapter shall be submitted in draft form with the preliminary plat or plan, and signed and notarized with the final plat or plan. The proper notary block shall be used. 18.72.020 PROPERTY OWNERS ASSOCIATION A. General. If common property is to be deeded to the property owners association or similar organization, of if the property owners association will be responsible for the maintenance of the development’s streets, centers, landscaping in street boulevards, parkland or pathways, property owners association bylaws or the declaration of covenants, conditions and restrictions shall be prepared and recorded with the final plat. B. Bylaws or Covenants, Conditions and Restrictions Contents. The property owners association bylaws or declaration of covenants, conditions and restrictions shall contain the following information: 1. Membership. Automatic and mandatory membership for each property or unit buyer and any subsequent buyer. 2. Common Land/Facilities. The legal description of the common land and a description of common facilities. 3. Enforcement. Persons or entities entitled to enforce the restrictions, responsibilities and payment of assessments, including the City of Bozeman. 4. Perpetual Reservation. Perpetual reservation and limited use of common property. 5. Right to Use. The right of each property or unit owner to use and enjoyment of any common property or facility. 6. Responsibility. Responsibility for liability insurance, any applicable tax assessments and the maintenance of any common property or facilities to be placed in the association. 7. Assessments. A mechanism to assess the common expenses for the land or facilities including upkeep and maintenance expenses, real estate taxes and insurance premiums. Assessments shall require each property or unit owner to pay a pro rata share of the cost of any common expenses, with any assessment charged by the association becoming a lien where necessary on individual parcels. Safeguards against unreasonably high charges and provision to adjust assessments may be provided. 8. A mechanism for resolving disputes among the owners or association members. 9. The conditions and timing of the transfer of ownership and control of land facilities to the association. 10. Any other matter the developer or the City of Bozeman deems appropriate. 11. In the event it becomes necessary for a property owners association to retain an attorney to enforce any of the association bylaws or covenants, conditions and restrictions, then the prevailing party shall be entitled to reasonable attorney’s fees and costs. C. If the property owners association fails to install or maintain improvements according to approved plans, the City may, at its option, complete construction of improvements and/or maintain improvements in compliance with §18.72.030 and Chapter 18.74, BMC. The City’s representative, contractors and engineers shall have the right to enter upon the property and 188 Ordinance # 1761. page 72-2 perform such work, and the property owners association shall permit and secure any additional permission required to enable them to do so. The City shall bill the property owners association for any costs associated with the installation or maintenance of improvements. 18.72.030 COVENANTS The City of Bozeman may require covenants to be recorded with the final plat when it is determined they are necessary for the protection of the public health, safety and general welfare. All covenants shall be considered to run with the land. If the covenants are not marked or noted on the final subdivision plat, they shall be contained in a separate instrument which shall be recorded with the final plat. The covenants may be required to include, but are not limited to, the following provisions: A. That all county declared noxious weeds will be controlled. B. A section addressing agricultural uses of neighboring properties in the following form: Lot owners and residents of the subdivision are informed that adjacent uses may be agricultural. Lot owners accept and are aware that standard agricultural and farming practices can result in dust, animal odors and noise, smoke, flies, and machinery noise. Standard agricultural practices feature the use of heavy equipment, chemical sprays and the use of machinery early in the morning and sometimes late into the evening. C. That all fences bordering agricultural lands shall be maintained by the landowners in accordance with state law. D. The property owners association shall be responsible for the maintenance of subdivision streets, common open space, centers, pathways, landscaping in street boulevards and/or parks. E. That any covenant which is required as a condition of the preliminary plat approval and required by the City Commission may not be amended or revoked without the mutual consent of the owners in accordance with the amendment procedures in the covenants, and the City Commission. F. The condition and timing of the transfer of the property owners association from developer to the subsequent purchasers. G. Common Area and Facility Maintenance Plan. The developer shall submit a legal instrument setting forth a plan providing for the permanent care and maintenance of common areas and facilities. These common areas and facilities shall include but are not limited to commonly owned open spaces, recreational areas, facilities, private streets and parking lots. These common areas and facilities shall also include but are not limited to public parks, squares, open space, recreation areas, trails, as well as any public streets, avenues and alleys not accepted by the City for maintenance. The same shall be submitted to the City Attorney and shall not be accepted by the City until approved as to legal form and effect. If the common areas are deeded to a property owners association, the applicant shall record the proposed documents governing the association at the time of final plat filing. Such documents shall meet the following requirements: 1. The property owners association must be established before any residences or other properties are sold; 2. Membership in the association must be mandatory for each property owner with a specified method of assigning voting rights; 3. Open space restrictions must be permanent and not for a period of years; 4. The property owners association must be made responsible for liability insurance, taxes, and maintenance of common facilities; 5. The association must have the power to levy assessments which can become a lien on individual premises for the purpose of paying the cost of operating and maintaining common facilities; and 189 Ordinance # 1761. page 72-3 6. The governing board of any such association shall consist of at least five members who shall be owners of property in the development. H. Common Area and Facility Maintenance Guarantee. In the event the organization or any successor organization established to own and maintain common areas and facilities, shall at any time fail to maintain the common areas or facilities in reasonable order and condition in accordance with the approved plan, the City Commission may cause written notice to be served upon such organization or upon the owners of property in the development. The written notice shall set forth the manner in which the common areas or facilities have failed to be maintained in reasonable condition. In addition, the notice shall include the demand that the deficiencies noted be cured within thirty days thereafter and shall state the date and place of a hearing public meeting to be held within fourteen days of the notice. At the time of hearingpublic meeting, the City Commission may modify the terms of the original notice as to deficiencies and may extend the time within which the same may be cured. If the deficiencies set forth in the original notice or modifications are not cured within the time set, the City may enter upon such common facilities and maintain the same for a period of one year, in order to preserve the taxable values of properties within the development and to prevent the common facilities from becoming a public nuisance. Such entry and maintenance shall not vest in the public any right to use the common facilities not dedicated to public use. Before the one year period expires, the Commission shall, upon its own initiative or upon written request of the organization theretofore responsible for maintenance, call a public hearing meeting and give notice of such hearing meeting to the organization responsible for maintenance or the property owners of the development. At the hearing, the organization responsible for maintenance and/or the residents of the development may show cause why maintenance by the City should not be continued for a succeeding year. If the City Commission determines that it is not necessary for the City to continue such maintenance, the City shall cease such maintenance at the time established by the City Commission. Otherwise the City shall continue maintenance for the next succeeding year subject to a similar hearing meeting and determination at the end of each year thereafter. 1. The cost of maintenance by the City shall be a lien against the common facilities of the development and the private properties within the development. The City Commission shall have the right to make assessments against properties in the development on the same basis that the organization responsible for maintenance of the facilities could make such assessments. Any unpaid assessment shall be a lien against the property responsible for the same, enforceable the same as a mortgage against such property. The City may further foreclose its lien on the common facility by certifying the same to the County Treasurer for collection as in the case of collection of general property taxes. 2. Should the property owners association request that the City assume permanent responsibility for maintenance of facilities, all facilities shall be brought to City standards prior to the City assuming responsibility. The assumption of responsibility must be by action of the City Commission and all costs to bring facilities to City standards shall be the responsibility of the property owners association. The City may create special financing mechanisms so that those properties within the area affected by the property owners association continue to bear the costs of maintenance. 3. These common areas and facilities shall include but are not limited to commonly owned open spaces, recreational areas, facilities, private streets and parking lots. These common areas and facilities shall also include but are not limited to public parks, squares, open space, recreation areas, trails, as well as any public streets, avenues and alleys not accepted by the City for maintenance. 4. The City shall assume permanent responsibility for maintenance of public areas and facilities when a dedicated funding mechanism is adopted. 190 Ordinance # 1761. page 72-4 I. Guarantee for Open Space Preservation. Open space shown on the approved final plan or plat shall not be used for the construction of any structures not shown on the final plan. J. Covenants may not contain provisions which inhibit compliance with the requirements of Chapter 17.02, BMC for those developments subject to Chapter 17.02, BMC. Some examples are: privately required minimum home or lot sizes which can not be met. 191 Ordinance # 1761. page 74-1 CHAPTER 18.74 IMPROVEMENTS AND GUARANTEES 18.74.010 PURPOSE AND APPLICABILITY A. This chapter is to provide standards and procedures relating to the installation of physical improvements and compliance with requirements related to development. As these improvements are necessary to meet requirements of the law and to protect public health, safety and general welfare and other purposes of this title it is also necessary to provide means by which their installation can be assured. Such improvements may include, but are not limited to, design elements such as landscaping, parking facilities, storm drainage facilities, architectural features, pedestrian walkways and public utilities. Furthermore, in some situations it is in the best interest of the person conducting development to be able to guarantee the completion of certain work and be able to begin utilization of a development sooner than would otherwise be possible if all improvements had to be physically installed before use could begin. This chapter therefore has the following purposes: 1. Ensure completion of required improvements or compliance with other requirements of development to an acceptable standard; 2. Provide buyer/lessee protection while allowing a person undertaking development to proceed with sales/leases before the project is totally complete, especially multi-phased projects; 3. Ensure adequate warranty or maintenance, when appropriate, of improvements; 4. Provide for mechanisms to ensure performance of or conformance with conditions of approval or development requirements; and 5. Accomplish the above listed purposes through mechanisms that reduce the need to rely on costly litigation to accomplish those purposes. B. This chapter applies to all subdivisions and site developments as described below. 1. Subdivisions shall install or provide security for installation of improvements prior to final platting as set forth in detail in this chapter. 2. Site developments including, site plans, conditional use permits, planned unit developments, reuses and certificates of appropriateness, shall install improvements or provide security for installation prior to occupancy or commencement of use. 3. The City may determine the nature and timing of required installation of improvements as part of the subdivision or site development process. When necessary to protect the health, safety, and general welfare of the public, and ensure the function and viability of development, certain needed improvements may not be allowed to be financially guaranteed. 18.74.020 STANDARDS FOR IMPROVEMENTS A. General. It shall be the responsibility of the developer to comply with the following procedures and standards for the installation of development improvements. 1. Construction Routes. For all developments, excluding sketch and reuse/further development, a construction route map shall be provided showing how materials and heavy equipment will travel to and from the site. The route shall avoid, where possible, local or minor collector streets or streets where construction traffic would disrupt neighborhood residential character or pose a threat to public health and safety. 192 Ordinance # 1761. page 74-2 2. Protection of Existing Improvements. The developer, his contractors and suppliers shall be jointly and severally responsible to ensure that existing improvements are not damaged or rendered less useful by the operation of the developer, his contractors or suppliers. Such protection of improvements may include requirements for cleaning of vehicles leaving a construction site. This provision is intended to preclude damage to existing roads, streets, water, sewer and drainage systems. The City Engineer may instruct the developer as to the streets or roads to be used for access by construction equipment, and the developer shall be responsible for enforcement of this instruction upon his contractors and their suppliers. The City of Bozeman may require the developer to post a surety to guarantee repair of damages. B. Improvements to be Dedicated to the Public. 1 Plans and Specifications. Engineering and survey plans, specifications and reports required in connection with public improvements and other elements of the subdivision, or other development required by the City of Bozeman, shall be prepared by a registered engineer and/or a registered land surveyor, licensed in the State of Montana, as their respective licensing laws allow. The plans and specifications shall be prepared in compliance with the City of Bozeman’s Design Standards and Specifications Policy. 2. Scope of Work. The intent of these regulations is to provide standards by which the contractor and the developer shall execute their respective responsibilities and guarantee proper construction and completion in every detail of the work in accordance with the plans, specifications and terms set forth under these regulations. a. The developer shall furnish the plans, specifications and typical sections for approval by the City Engineer. It shall be understood that the work to be done will not necessarily be limited to occurring within the right-of-way boundaries. b. The City Engineer shall have authority to make or cause to be made any reasonable changes, alterations, amendments and additions to the standard specifications for infrastructure improvements. 3. Control of Work. During the course of construction, and at the completion of each phase of the project, the developer’s registered civil engineer shall submit a statement that the improvements have been inspected and found to have been constructed in accordance with the approved plans and specifications. Prior to making any changes, the developer’s engineer shall notify and receive written approval or disapproval from the City Engineer for any changes in approved plans and specifications. 4. Improvement Procedure. a. Approval of the improvement plans and specifications shall be completed before installation of improvements or the entering into of an agreement where surety is to be provided for the completion of the improvements. b. The procedure for submittal, review and approval of improvement plans and specifications is contained in the City of Bozeman’s Design Standards and Specifications Policy, and shall be followed by the developer and/or his contractors. c. After the preliminary plat has received approval or conditional approval, and before the final plat is submitted, the developer shall either install the required improvements or enter into an agreement with the City of Bozeman financially guaranteeing the installation and performance of the improvements. d. After the final site plan is approved, subject to §18.74.030.C, BMC, and prior to occupancy of any buildings, the developer shall either install the required 193 Ordinance # 1761. page 74-3 improvements or enter into an agreement with the City of Bozeman financially guaranteeing the installation and performance of the improvements. 5. Sanitary Facilities. Water supply, sewage disposal and solid waste disposal systems shall meet the minimum standards of the City of Bozeman and the Montana Department of Environmental Quality as required by §76-4-101 through §76-4-135, MCA, and regulations adopted pursuant thereto, and are subject to the approval of the City of Bozeman. C. Private Improvements. Improvements shall be constructed as shown on the approved final site plan, final plat, or plans and specifications, as may be applicable. The developer is responsible for coordinating installation with all necessary parties and to restore to its original condition any public improvements or any private improvements or property damaged during installation of private improvements. 18.74.030 COMPLETION OF IMPROVEMENTS A. General. The applicant shall provide certification by the architect, landscape architect, engineer or other applicable professional that all improvements to be dedicated to the public were installed in accordance with the approved site plan, plans and specifications, or plat as applicable. For required private improvements, the applicant shall provide certification by the architect, landscape architect, engineer or other applicable professional that all improvements, including but not limited to, landscaping, ADA accessibility requirements, private infrastructure, or other required elements were installed in accordance with the approved site plan, plans and specifications, or plat as applicable, unless a waiver of certification in whole or part is explicitly approved by the DRC. 1. Improvements to be Dedicated to the Public. Improvements to be dedicated to the public, such as water mains, sewer mains and public streets, shall be installed in accordance with the approved plans and specifications by the developer, and certified by a registered professional civil engineer, licensed in the state of Montana, and accepted by the City prior to the approval of the final plat, building permit, issuance of a certificate of occupancy or other identified benchmark as may be appropriate. As-built drawings complying with the City of Bozeman’s Design Standards and Specifications Policy, including timing for submittal of materials, shall be provided. a. Public street means a public right-of-way or easement developed to adopted City standards including, but not limited to, the following improvements: curbs, gutters, storm drainage, sidewalks, paving, traffic control signage or equipment, and lighting. 2. Private Improvements and Other Required Improvements. Improvements, such as but not limited to, landscaping, paving or irrigation shall be installed in accordance with the approved preliminary plat or final site plan by the developer and inspected and found to comply with the City standards or requirements prior to the approval of the final plat, issuance of a certificate of occupancy for the building(s) or site, or other identified benchmark as may be appropriate. All improvements required as part of a subdivision must be installed and accepted, or financially secured in accordance with an improvements agreement, prior to final plat approval. 3. Improvements Agreement Required. All improvements necessary or required to meet the standards of this title or conditions of approval shall be the subject of an improvements agreement and be guaranteed for final plat approval, occupancy of buildings or other utilization of an approved development is allowed before the improvements are completed and inspected by the City. 194 Ordinance # 1761. page 74-4 a. Reservation. The City reserves the right to require actual installation of improvements prior to occupancy when such improvements are necessary to provide for health, safety and welfare or adequate function of systems or onsite development. B. Completion Time for Subdivisions. 1. All subdivision improvements, including parks, shall be constructed and completed as approved by the City. a. All improvements shall be installed prior to the issuance of a building permit for any lot within a subdivision unless otherwise provided for in development proposals occurring under the provisions of Chapter 18.36, BMC, Planned Unit Development (PUD), when concurrent construction is an identified purpose of the initial project review, and pursuant to the criteria established in §18.74.030.D, BMC. b. The subdivider shall meet one of the following requirements for completion of street improvements. The option SHALL be specified in the preliminary plat submittal. Should the applicant not identify which option is desired option (1) shall be required. Altering the choice of option after approval of the development shall constitute a material modification to the project and require rereview of the project for modification to the approval subject to the provisions of §18.02.070, BMC. (1) The subdivision streets improvements shall be installed prior to final plat approval. This requirement may be modified by the City Engineer for streets where dictated by circumstances, and where acceptable improvement security for the ultimate development of the streets is provided. However, under no circumstances shall the required gravel courses, curbs or gutters be waived. This requirement shall generally not be modified for nonresidential developments; or (2) The subdivider shall enter into an improvements agreement guaranteeing the completion of the paving, curb, gutter, storm drainage, street lighting or other street infrastructure improvements not yet completed. The improvements agreement shall be financially guaranteed, as explained in this chapter. However, at a minimum, the plans and specifications for the street improvements must be approved by the City Engineer prior to final plat approval. Building permits will not be issued until the street improvements are completed and accepted by the City of Bozeman unless otherwise provided for in development proposals occurring under the provisions of Chapter 18.36, BMC, Planned Unit Development (PUD), and pursuant to the criteria established in §18.74.030.D, BMC; or (3) The subdivider may request that street improvements be guaranteed by the creation of a special improvements district (SID). If a SID is formed for the improvements, the SID bonds must be sold before the final plat can be filed. SIDs shall not be permitted for the installation of subdivision water and sewer improvements. Building permits will not be issued until the street improvements are completed and accepted by the City of Bozeman unless otherwise provided for in development proposals occurring under the provisions of Chapter 18.36, BMC, Planned Unit Development (PUD), and pursuant to the criteria established in §18.74.030.D, BMC. 195 Ordinance # 1761. page 74-5 2. Sidewalks. City standard sidewalks (including a concrete sidewalk section through all private drive approaches) shall be constructed on all public and private street frontages prior to occupancy of any structure on individual lots. Should a subdivider choose not to install all sidewalks prior to final plat, an improvements agreement shall be entered into with the City of Bozeman guaranteeing the completion of all sidewalks within the subdivision within a three-year period. The developer shall supply the City of Bozeman with an acceptable method of security equal to 150 percent of these remaining sidewalk improvements. a. The subdivider shall install sidewalks adjacent to public lands, including but not limited to, parks, open space, and the intersection of alleys and streets or street easements. Sidewalks in these areas shall be installed prior to final plat approval, or shall be subject to an approved improvements agreement and financially guaranteed. b. Upon the third anniversary of the plat recordation of any phase of the subdivision, any lot owner who has not constructed said sidewalk shall, without further notice, construct within 30 days, said sidewalk for their lot(s), regardless of whether other improvements have been made upon the lot. 3. Subdivision Lighting. Subdivision lighting, as required in §18.42.150, BMC shall be incorporated into all subdivisions. by means of one of the following. The option SHALL be specified in the preliminary plat submittal. Should the applicant not identify which option is desired, option b shall be required. Altering the choice of option after approval of the development shall constitute a material modification to the project and require rereview of the project for modification to the approval subject to the provisions of §18.02.070, BMC. a. The subdivider shall install street and pathway lighting throughout the subdivision in compliance with this section. OR b. The subdivider shall participate in a street improvement lighting district (SILD) for the provision of street and pathway lighting. Prior to final plat approval, subdivision lighting shall be installed, or financially guaranteed, or a SILD shall be created and the bonds sold. If the subdivision lighting is financially guaranteed, they shall be considered as part of the required street improvements and building permits shall not be issued until the improvements are installed, unless otherwise provided for in development proposals occurring under the provisions of Chapter 18.36, BMC, Planned Unit Development (PUD), and pursuant to the criteria established in §18.74.030.D, BMC. C. Completion Time for Site Development. Whenever any building lots and/or building sites are created inside the City limits, and prior to the issuance of any building permits on such lots or sites, municipal water distribution systems, and municipal sanitary sewer collection systems, and streets shall be provided to the site. Each building site must utilize and be connected to both the municipal water distribution and municipal sanitary sewer collection systems. Subject to the provisions of subsection 1 below, these improvements shall be designed, constructed and installed according to the standards and criteria as adopted by the City and approved by both the City Engineer and Water and Sewer Superintendent prior to the issuance of any building permits. 196 Ordinance # 1761. page 74-6 1. Provision of municipal central water distribution, municipal sanitary sewer collection systems, and streets means that the criteria in either subsection a or subsections b and c are met: a. Water, sewer and street services are installed and accepted by the City with service stubs being extended into the site, with such stubs being of adequate size to provide water and sewer service to the proposed development without modification to publicly owned infrastructure; OR b. The water mains, sewer mains and streets to be extended to provide service to the development are: located within a publicly dedicated right-of-way or easement; constructed to City of Bozeman standards; are physically adjacent to the site proposed for construction; are installed and accepted by the City; and are adequate in capacity to provide necessary service to the proposed development; and comply with the requirements of this subsection and subsection c below: c. Water mains, sewer mains and streets shall meet the following requirements. (1) Any required onsite extensions of water mains, sewer mains or streets to be dedicated to the public shall be located entirely within publicly held easements or rights-of-way; shall serve only a single lot; are the subject of an irrevocable offer of dedication to the City upon completion of the project; the development is under the control of a single developer who shall retain control of the entire project until final completion; all work is under the supervision of a single general contractor; and no subdivision of land is involved; (2) The DRC shall determine when the standards of this subsection are met. The Fire Department must consider whether adequate fire protection services are available from existing hydrants, and water supply exists to meet needs during construction. If adequate fire protection does not exist then concurrent infrastructure and building construction may only occur under the provisions of subsection (3) below. Based on evaluation by the Fire Department, simultaneous construction of infrastructure to be dedicated to the public and private construction may be permitted only within a defined portion of the site; (3) Approval of the final engineering design, including location and grade, for the infrastructure project must be obtained from the Engineering Department, and the Montana Department of Environmental Quality when applicable, prior to issuance of any building permit for the development; and (4) No occupancy, either temporary or final, may be issued until all onsite and offsite water, sewer and street or drive improvements are installed and accepted or approved as applicable by the City. D. Exception. When municipal water distribution and municipal sanitary sewer collection systems and City streets are being provided to serve a development proposal occurring under the provisions of Chapter 18.36, BMC, Planned Unit Development (PUD), the issuance of a building permit may be allowed prior to completion of the public infrastructure, provided that the following criteria are met: 1. The subject property shall be developed under the provisions of Chapter 18.36, BMC; 2. The subdivider or other developer must enter into an improvements agreement to assure the installation of required infrastructure and other applicable improvements, to be 197 Ordinance # 1761. page 74-7 secured by a financial guarantee in an amount to be determined by the city, with said guarantee to be in the name of the City; 3. Approval of the final engineering design, including location and grade, for the infrastructure project must be obtained from the Engineering Department, and the Montana Department of Environmental Quality when applicable, prior to issuance of any building permit for the development; 4. Building permits may be issued incrementally, dependent upon the status of installation of the infrastructure improvements. All building construction within the PUD shall cease until required phases of infrastructure improvements as described in the PUD have been completed, and inspected and accepted by the City; 5. The subdivider shall provide and maintain fire hazard and liability insurance which shall name the City as an additional insured and such issuance shall not be cancelled without at least forty-five days prior notice to the City. The subdivider shall furnish evidence, satisfactory to the City, of all such policies and the effective dates thereof; 6. The subdivider recognizes, acknowledges and assumes the increased risk of loss because certain public services do not exist at the site; 7. The subdivider shall enter into an agreement with the City which provides for predetermined infrastructure funding options; 8. No occupancy of any structures or commencement of any use constructed or proposed within the boundaries of the PUD will be allowed until required infrastructure improvements have been completed, and inspected and accepted by the City, and a certificate of occupancy has been issued; a. No occupancy of structures or commencement of any use shall occur when such action would constitute a safety hazard in the opinion of the City; 9. The subdivider shall enter into an agreement with the City to address the provision of any services on an interim basis during construction, if deemed appropriate; 10. The subdivider shall execute a hold harmless and indemnification agreement indemnifying, defending and holding harmless the City, its employees, agents and assigns from and against any and all liabilities, loss, claims, causes of action, judgments and damages resulting from or arising out of the issuance of a building permit under this section; 11. The subdivider shall pay for any extraordinary costs associated with the project which the City may identify, including, but not limited to, additional staff hours to oversee the planning, engineering and construction of the project and infrastructure improvements, inspection of the infrastructure improvements and any extraordinary administrative costs; and 12. The development shall be under the control of a single developer and all work shall be under the supervision of a single general contractor. The developer and general contractor shall agree that there shall be no third-party builders until required infrastructure improvements have been completed, and inspected and accepted by the City. 13. Subsequent to preliminary plat approval, a Concurrent Construction Plan, addressing all requirements of this section, shall be submitted for review and approval of the Planning Director with a recommendation from the Development Review Committee. E. Notwithstanding the provisions of Section D above, the City may limit the scope, type and number of projects eligible for simultaneous construction consideration. 198 Ordinance # 1761. page 74-8 18.74.040 SPECIAL PROVISIONS FOR TIMING OF CERTAIN IMPROVEMENTS A. Park, Pathway, and Boulevard Improvements. 1. These required improvements shall be installed, or subject to an approved improvements agreement and financially guaranteed, prior to final plat approval or occupancy of a building subject to development review, excluding sketch plans. 2. Due to seasonal considerations, building and occupancy permits may be issued prior to installation of these improvements as long as the improvements are subject to an approved improvements agreement and are financially guaranteed. B. Neighborhood Center Improvements. 1. With the exception of neighborhood commercial and civic buildings and their grounds, neighborhood center improvements shall be installed, or subject to an approved improvements agreement and financially guaranteed, prior to final plat approval. 2. Due to seasonal considerations, building and occupancy permits may be issued prior to installation of improvements related to greens, plazas and squares as long as the improvements are subject to an approved improvements agreement and are financially guaranteed. 18.74.050 ACCEPTANCE OF IMPROVEMENTS A. Improvements Dedicated to the Public. 1. Acceptance of Street, Road, and Bridge Improvements. Before any subdivision street, whether new or existing, can be accepted into the City street system by the City of Bozeman, it shall be built to meet or exceed the required standards. Any improvements made to County roads shall meet or exceed standards set by the County Road Office, and must be reviewed and approved by the County Road Office. Any bridge improvement, within the City or the County, shall meet or exceed standards set by the Montana Department of Transportation, and must be reviewed and approved by the County Road Office and the City of Bozeman, and accepted by the County Road Office into the County’s bridge maintenance system. 2. Acceptance of Water, Sewer, and Storm Drainage Improvements. Before any public water, sewer or storm drainage improvement, whether new or existing, can be accepted into the City system by the City of Bozeman, it shall be built to meet or exceed the required standards. Any improvement, within the City or County, shall meet or exceed standards set by the City of Bozeman, Montana Department of Environmental Quality and County Road Office, and must be reviewed and approved by the City of Bozeman and the County Road Office, as applicable. 3. As-Built Record Drawings. As-built record drawings of all public infrastructure improvements constructed within the City of Bozeman, drawn to the specifications required by the Engineering Department, shall be submitted prior to final plat approval, per §8.94.3003(3.g), ARM, or other relevant final benchmark for site development. 4. The City may require verification that all liens have been released and payments made prior to accepting dedication of improvements. B. Private Improvements. The DRC and/or ADR or their representative shall conduct an “as- built” inspection to verify compliance and shall sign off on a certificate of occupancy, final plat or other conclusionary action if all terms and details of the approval are complied with. Except as provided for in §18.74.060 of this chapter, no final plat approval or occupancy shall be permitted, or certificate of occupancy issued, unless the terms and details of an approved plat, 199 Ordinance # 1761. page 74-9 site or sketch plan are met. Prior to grant of occupancy, the developer shall certify the completion of the improvements as required in §18.74.030.A, BMC. 18.74.060 IMPROVEMENTS AGREEMENTS A. Required When. 1. When occupancy of a development subject to zoning review will commence prior to completion of all required site improvements, generally excluding sketch plans; or 2. When a subdivision is to be granted final plat approval prior to the completion of all required improvements, the applicant shall enter into an improvements agreement with the City. 3. At the discretion of the Planning Director, certain projects receiving a certificate of appropriateness may be required to enter into an improvements agreement with the City at the time of final approval of the certificate of appropriateness. B. If an improvements agreement is used to guarantee the completion of required improvements, including infrastructure, it may allow for the staged installation of improvements in defined areas and in accordance with an approved time schedule. At the City’s discretion, the improvements in a prior increment may be required to be completed or the payment or guarantee of payment for costs of the improvements incurred in a prior increment must be satisfied before development of future increments. 1. If an improvements agreement is filed with the final subdivision plat to secure infrastructure improvements, a separate document shall be filed with the final plat that clearly states that building permits will not be issued until all water, sewer, storm drainage infrastructure and streets are installed and accepted. This requirement may be modified by the City Engineer for streets where dictated by circumstances, and where acceptable improvement security for the ultimate development of the streets is provided. However, under no circumstances shall the required gravel courses, curbs or gutters be waived. This requirement shall generally not be modified for nonresidential developments. No building permits will be issued for a subdivision within the City until all required water, sewer, storm drainage, required street lighting, and street gravel courses are installed and accepted unless otherwise provided for in development proposals occurring under the provisions of Chapter 18.36, BMC, Planned Unit Development (PUD), and pursuant to the criteria established in §18.74.030.D, BMC. C. Standards for Improvements Agreements. 1. All Agreements. All improvements agreements shall meet the following standards: a. The agreement and security shall be satisfactory to the City Attorney as to form and manner of execution; b. Detailed cost estimates and construction plans of all required on-site and off-site improvements shall be made a part of the agreement; c. Provide for security in the amount equal to 150 percent of the estimated cost of the improvements to be secured if the agreement is to be activated; d. The term for the security referenced in section c above shall be not less than the length of time of the improvements agreement; d. The agreement shall provide for the City to claim the guarantee by certifying that the developer is in default of the performance to be secured; 200 Ordinance # 1761. page 74-10 e. Requests for partial release of security shall only be in amounts such that the security will always equal 150 percent of the value of the remaining uncompleted work, and such that not more than 90 percent of the security is released prior to completion of all improvements. The City may take into account the location and scope of development phases in evaluating requests to reduce the amount of a financial guarantee. The City may require verification that all liens have been released and payments made prior to releasing a portion of the security; f. Shall provide for the City to require a replacement security in the event the issuer of the security becomes insolvent, enters receivership, or otherwise gives cause for the City to lack confidence in the ability of the issuer to honor the security; g. Shall permit the City in the event of default by the developer to include in the costs to be recovered from the security those costs resulting from the need to call in the security, including but not limited to costs for the City Attorney’s time; and h. The financial security shall be placed in the keeping of the City Treasurer. 2. Subdivisions. Improvements agreements for subdivisions shall meet the following standards in addition to those listed in subsection C.1 above: a. The length of time of the agreement shall not exceed 1 year from the date of final plat approval. The agreement shall stipulate the time schedule the subdivider proposes for accomplishing the required improvements; b. The estimated cost of improvements shall be provided by the subdivider’s professional engineer. The City Engineer has the discretion to require a second estimate of the cost of improvements, with the cost of obtaining the second estimate borne by the subdivider. The agreement shall stipulate which type of security arrangements will be used; c. Security for improvements for internal subdivision streets, water, storm drainage and sewer mains, shall be reduced only upon recommendation of the City Engineer; d Security for improvements other than internal subdivision streets, water, storm drainage and sewer mains, shall be reduced only upon recommendation of the City Engineer and approval by the City Commission, upon request by the subdivider; e. The improvements agreement shall be filed with the final plat; and f. The security provided shall be a financial security valid for eighteen months. 3. Site Development. Improvements agreements for developments other than subdivisions shall meet the following standards in addition to those listed in subsection C.1 above: a. If occupancy of the structure or commencement of the use is to occur prior to installation of the required improvements, the installation of those improvements must be secured in conformance with the requirements of this chapter; b. The length of time of the agreement and method of security shall not be less than twelve months; c. All secured improvements must be completed by the developer within nine months of occupancy or the security shall be forfeited to the City for the purpose of installing or contracting for the installation of the required improvements; 201 Ordinance # 1761. page 74-11 d. At the Planning Director’s discretion, a developer may be permitted to extend the manner of security, in general for a period not to exceed 1 additional year. Factors such as, but not limited to, progress of installation achieved to date and phasing of projects may be considered; e. The DRC and/or ADR shall determine which, if any, of the required improvements must be installed prior to occupancy, regardless of the use of a secured improvements agreement. Such determination shall be based on a finding that unsafe or hazardous conditions will be created or perpetuated without the installation of certain improvements or that the property will have an unacceptable adverse impact on adjoining properties until such improvements are installed; (1) Items include but are not limited to walkways and signage necessary for ADA compliance, parking surfaces adequate to meet the needs of the uses to be conducted during the term of the improvements agreement, or matters related to life safety are required to be installed prior to any occupancy; and f. When all provisions are met for occupancy of a facility or commencement of a use prior to the installation of all improvements, and adequate security has been provided in accordance with the terms of an improvements agreement, the building official may issue a temporary certificate of occupancy which allows occupancy of the facility on a temporary basis for a period not to exceed nine months. When all required improvements are installed in compliance with all terms and details of the site or sketch plan approval, the temporary occupancy permit shall be withdrawn and a permanent certificate of occupancy shall be issued according to the provisions of this chapter. D. Notwithstanding the provisions of this section, the City may limit the scope, type and number of improvements eligible for being secured by an improvements agreement and require installation prior to final plat approval, issuance of building permits, occupancy or other similar actions. E. The Planning Director shall be responsible to sign improvements agreements on behalf of the City. F. When an improvements agreement is used to allow the filing of a final plat prior to the completion of infrastructure, a notice of improvements agreement shall be recorded along with the plat which indicates that certain infrastructure work is still not complete and identifying that work. When the work has been completed and is accepted by the City as complete, the City shall record a notice of completion stating that the work that was the subject of the improvements agreement is complete. 18.74.070 PAYMENT FOR EXTENSION OF CAPITAL FACILITIES The City of Bozeman may require a subdivider or other site developer to pay or guarantee payment for part or all of the costs of extending capital facilities related to public health and safety, including but not limited to public roads or streets, sewer mains, water supply mains and stormwater facilities for a subdivision. The costs must reasonably reflect the expected impacts directly attributable to the subdivision. The city may not require a subdivider or other site developer to pay or guarantee payment for part or all of the costs of constructing or extending capital facilities related to education. 18.74.080 TYPES OF ACCEPTABLE SECURITIES A. Financial Securities. A variety of means of providing for the security of improvements agreements, ensuring adequate maintenance of required improvements and ensuring compliance with conditions of approval for various developments may be allowed. One or more of the 202 Ordinance # 1761. page 74-12 following instruments may be used to provide a financial security for improvements to be completed. The method, terms and amount of security must be acceptable to the City. Financial security is the primary method to provide security for installation of physical improvements. 1. Direct payment of cash to the City; 2. Irrevocable letters of credit; 3. Cash escrows held by the City, or held by an approved escrow agent and subject to an executed escrow agreement; or 4. Performance bonds, in limited circumstances and subject to approval by the City Attorney. B. Nonfinancial Securities. In addition to the possible financial securities listed above, the following nonfinancial securities may be used to ensure compliance with conditions of approval, ensure maintenance of required improvements and coordinate timing of development. When deemed appropriate, the City may use nonfinancial security methods in combination with a financial security method. 1. Granting of final permits; 2. Sequential approval of multi-phased projects, with subsequent phases to not receive approval until prior approved phases have complied with all requirements; 3. Formation of a special improvement or maintenance district. This method shall not be considered completed until after all final actions have occurred and the district is in existence and the bonds sold; 4. Establishment of a property owners association with City enforceable duties to maintain certain improvements; 5. Irrevocable offer of dedication of improvements to be dedicated to the public after completion of the project; and 6. Recording of a special restrictive covenant or deed restriction which may only be released by written agreement of the City. 18.74.090 DEVELOPMENT OR MAINTENANCE OF COMMON AREAS AND FACILITIES BY DEVELOPER OR PROPERTY OWNERS ASSOCIATION A. General. For the purposes of this section, “common areas and facilities” include: 1. Public and/or private parkland; 2. Boulevard strips in public rights-of-way along external subdivision streets and adjacent to parks and/or open space; 3. Common open space; 4. Neighborhood centers (except for neighborhood commercial and civic uses and their grounds); and 5. Pathways. B. Development. If common areas or facilities will be developed by the subdivider or by a property owners association, a development plan shall be submitted with the preliminary plat application for review and approval. The development plan shall be reviewed and approved by the City prior to the installation of improvements in common areas or the installation of common facilities. An approved park master plan would satisfy this requirement. 1. Landscaping. When landscaping will be installed in parkland, boulevard strips or common open space, the development plan shall be accompanied by a landscaping plan 203 Ordinance # 1761. page 74-13 that was prepared by a qualified landscaping professional. When landscaping in common areas is installed by the subdivider, the subdivider shall warrant against defects in these improvements for a period of two years from the date of installation of the landscaping. 2. Tree Permits. If trees will be planted in dedicated City parkland or boulevard strips, tree planting permits shall be obtained from the Forestry Department. C. Maintenance. When common areas or facilities will be maintained by the subdivider or by a property owners association, a maintenance plan that complies with §18.72.040, BMC shall be submitted with the preliminary plat application for review and approval. The maintenance plan shall include a maintenance schedule, and a mechanism to assess and enforce the common expenses for the common area or facility. The maintenance plan shall be included in the subdivision covenants. The developer shall provide all necessary maintenance until the improvements are transferred to the City, a property owners association, or other final custodian. The provisions of §18.72.040.B, BMC apply to this section. 1. Landscaping Warranty. Any required or proposed landscaping must be maintained in a healthy, growing condition at all times. Any plant that dies must be replaced with another living plant that complies with the approved landscape plan. 2. Shade Tree Maintenance. The Forestry Department shall be responsible for the maintenance of shade trees in all City rights-of-way and on City property, including parks. 18.74.100 WARRANTY All publicly dedicated improvements shall be subject to a warranty of duration and scope to meet the City of Bozeman’s Design Standards and Specifications Manual. 204 Ordinance #1761. page 76-1 CHAPTER 18.76 NOTICING 18.76.010 PURPOSE It is the intent of this chapter to provide for adequate notice of governmental actions to those affected by such actions. Notice is required in order for citizens to participate in decision making which affects their interests and provides opportunity to receive information pertinent to an application that would not otherwise be available to the decision maker. In establishing standards for providing such notice, the need for expeditious processing of applications is also recognized. 18.76.020 CONTENTS OF NOTICE A. The following elements shall be included in notices issued pursuant to this title: 1. Address of the property, or its location by approximate distances from the nearest major street intersections, or other description to identify the affected property; 2. Legal description of the property; 3. The name and address of the applicant; 4. The name and address of the owner of record; 5. The number, date, time and place of all relevant scheduled public hearings by the City Commission, Board of Adjustment, Planning Board or Zoning Commission, meetings of other review bodies established by this title at which final decisions shall be made, or the date of any final public comment deadline; 6. A description of how and where additional information regarding the action may be obtained including the address and phone number of the City; and 7. A brief description of the subject of the notice. B. The following additional elements shall be included in all notices required for site plans, master site plans, certificates of appropriateness, conditional use permits, planned unit developments, deviations, variances and subdivisions: 1. A map of the area in question so as to indicate its general location and proximity to surrounding properties shall be included in mailed and posted notices; and 2. A reference to the appeals process for this title for notices regarding projects where the Board of Adjustment or City Commission will not be making the final decision. C. The following additional elements shall be included in all notices required for text amendments to this title: 1. A summary explanation of the intent of the change, with reference to the exact text being available for public review. D. For site and subdivision developments, Tthe applicant shall provide for the purposes of noticing a list of names and addresses of property owners within 200 feet of the site, using the most current known property owners of record as shown in the records of the County Clerk and Recorder’s Office and stamped, unsealed envelopes (with no return address) addressed with names of above property owners, and/or labels with the names of the above property owners, as specified on the appropriate application. 18.76.030 NOTICE REQUIREMENTS FOR APPLICATION PROCESSING A. The following minimum standards for timing, location of noticing area and type of notice shall be provided. Noticing provisions are cumulative with the maximum combination of noticing 205 Ordinance #1761. page 76-2 requirements being provided. When more than one newspaper notice is required, only one of the required publication dates must fall within the minimum and maximum days required. B. If for some reason a required property owner fails to receive mail notification of a scheduled public hearing, or if one or more of the required posted signs in the area or on the site for which the public hearing is being held is inadvertently moved through no fault of the City, this in no way shall invalidate the legal notice requirements of the scheduled public hearing. C. Notice may also be provided to property owners in any additional area that may be substantially impacted by the proposed change or use as determined by the Planning Director. The Planning Director may use other means in addition to posting, mailing, or publication to provide notice. Table 76-1 Application Minimum Days12 Maximu m Days12 Distance 1 Notice Type Text Amendment 15 45 NA Newspaper once ZMA2 15 45 200 Newspaper once, post on- site, mail 1st class ZMA2- Resulting from ordinance changes 15 45 None Newspaper once ZMA2- Annexation w/ initial zoning 15 45 None Newspaper once, post on- site, mail 1st class Variance - floodplain, zoning, and subdivision 15 45 200 Newspaper once (zoning 2 times), post on-site, mail 1st class Public Agency Exemption 15 45 None Newspaper 2 times, post on- site Deviation 15 45 200 Newspaper 2 times, post on- site, mail 1st class Appeals3 15 45 2003 Newspaper 2 times, post on- site, mail 1st class Sketch Plan/Reuse/Change in Use/Further Development None None None None Sketch Plan4 15 45 None Post on-site Informal/Concept Plan None None None None Preliminary Site Plan or Master Site Plan 15 45 200 Post on-site, mail 1st class Preliminary PUD5 15 45 200 Newspaper 2 times, post on- site, mail 1st class Preliminary CUP6 15 45 200 Newspaper 2 times, post on- site, mail 1st class Floodplain Permit 15 45 200 Newspaper, mail 1st class COA7 None None None None Final Site Plan None None None None Final PUD Plan None None None None Final CUP plan None None None None Subdivision Exemption None None None None 1st Minor Subdivision without variance- Preliminary Plat 15 45 200 Mail 1st class 1st Minor Subdivision with variance/2nd Minor/Major Subdivision - Preliminary Plat 15 (Planning Board) 45(Commission) 200 Newspaper8, post on-site, mail 1st class9, certified mail10 Final Plat None None None None Notice of Violation11 15 45 None Post on-site, certified mail to landowner 1The distance from the exterior property boundary of the site to all or part of another parcel of land whose owners must be notified of a governmental action. This distance includes the width of a right-of-way or other public ownership. 206 Ordinance #1761. page 76-3 2Zone Map Amendment, Chapter 18.70, BMC. 3Posting and mailing only applies to appeals taken from actions to approve, approve with conditions or deny a development proposal and not to appeals of administrative interpretations. 4Sketch plans for adding dwellings in the neighborhood conservation overlay district, demolition of contributing structures in the neighborhood conservation overlay district, or modification of wetlands. 5Planned Unit Development, Chapter 18.36, BMC. 6Conditional Use Permit, Chapter 18.34, BMC. 7Certificate of Appropriateness, Chapters 18.28 and 18.30, BMC. 8When newspaper notice is required the notice shall be published in a newspaper of general circulation. 9Mail by 1st class to all landowners within 200 feet except those subject to certified mail. 10Certified mail must be sent to recorded purchasers under contract for deed in addition to owners of physically contiguous property and the subdivider. 11 Notices of Violation subject to §18.64.150.E, BMC. 12 Days prior to the close of the public comment period or public hearing unless otherwise specified in this title. 18.76.040 NOTICE OF CITY APPROVAL WITHIN NEIGHBORHOOD CONSERVATION AND ENTRYWAY OVERLAY DISTRICTS In order to inform adjacent property owners and residents that an application within an overlay district has been approved by the City, any site approved for construction or alterations within an overlay district shall be posted with a notice supplied by the Planning Department. The notice shall be posted in a conspicuous place on the site before any construction begins and may be removed when the project is substantially complete. The notice shall specify the name of the owner of record, the address of the property, a description of the scope of work approved and the date of City approval. 207 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-1 CHAPTER 18.78 SUBMITTAL MATERIALS AND REQUIREMENTS 18.78.010 GENERAL All applications and supplemental material, including all copies of plats and site development plans, shall be bound and folded into complete 8½- by 11-inch or 8½- by 14-inch sets ready for distribution. All plats shall be on one or more sheets either 18- by 24-inches or 24- by 36-inches in size, and shall be folded and included in the bound submittal. A digital (PDF) copy of the entire submittal (applications, supplemental material, plat and plans) shall be provided as required. 18.78.020 STREAMBED, STREAMBANK AND/OR WETLANDS PERMITS The developer shall provide the Planning Department with a copy of all required streambed, streambank or wetlands permits, or written notification from the appropriate agency that a permit is not required, prior to the commencement of any work on the site and/or final plat approval, whichever is sooner. These permits include, but are not limited to: A. Montana Stream Protection Act (SPA 124 Permit). Administered by the Habitat Protection Bureau, Fisheries Division, Montana Fish, Wildlife and Parks B. Stormwater Discharge General Permit. Administered by the Water Quality Bureau, Montana Department of Environmental Quality C. Montana Natural Streambed and Land Preservation Act (310 Permit). Administered by the Board of Supervisors, Gallatin Conservation District D. Montana Floodplain and Floodway Management Act (Floodplain Development Permit). Administered by the City of Bozeman, Engineering Department E. Federal Clean Water Act (404 Permit). Administered by the U.S. Army Corps of Engineers and the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency F. Federal Rivers and Harbors Act (Section 10 Permit). Administered by the U.S. Army Corps of Engineers G. Short-term Water Quality Standard for Turbidity (318 Authorization). Administered by Montana Department of Environmental Quality H. Montana Land-Use License or Easement on Navigable Waters. Administered by the Montana Department of Natural Resources and Conservation I. Montana Water Use Act (Water Right Permit and Change Authorization). Administered by the Water Rights Bureau, Montana Department of Natural Resources and Conservation 18.78.030 SUBDIVISION PRE-APPLICATION PLAN The pre-application plan may be a freehand sketch, legibly drawn, showing approximate boundaries, dimensions, areas and distances. The plan may be drawn directly on a print of a topographic survey required for the preliminary plat and shall include: A. Sketch Map. A sketch map showing: 1. The names of adjoining subdivisions and numbers of adjoining certificates of survey, along with adjacent lot and tract lines. 2. Location, name, width and owner of existing or proposed streets, roads and easements within the proposed subdivision; existing streets, roads and easements within adjacent subdivisions and tracts; and the name of street or road that provides access from the nearest public street or road to the proposed subdivision. 208 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-2 3. Location of all existing structures, including buildings, railroads, powerlines towers, and improvements inside and within 100 feet of the proposed subdivision. 4. Zoning classification within the proposed subdivision and adjacent to it. The zoning proposed for the subdivision, if a change is contemplated. B. Topographic Features. Topographic features of the proposed subdivision and adjacent subdivisions and tracts, including: 1. A current U.S. Geological Survey topographic map at the largest scale available with the subdivision clearly outlined. 2. Embankments, water courses, drainage channels, areas of seasonal water ponding, areas within the designated floodway, marsh areas, wetlands, rock outcrops, wooded areas, noxious weeds and areas of active faults. Include copies of any permits listed in §18.78.020, BMC that have been obtained for the project. C. Utilities. The existing and proposed utilities located on and adjacent to the proposed subdivision including: 1. Location, size and depth of sanitary and storm sewers, water mains and gas lines. 2. Location of fire hydrants, electric lines, telephone lines, sewage and water treatment, and storage facilities. D. Subdivision Layout. The proposed layout of the subdivision showing the approximate: 1. Subdivision block, tract, and lot boundary lines, with numbers, dimensions, and areas for each block, tract and lot. 2. Street location, right-of-way width, and name. 3. Easement location, width and purpose. 4. Sites to be dedicated or reserved as park, common open space or other public areas, with boundaries, dimensions and areas. 5. Sites for commercial centers, churches, schools, industrial areas, condominiums, manufactured housing community and uses other than single-household residences. E. Development Plan. An overall development plan indicating future development of the remainder of the tract, if the tract is to be developed in phases. F. Name and Location. A title block indicating the proposed name, quarter-section, section, township, range, principal meridian and county of subdivision. G. Notations. Scale, north arrow, name and addresses of owners and developers, and date of preparation. H. Variances. A list of variance requests which will be submitted with the application for preliminary plat application. I. Waivers. List of waivers requested from the requirements of §18.78.060, BMC shall be submitted with the preapplication. The DRC shall be responsible for granting waivers, and the Planning Department staff shall notify the developer in writing of any waivers granted from §18.78.060, BMC after the preapplication meeting or plan review. J. Parks and Recreation Facilities. The following information shall be provided for all land proposed to meet parkland dedication requirements: 1. Park concept plan, including: a. Site plan for the entire property; b. The zoning and ownership for adjacent properties; 209 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-3 c. The location of any critical lands (wetlands, riparian areas, streams, etc.); d. General description of land, including size, terrain, details of location and history, and proposed activities; and e. Description of trails or other recreational features proposed to connect the proposed park area to other park or open space areas. K. Digital (PDF) copy of entire submittal. L. Affordable Housing. Describe how the subdivision proposes to satisfy the requirements of Title 17 Chapter 2, BMC. 18.78.040 SUBDIVISION PRELIMINARY PLAT The preliminary plat shall be legibly drawn at a horizontal scale no smaller than 100 feet to the inch, and may show approximate boundaries, dimensions, distances and areas, unless specifically noted. The plat shall be on one or more sheets of 18- by 24-inch or 24- by 36-inch paper. Where accurate information is required, surveying and engineering data shall be prepared under the supervision of a registered engineer or registered land surveyor, licensed in the State of Montana, as their respective licensing laws allow. The plat submittal shall include the following: A. Pre-application Information. All information required with the pre-application plan, as outlined in §18.78.030, BMC. B. Subdivision Information. Name and location of the subdivision, scale, scale bar, north arrow, date of preparation, lots and blocks (designated by number), the dimensions and area of each lot, and the use of each lot, if other than for single-household. C. Streets, Roads and Grades. All streets, roads, alleys, avenues, highways and easements; the width of the right-of-way, grades and curvature of each; existing and proposed road and street names; and proposed location of intersections for any subdivision requiring access to arterial or collector streets. D. Adjoining Subdivisions. The names of adjoining platted subdivisions and numbers of adjoining certificates of survey. E. Adjoining Owners. Names and addresses of record owners of lots and tracts immediately adjoining the proposed subdivision. F. Perimeter Survey. An approximate survey of the exterior boundaries of the platted tract with bearings, distances, and curve data indicated outside of the boundary lines. When the plat is bounded by an irregular shoreline or a body of water, the bearings and distances of a closing meander traverse shall be given. G. Section Corner. The approximate location of all section corners or legal subdivision corners of sections pertinent to the subdivision boundary. H. Phased Improvements. If the improvements required are to be completed in phases after the final plat is filed, the approximate area of each phase shall be shown on the plat. I. Contours. Ground contours shall be provided for the tract according to the following requirements: Table 78-1 Where the average slope is: Contour intervals shall be: Under 10 percent 2 feet (if all lots are over one acre in size, five feet intervals may be used) Between 10 and 15 percent 5 feet Greater than 15 percent 10 feet 210 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-4 J. Waivers. List of waivers granted from the requirements of §18.78.070, BMC during the preapplication process shall be submitted with the preliminary plat application. K. Request for Exemption from Department of Environmental Quality Review. If the developer is proposing to request an exemption from the Department of Environmental Quality for infrastructure plan and specification review, the preliminary plat application shall include a written request from the developer’s professional engineer, licensed in the State of Montana, that indicates the intent to request the exemption, and details the extent of water, sewer and stormwater infrastructure that will be completed prior to final plat approval. A detailed preliminary stormwater drainage plan must also be submitted with the written request 18.78.050 PRELIMINARY PLAT SUPPLEMENTS REQUIRED FOR ALL SUBDIVISIONS The following supplemental information shall be submitted with the preliminary plat. A. Area Map. A map showing all adjacent sections of land, subdivision, certificates of survey, streets and roads. B. Subdivision Map. Map of entire subdivision on an 8½” x 11", 8½” x 14", or 11" x 17" sheet. C. Variances. A written statement describing any requested subdivision variance(s) and the facts of hardship upon which the request is based (refer to Chapter 18.66, BMC). D. Property Owners. A certified list of adjoining property owners, their mailing addresses and property description, including property owners across public rights-of-way and/or easements. The names and addresses shall also be provided on self-adhesive mailing labels, one set of labels for first minor subdivisions or subdivisions eligible for summary review, and three sets of labels for all other subdivisions. E. Documents and Certificates. Draft copy of the following documents, and certificates to be printed on or to accompany the preliminary plat: 1. Covenants, restrictions and articles of incorporation for the property owners association. 2. Encroachment permits or a letter indicating intention to issue a permit where new streets, easements, rights-of-way or driveways intersect state, county or city highways, streets or roads. 3. A letter of approval or preliminary approval from the City of Bozeman where a zoning change is necessary. 4. A draft of such other appropriate certificates. 5. Provision for maintenance of all streets (including emergency access), parks, and other required improvements if not dedicated to the public, or if private. F. Street Profile Sheets. Profile sheets for street grades greater than 5 percent. G. Application and Fee. Completed preliminary plat application form, with the original signatures of all owners of record or their authorized representatives, and the required review fee. If an authorized representative signs on behalf of an owner of record, a copy of the authorization shall be provided. H. Noxious Weed Management and Revegetation Plan. Noxious weeds shall be controlled in all developments as directed by the County Weed Control District (district) in accordance with the Montana County Noxious Weed Control Act (§7-22-21, MCA). The developer shall have any noxious weeds identified and their location mapped by a person with experience in weed management and knowledgeable in weed identification. A noxious weed management and revegetation plan approved by the district for control of noxious weeds shall be submitted with the preliminary plat application. This plan shall ensure the control of noxious weeds upon 211 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-5 preliminary plat approval and the revegetation of any land disturbed during the construction of subdivision improvements. I. Sanitation Information. When the subdivision does not qualify for the certification established in §18.06.050, BMC, the subdivider shall provide the information regarding sanitation set forth in §76-3-622, MCA. 18.78.060 ADDITIONAL SUBDIVISION PRELIMINARY PLAT SUPPLEMENTS The following list of preliminary plat application supplements shall also be provided for all subdivisions unless waived by the Development Review Committee during the pre-application process. The developer shall include documentation of any waivers granted by the City after the pre-application meeting or plan review. Additional relevant and reasonable information may be required to adequately assess whether the proposed subdivision complies with this title and the Montana Subdivision and Platting Act. The need for additional information shall be determined during the pre-application process. A. Surface Water. 1. Mapping. Locate on a plat overlay or sketch map all surface waters and the delineated floodplain which may affect or be affected by the proposed subdivision including: a. Natural water systems such as natural streams, creeks, stream/ditches, drainages, waterways, gullies, ravines or washes in which water flows either continuously or intermittently and has a definite channel, bed and banks. b. Artificial water systems such as canals, ditches, ditch/streams, aqueducts, reservoirs, irrigation or drainage systems. 2. Description. Describe all surface waters which may affect or be affected by the proposed subdivision including name, approximate size, present use and time of year when water is present. a. Describe proximity of proposed construction (such as buildings, sewer systems, streets) to surface waters. 3. Water Body Alteration. Describe any existing or proposed streambank or shoreline alterations or any proposed construction or modification of lake beds, watercourses or irrigation ditches. Provide information on location, extent, type and purpose of alteration. Provide a revised floodplain analysis report, in compliance with Chapter 18.58, BMC, as appropriate. 4. Wetlands. If the subdivision contains wetlands, as defined in Chapter 18.80 of this title, then a delineation of the wetland(s) shall be shown on the preliminary and final plats. 5. Permits. Include copies of any permits listed in §18.78.020, BMC that have been obtained for the project. B. Floodplains. A floodplain analysis report shall be submitted with the preliminary plat in compliance with Chapter 18.58 of this title. C. Groundwater. 1. Depth. Establish the seasonal minimum and maximum depth to the water table, dates on which these depths were determined, and the location and depth of all known aquifers which may be affected by the proposed subdivision. The high water table shall be determined from tests taken during the period of major concern as specified in writing by the County Environmental Health Department. Specific locations for test holes may also be determined by the County Environmental Health Department. 212 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-6 2. Steps to Avoid Degradation. Describe any steps necessary to avoid the degradation of groundwater and groundwater recharge areas. D. Geology - Soils - Slopes. 1. Geologic Hazards. Identify geologic hazards affecting the proposed subdivision which could result in property damage or personal injury due to rock falls or slides; landslides, mud or snow; surface subsidence (i.e., settling or sinking); or seismic activity. 2. Protective Measures. Explain what measures will be taken to prevent or materially lessen the danger of future property damage or injury due to any of the hazards referred to above. 3. Unusual Features. Provide a statement describing any unusual soil, topographic or geologic conditions on the property which limit the capability for building or excavation using ordinary and reasonable construction techniques. The statement should address conditions such as shallow bedrock, high water table, unstable or expansive soil conditions, and slope. On a map, identify any slopes in excess of 15 percent grade. 4. Soils Map. The subdivision shall be overlaid on the Gallatin County Soil Survey maps obtained from the Natural Resource and Conservation Service (NRCS). The maps are 1:24,000 in scale. These maps may be copied without permission. However, enlargement of these maps could cause misunderstanding of the detail of mapping. Soils were mapped using a minimum delineation of five acres, and these soils reports were intended to alert developers to possible problems and the need for a more detailed on- site investigation. The developer shall provide the following soil reports, which can be obtained from the NRCS: a. The physical properties and engineering indexes for each soil type; b. Soil limitations for building and site development, and water features for each soil type; c. Hydric soils report for each soil type. If hydric soils are present, the developer shall provide a wetlands investigation by a certified consultant, using the Federal Manual for Identifying and Delineating Jurisdictional Wetlands (January, 1987); and d. The developer shall provide any special design methods planned to overcome the above limitations. 5. Cuts and Fills. Describe the location and amount of any cut or fill three or more feet in depth. These cuts and fills should be indicated on a plat overlay or sketch map. Where cuts or fills are necessary, describe any plans to prevent erosion and to promote revegetation such as replacement of topsoil and grading. E. Vegetation. 1. Vegetation Map. On a plat overlay or sketch map: a. Indicate the distribution of the major vegetation types such as marsh, grassland, shrub, coniferous forest, deciduous forest or mixed forest. b. Identify critical plant communities such as stream bank or shoreline vegetation; vegetation on steep, unstable slopes; and vegetation on soils highly susceptible to wind or water erosion. 2. Protective Measures. Describe measures to preserve trees and critical plant communities (e.g., design and location of streets, lots and open spaces). 213 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-7 F. Wildlife. 1. Species. Describe species of fish and wildlife which use the area affected by the proposed subdivision. 2. Critical Areas. Identify on a plat overlay or sketch map of the proposed subdivision any known critical, significant or “key” wildlife areas, such as big game winter range, waterfowl nesting areas, habitat for rare or endangered species or wetlands. 3. Pets/Human Activity. Describe the expected effects of pets and human activity on wildlife. 4. Public Access. Describe the effects on public access to public lands, trails, hunting or fishing areas. 5. Protective Measures. Describe any proposed measures to protect or enhance wildlife habitat or to minimize degradation (e.g., keeping building and streets back from shorelines, setting aside marshland as undeveloped open space). 6. The developer shall discuss the impact of the proposed development on fish and wildlife with the Montana Department of Fish, Wildlife and Parks (FWP). With the preliminary plat, the developer shall provide written documentation from FWP that: a. Verifies that FWP has reviewed the proposed plat; b. Lists any FWP recommendations; and c. Outlines any mitigation planned to overcome any adverse impacts. G. Historical Features. 1. Affected Areas. Describe and locate on a plat overlay or sketch map any known or possible historic, paleontological, archeological, or cultural sites, structures, or objects which may be affected by the proposed subdivision. 2. Protective Measures. Describe any plans to protect such sites or properties. 3. Describe procedures to be followed if any historic, paleontological, archeological, cultural sites, structures or object are found on site during site preparation and construction. 4. The developer shall discuss the impact of the proposed development on any historic features, and the need for inventory, study and/or preservation with the State Historic Preservation Office (SHPO). The developer shall provide written documentation from SHPO that: a. Verifies that SHPO has reviewed the proposed plat; b. Lists any SHPO recommendations; c. Outlines any plans for inventory, study, and/or preservation; and d. Describes any mitigation planned to overcome any adverse impacts. 5. Information on historical sites shall be prepared by a qualified professional, including persons with a professional or educational background in history, architectural history, archeology, art history, historic preservation, anthropology and cultural resource management. H. Agriculture. 1. Number of acres in production and type of production. 2. Agricultural operations in the vicinity, and other uses of land in the general vicinity. 3. The productivity of the land. 214 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-8 4. Whether or not the property is part of a viable farm unit, and whether the property was under production during the last regular season. 5. What measures will be taken, if any, to control family pets. 6. Fencing of Agricultural Land. Describe any existing fence lines around the subdivision boundary which protect agricultural lands under an ownership other than of the developer, and describe any measure which will be taken to ensure that the owners of the subdivision will share with the owner of the agricultural lands in the continued maintenance of the fence. I. Agricultural Water User Facilities. 1. Type, description, ownership and users of facilities. 2. Written documentation demonstrating active use of facilities. If a facility is not being actively used, include a written plan for abandonment. 3. Describe any proposed realignment(s). All realignments must comply with all relevant requirements of state law. J. Water and Sewer. Provide an engineering design report and/or other documentation demonstrating that adequate water distribution systems and capacity, and sewage collection and disposal systems and capacity, exists to serve the proposed subdivision. K. Stormwater Management. A stormwater management plan shall be submitted with the preliminary plat. A system shall be designed to remove solids, silt, oils, grease and other pollutants from the runoff from the private and public streets and all lots, including; 1. The plan shall depict the retention/detention basin locations, and locate and provide easements for adequate drainage ways within the subdivision to transport runoff to the stormwater receiving channel. Stormwater receiving channels shall be clearly identified for all ponds. 2. The plan shall include sufficient site grading and elevation information (particularly for the basin sites, drainage ways and lot finished grades), typical stormwater retention/detention basin and discharge structure details, basin sizing calculations, and a stormwater maintenance plan. 3. Any necessary stormwater easements. L. Streets, Roads and Alleys. 1. Description. Describe any proposed new public or private streets, roads or alley, or substantial improvements of existing public or private streets, roads or alleys. The developer shall demonstrate that the land to be subdivided has access onto a legal street. 2. Access to Arterial. Discuss whether any of the individual lots or tracts have access directly to arterial streets or roads, and if so, the reason access was not provided by means of a street within the subdivision and how the access complies with §18.44.090, BMC 3. Modification of Existing Streets, Roads or Alleys. Explain any proposed closure or modification of existing streets, roads or alleys. 4. Dust. Describe provisions considered for dust control on alleys. 5. Pollution and Erosion. Explain how street, road and alley maintenance will be provided to meet the Department of Environmental Quality guidelines for prevention of water pollution and erosion. 215 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-9 6. Traffic Generation. Discuss how much daily traffic will be generated on existing local and neighborhood streets, roads and alleys, when the subdivision is fully developed, and provide the following information. a. The report format shall be as follows: (1) Trip generation, using the Institute of Transportation Engineers Trip Generation Manual; (2) Trip distribution; (3) Traffic assignment; (4) Capacity analysis; (5) Evaluation; and (6) Recommended access plan, including access points, modifications and any mitigation techniques. b. The report shall include the following information: (1) Land use and trip generation in the form of a table of each type of land use, the number of units or square footage, as appropriate, the trip rates used (daily and peak) and resulting trip generation. (2) Traffic graphics, which show: (a) AM peak hour site traffic; (b) PM peak hour site traffic; (c) AM peak hour total traffic; (d) PM peak hour total traffic; (e) Total daily traffic (with site generated traffic shown separately). (3) AM and PM capacity analysis with an AM and PM peak hour capacity analysis provided for: (a) All major drive accesses that intersect collector or arterial streets or roads; and (b) All arterial-arterial, collector-collector and arterial-collector intersections within one mile of the site, or as required by the City Engineer during the pre-application review, concept plan review, or informal project review. 7. Capacity. Indicate the levels of service (before and after development) of existing and proposed streets and roads, including appropriate intersections, to safely handle any increased traffic. Describe any anticipated increased maintenance that will be necessary due to increased traffic and who will pay the cost of maintenance. 8. Bicycle and Pedestrian Pathways, Lanes and Routes. Describe bicycle and pedestrian pathways, lanes or routes to be developed with the development. 9. Traffic Calming. Detailed drawings of any proposed traffic calming installations, including locations and turning radius templates. M. Utilities. The developer shall submit a copy of the subdivision plat to all relevant utility companies. With the preliminary plat, the developer shall provide written documentation of the following: 1. Affected Utilities. Indicate which affected utilities the subdivision plat has been submitted to for review, and include a copy of responses. 216 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-10 2. Include a Description of. a. The method of furnishing electric, natural gas, cable TV, internet or telephone service, where provided. b. Estimated timing of each utility installation. c. The developer shall provide a written statement from the utility companies that the proposed subdivision can be provided with service. N. Educational Facilities. With the preliminary plat, provide a written statement from the administrator of the appropriate school system indicating whether the increased enrollment can be accommodated by the present personnel and facilities and by the existing school bus system. O. Land Use. 1. Indicate the proposed use(s) and number of lots or spaces in each: a. Residential area, single-household; b. Residential area, multiple-household. Types of multiple-household structures and numbers of each (e.g., duplex, four-plex); c. Planned unit development (number of units); d. Condominium (number of units); e. Manufactured housing community (number of units); f. Recreational vehicle park; g. Commercial or industrial; and h. Other (please describe). P. Parks and Recreation Facilities. The following information shall be provided for all land used to meet parkland dedication requirements: 1. Park plan, including: a. Site plan for the entire property; showing developer installed improvements on the initial park plan and proposed future improvements on the future park plan; b. Drainage areas; c. Utilities in and adjacent to the property; d. The zoning and ownership for adjacent properties; e. The location of any critical lands (wetlands, riparian areas, streams, etc.) and location of watercourse setbacks; f. Park landscaping plan, prepared by a qualified landscape professional in accordance with §18.78.100, showing the location and specific types and species of plants, shrubs, trees as well as grass seed mixes; g. General description of land, including size, terrain, details of location and history, and proposed activities; h. Trail design and construction showing compliance with adopted City standards and trail classifications; i. The requirement for approval of the final park plan by the City Commission with a recommendation from the Bozeman Recreation and Parks Advisory Board prior to any site work; j. The requirement for a preconstruction meeting prior to any site work; 217 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-11 j. Appropriate sections from the “Design Guidelines for City of Bozeman Parks”; k. Cost estimate and installation responsibility for all improvements; l. If playground equipment will be provided, information including the manufacturer, installation data and specifications, installer, type of fall zone surfacing and age group intended for use shall be provided; and m. Soils information and analysis. 2. Park Maintenance. a. Maintenance information, including levels of maintenance, a maintenance schedule, and responsible parties; b. Weed control plan, including responsible parties; and c. Plan for garbage collection, snow removal and leaf removal including responsible parties. 3. Irrigation Information. a. An irrigation system map generally showing the locations and types of lines, including depth, water source, heads, electric valves, quick couplers, drains and control box; and b. If a well will be used for irrigation, a certified well log shall be submitted showing depth of well, gpm, pump type and size, voltage, water rights, etc. 4. Phasing. If improvements will be phased, a phasing plan shall be provided including proposed financing methods and responsibilities. Q. Neighborhood Center Plan. A neighborhood center plan shall be prepared and submitted for all subdivisions containing a neighborhood center. R. Lighting Plan. The following subdivision lighting information shall be submitted for all new subdivisions: 1. For subdivision applications where lighting is required or proposed, lighting plans shall be submitted to the City for review and approval, and shall include: a. Isofootcandle plots for individual fixture installations, and 10 foot by 10 foot illuminance-grid plots for multi-fixture installations, which demonstrate compliance with the intensity and uniformity requirements as set forth in this ordinance. c. Description of the proposed equipment, including fixture manufacturer’s cutsheets, photometrics, glare reduction devices, lamps, on/off control devices, mounting heights, pole foundation details and mounting methods. d. The lighting plan shall be prepared, and certified for compliance with the City’s design requirements and illumination standards, by a qualified lighting professional. Qualified lighting professionals include electrical engineers, architects, lighting designers and manufacturers representatives. e. Lighting calculations shall include only the illuminated areas; areas occupied by buildings or other non-lighted areas shall be excluded from calculations. 2. When requested by the City of Bozeman, the applicant shall also submit a visual-impact plan that demonstrates appropriate steps have been taken to mitigate on-site and off-site glare and to retain the City’s character. 218 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-12 3. Post-approval alterations to lighting plans or intended substitutions for approved lighting shall only be made after City of Bozeman review and approval. S. Miscellaneous. 1. Public Lands. Describe how the subdivision will affect access to any public lands. Where public lands are adjacent to or within 200 feet of the proposed development, describe present and anticipated uses for those lands (e.g., open space, recreation, etc.), and how public access will be preserved/enhanced. 2. Hazards. Describe any health or safety hazards on or near the subdivision, such as mining activity or potential subsidence, high pressure gas lines, dilapidated structures or high voltage power lines. Any such conditions should be accurately described and their origin and location identified. List any provisions that will be made to mitigate these hazards. Also describe any on-site or off-site land uses creating a nuisance. T. Affordable Housing. Describe how the subdivision will satisfy the requirements of Title 17 Chapter 2, BMC. The description shall be of adequate detail to clearly identify those lots designated as subject to Title 17, Chapter 2, BMC compliance requirements and to make the obligations placed on the affected lots readily understandable. 1. On all lots intended to be used to satisfy the requirements of Chapter 17.02, BMC the allowable building envelope shall be depicted. 18.78.070 FINAL PLAT A final subdivision plat may not be approved by the City Commission unless all certificates, with the exception of the Director of Public Service and the County Clerk and Recorder, have been complied with, signed and notarized and all subdivision regulations and conditions of preliminary plat approval have been met. A final subdivision plat may not be filed with the County Clerk and Recorder unless all certificates, with the exception of the County Clerk and Recorder, have been complied with, signed and notarized. This shall include the Certification by the County Treasurer that no real property taxes and special assessments assessed and levied on the land to be subdivided are delinquent. A. A final subdivision plat may not be approved by the City Commission or filed by the County Clerk and Recorder unless it complies with the uniform standards for final subdivision plats (§8.94.3003, ARM). B. A letter from the City Engineer shall be submitted to the Planning Department with the final plat application, where applicable, certifying that the following documents have been received: 1. As-built drawings, i.e., copies of final plans, profiles, grades and specifications for public improvements, including a complete grading and drainage plan. 2. Copy of the state highway access or encroachment permit where a street created by the plat will intersect with a state highway. C. Noxious Weed MOU. Prior to final plat approval, a memorandum of understanding shall be entered into by the Weed Control District and the developer. The memorandum of understanding shall be signed by the district and the developer prior to final plat approval, and a copy of the signed document shall be submitted to the Planning Department with the application for final plat approval. D. Final Park Plan. For all land used to meet parkland dedication requirements, a final park plan shall be submitted to the City of Bozeman for review and approval prior to final plat. The installation of any park improvements to meet minimum development standards or conditions of approval shall comply with Chapter 18.74, BMC. The final park plan shall be reviewed and approved by the City Commission, with a recommendation from the Bozeman Recreation and 219 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-13 Parks Advisory Board. The final park plan shall include all of the information listed in §18.78.060.P of this chapter. E. Irrigation System As-Builts. The developer shall provide irrigation system as-builts, for all irrigation installed in public rights-of-way and/or land used to meet parkland dedication requirements, once the irrigation system is installed. The as-builts shall include the exact locations and type of lines, including accurate depth, water source, heads, electric valves, quick couplers, drains and control box. F. Affordable Housing. The developer shall provide a description of how the subdivision has complied with Title 17 Chapter 2, BMC. The description shall be of adequate detail to clearly identify those lots designated as subject to Title 17, Chapter 2, BMC compliance requirements and to make the obligations placed on the affected lots readily understandable. 18.78.080 SITE PLAN SUBMITTAL REQUIREMENTS Applications for all site plan approvals shall be submitted to the Planning Department on forms provided by the Planning Director. The site plan application shall be accompanied by the appropriate fee and development plans showing sufficient information for the approval authority to determine whether the proposed development will meet the development requirements of the City. A. General Information. 1. Complete, signed application including the following: a. Name of project/development; b. Location of project/development by street address and legal description; c. Name and mailing address of developer and owner; d. Name and mailing address of engineer/architect, landscape architect and/or planner; e. Listing of specific land uses being proposed; and f. A statement signed by the owner of the proposed development of their intent to comply with the requirements of the Bozeman Municipal Code and any conditions considered necessary by the approval body; 2. Location map, including area within one-half mile of the site; 3. List of names and addresses of property owners according to Chapter 18.76, BMC; 4. For all developments, excluding sketch and reuse/further development, a construction route map shall be provided showing how materials and heavy equipment will travel to and from the site. The route shall avoid, where possible, local or minor collector streets or streets where construction traffic would disrupt neighborhood residential character or pose a threat to public health and safety. B. Site Plan Information. The following information is required whenever the requested information pertains to zoning or other regulatory requirements of this title, existing conditions on-site or conditions on-site which would result from the proposed development: 1. Boundary line of property with dimensions; 2. Date of plan preparation and changes; 3. North point indicator; 4. Suggested scale of 1 inch to 20 feet, but not less than 1 inch to 100 feet; 5. Parcel(s) and site coverage information: a. Parcel size(s) in gross acres and square feet; 220 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-14 b. Estimated total floor area and estimated ratio of floor area to lot size (floor area ratio, FAR), with a breakdown by land use; and c. Location, percentage of parcel(s) and total site, and square footage for the following: (1) Existing and proposed buildings and structures; (2) Driveway and parking; (3) Open space and/or landscaped area, recreational use areas, public and semipublic land, parks, school sites, etc.; and (4) Public street right-of-way; 6. Total number, type and density per type of dwelling units, and total net and gross residential density and density per residential parcel; 7. Location, identification and dimension of the following existing and proposed data, on- site and to a distance of 100 feet (200 feet for PUDs) outside site plan boundary, exclusive of public rights-of-way, unless otherwise stated: a. Topographic contours at a minimum interval of 2 feet, or as determined by the Planning Director; b. Adjacent streets and street rights-of-way to a distance of 150 feet, except for sites adjacent to major arterial streets where the distances shall be 200 feet; c. On-site streets and rights-of-way; d. Ingress and egress points; e. Traffic flow on-site; f. Traffic flow off-site; g. Utilities and utility rights-of-way or easements: (1) Electric; (2) Natural gas; (3) Telephone, cable TV, and similar utilities; (4) Water; and (5) Sewer (sanitary, treated effluent and storm); h. Surface water, including: (1) Holding ponds, streams and irrigation ditches; (2) Watercourses, water bodies and wetlands; (3) Floodplains as designated on the Federal Insurance Rate Map or that may otherwise be identified as lying within a 100-year floodplain through additional floodplain delineation, engineering analysis, topographic survey or other objective and factual basis; and (4) A floodplain analysis report in compliance with Chapter 18.58 of this title if not previously provided with subdivision review; i. Grading and drainage plan, including provisions for on-site retention/detention and water quality improvement facilities as required by the Engineering Department, or in compliance with any adopted storm drainage ordinance or best management practices manual adopted by the City; (1) All drainageways, streets, arroyos, dry gullies, diversion ditches, spillways, reservoirs, etc. which may be incorporated into the storm drainage system for the property shall be designated: (a) The name of the drainageway (where appropriate); 221 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-15 (b) The downstream conditions (developed, available drainageways, etc.); and (c) Any downstream restrictions; j. Significant rock outcroppings, slopes of greater than 15 percent or other significant topographic features; k. Sidewalks, walkways, driveways, loading areas and docks, bikeways, including typical details and interrelationships with vehicular circulation system, indicating proposed treatment of points of conflict, a statement requiring lot accesses to be built to the standard contained in this section, the City of Bozeman Design Standards and Specifications Policy, and the City of Bozeman Modifications to Montana Public Works Standard Specifications; l. Provision for handicapped accessibility, including but not limited to, wheelchair ramps, parking spaces, handrails and curb cuts, including construction details and the applicant’s certification of ADA compliance; m. Fences and walls, including typical details; n. Exterior signs; o. Exterior refuse collection areas, including typical details; p. A site plan, complete with all structures, parking spaces, building entrances, traffic areas (both vehicular and pedestrian), vegetation that might interfere with lighting, and adjacent uses, containing a layout of all proposed fixtures by location and type. The materials required in §18.78.060.R, BMC, if not previously provided; q. Curb, asphalt section and drive approach construction details; r. Landscaping (detailed plan showing plantings, equipment, and other appropriate information as required in §18.78.100, BMC); s. Unique natural features, significant wildlife areas and vegetative cover, including existing trees and shrubs having a diameter greater than 2.5 inches, by species; t. Snow storage areas; u. Location of City limit boundaries, and boundaries of Gallatin County’s Bozeman Area Zoning Jurisdiction, within or near the development; v. Existing zoning within 200 feet of the site; w. Historic, cultural and archeological resources, describe and map any designated historic structures or districts, and archeological or cultural sites; and x. Major public facilities, including schools, parks, trails, etc.; 8. Detailed plan of all parking facilities, including circulation aisles, access drives, bicycle racks, compact spaces, handicapped spaces and motorcycle parking, on-street parking, number of employee and non-employee parking spaces, existing and proposed, and total square footage of each; 9. The information required by §18.78.060 L., BMC, subject to the following exceptions: a. Such information was previously provided through a subdivision review process; or b. The provision of such information was waived in writing by the City Engineer during subdivision review of the land to be developed; or 222 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-16 c. The provision of such information is waived in writing by the City Engineer prior to submittal of a preliminary site plan application; or d. The application for site plan approval involves the redevelopment of property located within the City’s established Neighborhood Conservation Overlay District. In such cases, the City may require the property owner to sign a Waiver of Right to Protest Creation of a Special Improvement District, or other form of agreement, assuring participation, on a fair share, pro-rata basis, in future improvements to intersections in the vicinity of the development proposal; or e. The application for site plan approval involves the adaptive reuse of an existing building, regardless of its location within the City, or the redevelopment of a property located within one of the City’s Urban Renewal Districts. In cases where an existing building or complex of buildings is to be torn down and replaced with a larger building or complex of buildings, the City Engineer may require the information described in Section 18.78.060 L. to evaluate the additional traffic impacts resulting from development of the larger building or complex of buildings. 10. Building design information (on-site): a. Building heights and elevations of all exterior walls of the building(s) or structure(s); b. Height above mean sea level of the elevation of the lowest floor and location of lot outfall when the structure is proposed to be located in a floodway or floodplain area; c. Floor plans depicting location and dimensions of all proposed uses and activities; and d. All onsite utilities and mechanical equipment; 11. Description and mapping of soils existing on the site, accompanied by analysis as to the suitability of such soils for the intended construction and proposed landscaping; 12. Temporary facilities plan showing the location of all temporary model homes, sales offices and/or construction facilities, including temporary signs and parking facilities; 13. Unless already provided through a previous subdivision review, a noxious weed control plan complying with §18.78.050, BMC; and 14. Drafts of applicable supplementary documents as set forth in Chapter 18.72 of this title. 15. The information necessary to complete the determination of density change and parkland provision required by §18.50.020.B, BMC, unless such information was previously determined by the City to be inapplicable and written confirmation is provided to the applicant prior to submittal of a preliminary site plan application. If a new park will be created by the development the park plan materials of §18.78.060.P, BMC shall be provided. 16. Affordable Housing. Describe how the site plan will satisfy any requirements of Title 17 Chapter 2, BMC which have either been established for that lot(s) through the subdivision process or if no subdivision has previously occurred are applicable to a site plan. The description shall be of adequate detail to clearly identify those lots and dwellings designated as subject to Title 17, Chapter 2, BMC compliance requirements and to make the obligations placed on the affected lots and dwellings readily understandable. 223 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-17 18.78.090 CERTIFICATES OF APPROPRIATENESS - ADDITIONAL APPLICATION REQUIREMENTS, REVIEW PROCEDURES AND REVIEW CRITERIA A. Submittal Requirements for Certificates of Appropriateness. All development proposals requiring certificates of appropriateness (i.e. located in a neighborhood conservation or entryway corridor overlay districts) shall submit the following information in addition to any sketch plan, site plan or special development submittal requirements for the proposal: 1. Neighborhood Conservation Overlay District. Certain information shall be provided to the appropriate review authority to review prior to granting or denying a certificate of appropriateness. The extent of documentation to be submitted on any project shall be dictated by the scope of the planned alteration and the information reasonably necessary for the appropriate review authority to make its determination. At a minimum, the following items shall be included in the submission: a. Completed application on form provided by the Planning Department; b. One current picture of each elevation of each structure planned to be altered and such additional pictures of the specific elements of the structure or property to be altered that will clearly express the nature and extent of change planned. Except when otherwise recommended, no more than eight pictures should be submitted and all pictures shall be mounted on letter-size sheets and clearly annotated with the property address, elevation direction (N, S, E, W) and relevant information; c. Sketch plan or site plan information, as per §18.34.050 or §18.34.060, BMC; d. Historical information, including available data such as pictures, plans, authenticated verbal records and similar research documentation that may be relevant to the planned alteration; e. Materials and color schemes to be used; f. Plans, sketches, pictures, specifications and other data that will clearly express the applicant’s proposed alterations; g. A schedule of planned actions that will lead to the completed alterations; h. Such other information as may be suggested by the Planning Department; i. It is further suggested that the applicant seek comments from the neighborhood or area; and j. Description of any applicant-requested deviation(s) and a narrative explanation as to how the requested deviation(s) will encourage restoration and rehabilitation activity that will contribute to the overall historic character of the community. 2. Entryway Overlay District. a. Depending on the complexity of development, either sketch plans or site plans will be required as specified in this chapter. b. If the proposal includes an application for a deviation as outlined in §18.66.050, BMC, the application for deviation shall be accompanied by written and graphic material sufficient to illustrate the conditions that the modified standards will produce, so as to enable the City Commission to make the determination that the deviation will produce an environment, landscape quality and character superior to that produced by the existing standards, and will be consistent with the intent and purpose of Chapter 18.30, BMC. 224 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-18 18.78.100 SUBMITTAL REQUIREMENTS FOR LANDSCAPE PLANS A These landscape regulations apply to a lot or site subject to plan review and approval outlined in Chapter 18.34, BMC, a separate landscape plan shall be submitted as part of the site plan application unless the required landscape information can be included in a clear and uncluttered manner on a site plan with a scale where 1 inch equals 20 feet. B. Landscape Plan Format. The landscape plan submittal shall include: 1. Suggested scale of 1 inch equals 20 feet but not less than 1 inch equals 100 feet; and 2. Standard drawing sheet of a size not to exceed 24- by 36-inches. A plan which cannot be drawn entirely on a 24- by 36-inch sheet must be drawn on two or more sheets, with match lines. C. Preparation of Landscape Plan. Landscape plans shall be prepared and certified by: 1. A registered Montana landscape architect; 2. An individual with a degree in landscape design and two years of professional design experience in Montana; or 3. An individual with a degree in a related field (such as horticulture, botany, plant science, etc.) and at least five years of professional landscape design experience, of which two years have been in Montana. D. Contents of Landscape Plan. A landscape plan required pursuant to this title shall contain the following information: 1. Date, scale, north arrow, and the names, addresses, and telephone numbers of both the property owner and the person preparing the plan; 2. Location of existing boundary lines and dimensions of the lot; 3. Approximate centerlines of existing watercourses, required watercourse setbacks, and the location of any 100-year floodplain; the approximate location of significant drainage features; and the location and size of existing and proposed streets and alleys, utility easements, utility lines, driveways and sidewalks on the lot and/or adjacent to the lot. 4. Project name, street address, and lot and block description; 5. Location, height and material of proposed screening and fencing (with berms to be delineated by one foot contours); 6. Locations and dimensions of proposed landscape buffer strips, including watercourse buffer strips; 7. Complete landscape legend providing a description of plant materials shown on the plan, including typical symbols, names (common and botanical name), locations, quantities, container or caliper sizes at installation, heights, spread and spacing. The location and type of all existing trees on the lot over 6 inches in caliper must be specifically indicated; 8. Complete illustration of landscaping and screening to be provided in or near off-street parking and loading areas, including information as to the amount (in square feet) of landscape area to be provided internal to parking areas and the number and location of required off-street parking and loading spaces; 9. An indication of how existing healthy trees (if any) are to be retained and protected from damage during construction; 10. Size, height, location and material of proposed seating, lighting, planters, sculptures, and water features; 11. A description of proposed watering methods; 225 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-19 12. Location of street vision triangles on the lot (if applicable); 13. Tabulation of “points” earned by the plan (see §18.48.060 of this title); 14. Designated snow removal storage areas; 15. Location of pavement, curbs, sidewalks and gutters; 16. Show location of existing and/or proposed drainage facilities which are to be used for drainage control; 17. Existing and proposed grade; 18. Size of plantings at the time of installation and at maturity; 19. Areas to be irrigated; 20. Planting plan for watercourse buffers, per §18.42.100, BMC, if not previously provided through subdivision review; and 21. Front and side elevations of buildings, fences and walls with height dimensions if not otherwise provided by the application. Show open stairways and other projections from exterior building walls. 18.78.110 SKETCH PLAN SUBMITTAL REQUIREMENTS A sketch plan shall be drawn to scale and in sufficient detail to demonstrate compliance with the requirements of this title. Sketch plans shall be oriented with north at the top of the page and shall also show site boundaries, street and alley frontages with names, and location of all structures with distances to the nearest foot between buildings and from buildings to property lines. 18.78.120 PLANNED UNIT DEVELOPMENT SUBMITTAL REQUIREMENTS The following material shall be submitted for review with each planned unit development. A. Submittal Requirements for Pre-applications. The following information and data shall be submitted for pre-application review. The number of copies required shall be determined by the Planning Department: 1. Data regarding site conditions, land characteristics, available community facilities and utilities and other related general information about adjacent land uses and the uses of land within one-half mile of the subject parcel of land; 2. Conceptual (sketch) drawing showing the proposed location of the uses of land, major streets and other significant features on the site and within one-half mile of the site; and 3. A computation table showing the site’s proposed land use allocations by location and as a percent of total site area. B. Submittal Requirements for Preliminary Plans. The following information and data shall be submitted for preliminary plan review. The number of copies required shall be determined by the Planning Department: 1. Document Requirements. The following information shall be presented in an 8½- by 11- inch vertically bound document. The document shall be bound so that it will open and lie flat for reviewing and organized in the following order: a. Application forms; b. A list of names of all general and limited partners and/or officers and directors of the corporation involved as either applicants or owners of the planned unit development; c. A statement of planning objectives, including: 226 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-20 (1) Statement of applicable City land use policies and objectives achieved by the proposed plan and how it furthers the implementation of the Bozeman growth policy; (2) Statement of: (a) Proposed ownership of open space areas; and (b) Applicant’s intentions with regard to future ownership of all or portions of the planned unit development; (3) Estimate of number of employees for business, commercial and industrial uses; (4) Description of rationale behind the assumptions and choices made by the applicant; (5) Where deviations from the requirements of this title are proposed, the applicant shall submit evidence of successful completion of the applicable community design objectives and criteria of §18.36.090, BMC. The applicant shall submit written explanation for each of the applicable objectives or criteria as to how the plan does or does not address the objective or criterion. The Planning Director may require, or the applicant may choose to submit, evidence that is beyond what is required in that section. Any element of the proposal that varies from the criterion shall be described; (6) Detailed description of how conflicts between land uses of different character are being avoided or mitigated; and (7) Statement of design methods to reduce energy consumption, (e.g., home/business utilities, transportation fuel, waste recycling); d. A development schedule indicating the approximate date when construction of the planned unit development, or stages of the same, can be expected to begin and be completed, including the proposed phasing of construction of public improvements and recreational and common space areas; e. One reduced version of all preliminary plan and supplemental plan maps and graphic illustrations at 8½- by 11-inches or 11- by 17-inches size. 2. Site Plan Requirements. A site plan of the proposed development drawn at a scale of not less than 1 inch equals 100 feet, composed of one or more sheets with an outer dimension of 24- by 36-inches, showing the information required for site plans in §18.78.080, BMC plus the following additional information: a. Notations of proposed ownership, public or private, should be included where appropriate; b. The proposed treatment of the perimeter of the planned unit development, including materials and techniques used, such as screening, fences, walls and other landscaping; and c. Attorney’s or owner’s certification of ownership. 3. Supplemental Plan Requirements. a. Viewsheds. (1) Looking onto and across the site from areas around the site, describe and map the views and vistas from adjacent properties that may be blocked or impaired by development of the site; (2) Describe and map areas of high visibility on the site as seen from adjacent off-site locations; 227 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-21 b. Street Cross Sections if Different From City Standards. Street cross-section schematics shall be submitted for each general category of street, including: (1) The proposed width; (2) Treatment of curbs and gutters, or other storm water control system if other than curb and gutter is proposed; (3) Sidewalk systems; and (4) Bikeway systems, where alternatives to the design criteria and standards of the City are proposed; c. Physiographic data, including the following: (1) A description of the hydrologic conditions of the site with analysis of water table fluctuation and a statement of site suitability for intended construction and proposed landscaping. The description of the hydrologic conditions shall include depth to groundwater measurements taken May 15th through September 15th; (a) An alternative to the actual measurement of water table depth may be offered provided that such alternative includes a detailed soil profile, including a detailed description of the soil which follows The National Cooperative Soil Survey Field Book for describing soils and which provides good and sufficient evidence to establish the presence and depth of a seasonal water table, a land form position or location, or other physiographic data which are sufficient to establish the minimum depth to groundwater. Some soils are not easily profiled to establish an off-season high water table, such as those underlain by sand or gravel, those high in organic matter and those with a high lime content. Physical monitoring of these types of soils may be necessary; (3) Locate and identify the ownership of existing wells or well sites within 400 feet of the site; d. Preliminary Subdivision Plat. If the project involves or requires platting, a preliminary subdivision plat, subject to the requirements of this title relative to subdivisions, shall be submitted; e. Traffic Impact Analysis. Not withstanding the waiver provisions of §18.78.080.B.9, BMC, at the discretion of the City Engineer, a traffic impact analysis shall be prepared based upon the proposed development. The analysis shall include provisions of the approved development guidelines, and shall address impacts upon surrounding land uses. The Director of Public Service may require the traffic impact analysis to include the information in §18.78.050.L, BMC. If a traffic impact analysis has been submitted as part of a concurrent subdivision review, that analysis shall meet this requirement; f. Additional Studies and Plans. If the development’s compliance with the community design objectives and criteria is under question, the City Commission may require additional impact studies or other plans as deemed necessary for providing thorough consideration of the proposed planned unit development; g. A proposed draft of a legal instrument containing the creation of a property owner’s association sufficient to meet the requirements of §18.72.020, BMC shall be submitted with the preliminary plan application. 228 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-22 C. Submittal Requirements for Final Plans. 1. A completed and signed application form; 2. A list of names of all general and limited partners and/or officers and directors of the corporation involved as either applicants or owners of the planned unit development; 3. Site Plan Submittal Requirements. a. A final plan site plan shall be submitted on a 24- by 36-inch sheet(s) at the same scale as the approved preliminary plan. If a different scale is requested or required, a copy of the approved preliminary plan shall be submitted that has been enlarged or reduced to equal the scale of the final plan. However, only the scales permitted for the preliminary plans shall be permitted for final plans. b. The final plan site plan shall show the following information: (1) Land use data (same information as required on the preliminary site plan); (2) Lot lines, easements, public rights-of-way as per subdivision plat; (3) Attorney’s or owner’s certification of ownership; (4) Planning Director certification of approval of the site plan and its conformance with the preliminary plan; and (5) Owner’s certification of acceptance of conditions and restrictions as set forth on the site plan; 4. Supplemental Plans. a. Final Landscape Plan. A final landscape plan consistent with the conditions and restrictions of the approved preliminary plan shall be submitted. It shall also be consistent with the Chapter 18.48, BMC, except that any stated conditions and restrictions of the preliminary plan approval shall supersede the provisions of Chapter 18.48, BMC; b. Final Subdivision Plat. An official final subdivision plat of the site must accompany the final planned unit development plan when applicable. City approval of the final subdivision plat shall be required before issuance of building permits; c. Final Utility Plans. Prior to submission of the final plan to the DRC and ADR staff, engineering plans and specifications for sewer, water, street improvements and other public improvements, and an executed improvements agreement in proper form providing for the installation of such improvements, must be submitted to and approved by the City; and d. Open Space Maintenance Plan. A plan for the maintenance of open space, meeting the requirements of §18.72.040, BMC, shall be submitted with an application for final plan approval. Open space shown on the approved final plan shall not be used for the construction of any structures not shown on the final plan. 18.78.130 SUBMITTAL MATERIALS FOR REGULATED ACTIVITIES IN WETLANDS The following information shall be submitted for all regulated activities proposed for regulated wetland areas: A. A description of the proposed activity; B. A description of why avoidance and less damaging alternatives have been rejected, if applicable; 229 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-23 C. A site plan which shows the delineated wetland boundary, the property boundary, all existing and proposed structures and roads, watercourses and drainageways on the property; D. The exact locations and specifications for all proposed regulated activities, and the direct and indirect impact of such activities; E. The source, type and method of transport and disposal of any fill material to be used, and certification that the placement of fill material will not violate any applicable state or federal statutes and regulations; F. The names and addresses of all property owners within 200 feet of the subject property. The names and addresses shall also be provided on self-adhesive mailing labels; G. Copies of any Section 404 wetland permits already obtained for the site; and H. A completed wetland review application supplement. (1) All parties applying for activity(s) permits proposing action(s) affecting Federal, State or City regulated wetlands, watercourses and/or buffers within the City limits shall submit the following information to the Water Review Board: A. A Wetland and Watercourse Delineation Report must be submitted to the city for all projects, if aquatic resources are present. If no aquatic resources are present, a letter shall be submitted to the City stating that there are no water resources within the subject property. 1. This Wetland and Watercourse Delineation Report shall include, but not be limited to, the following: a. Wetland and watercourse descriptions; b. Functional assessment, as determined by a State-accepted functional assessment method, i.e. Montana Department of Transportation (Berglund and McEldowney 2008) or Montana Department of Environmental Quality (Apfelbeck and Farris 2005); c. Wetland types, as determined by a State-accepted functional assessment method (i.e. Cowardin et al 1979); d. Wetland acreages (by a licensed surveyor); e. Maps with property boundaries, wetland and watercourse boundaries and acreages; and f. Wetland data forms (U.S. Army Corps of Engineers Data Forms). B. If activities are planned in and/or adjacent to aquatic resources the following information is required: 1. A site plan which shows the property boundary; delineated wetland and watercourse boundaries; buffer boundaries; and all existing and proposed structures, roads, trails, and easements. The site plan will include a table of existing wetland functional ratings and acreage, required buffers and acreage, and linear feet of all watercourses and ditches. a. All direct impacts to wetlands, watercourses, and buffers shall be highlighted and summarized in a table on the site plan. The water resource and buffer summary table shall include wetland/watercourse identification number; corresponding buffer width and acreage; total site, wetland, watercourse, ditch, and buffer acreages; jurisdictional status; impacts to all water resources and buffers; and, mitigation types and acreages. b. All indirect impacts (e.g. shading from boardwalks or public utility well drawdown) shall be summarized in the document. 230 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-24 2. Include a map with all proposed mitigation areas and their required buffers. The map will include a table of mitigation wetland type and acreage and required buffers and acreage. Describe the functional unit gain of the wetland mitigation (as determined by a State-accepted functional assessment method). 3. The source, type and method of transport and disposal of any fill material to be used, and certification that the placement of fill material will not violate any applicable state or federal statutes and regulations as listed in 18.78.020. 4. The names and addresses of all property owners within 200 feet of the subject property. The names and addresses shall also be provided on self-adhesive mailing labels. 5. Copies of the following: (a) any Clean Water Act (CWA) Section 404 and 401 permits; (b) any MT 301 permits; (c) any floodplain determinations for the proposed site(s) known to the applicant; (d) any other applications, state or federal, for wetlands permits regarding the proposed site(s); (e) any US Army Corps of Engineers jurisdictional determinations regarding wetlands on the proposed and adjacent site(s); (f) and, if relevant, any MT state joint applications for the proposed project site(s) 6. A completed Wetland Review Checklist. C. If in the preparation or review of the required submittal materials it is determined that there are unavoidable impacts to wetlands and/or watercourses that will require a Federal Clean Water Act permit, then the following information will be submitted to the city for all Federal jurisdictional and City-regulated wetlands (see 18.80.3170) in a Compensatory Mitigation Report: 1. The descriptive portion of the Compensatory Mitigation Report shall include, at a minimum: a. The name and contact information of the applicant; the name, qualifications, and contact information for the primary author(s) of the Compensatory Mitigation Report; a description of the proposal; summary of the direct and indirect impacts and proposed mitigation concept; identification of all the local, State, and federal wetland/stream-related permit(s) required for the project; and, a vicinity map for the project. b. Description of the existing wetland, watercourse and buffer areas that will be impacted including area based on professional surveys; dominant vegetation; and functional assessments and wetland ratings for the entire wetland and the portions proposed to be impacted. c. An assessment of the potential changes in wetland hydroperiod for the proposed project and how the design has been modified to avoid, minimize or reduce impacts to the wetland hydroperiod. d. A description of the proposed conceptual mitigation actions for wetland, watercourse and buffer areas. Provide specifications (including buffers) for all proposed mitigation for wetland/watercourse/buffer impacts. Include a map with all proposed mitigation areas and their required buffers; e. An assessment of existing conditions in the zone of the proposed mitigation including vegetation community structure and composition, existing hydroperiod, existing soil conditions, and existing wetland functions. f. Provide field data that was collected to document the existing conditions of the proposed mitigation sites and on which the future hydrologic and soil conditions of the mitigation wetlands are based (e.g. hydrologic conditions: piezometer data, staff/crest gage data, hydrologic modeling, visual observations; soil conditions: 231 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-25 data from hand-dug or mechanical soil pits or boring results). Do not rely on soil survey data for establishing existing conditions. g. A planting schedule by proposed community type and hydrologic regime, size and type of plant material to be installed, spacing of plants, “typical” clustering patterns, total number of each species by community type, timing of installation, nutrient requirements, watering schedule, weed control, and where appropriate measures to protect plants from destruction. Native species shall comprise 80% of the plants installed or seeded within the mitigation site. h. The mitigation monitoring plan should include a period of not less than 3 years, and establish the responsibility for long-term removal of invasive vegetation. j. Wetland mitigation performance criteria (measurable standards reflective of expected development goals established for each year after the mitigation site is established, i.e. “At the end of 3 years there will be an 80% survival of the planted shrubs and trees.”) for mitigation wetlands and buffers, a monitoring schedule, reporting requirements to the City, and maintenance schedule and actions for each year of monitoring. j. Contingency plans which clearly define course of action or corrective measures needed if Performance Criteria are not met. 2. The scaled plan sheets for the compensatory mitigation must contain, at a minimum: a. Existing wetland and buffer surveyed edges; proposed areas of wetland and buffer impacts; and, location of proposed wetland and buffer compensation action. b. Surveyed topography at 1- to 2-foot contour intervals in the zone of the proposed compensation actions if any grading activity is proposed in the compensation area(s). Provide existing and proposed mitigation design cross- section(s) for the wetland and/or buffer compensation areas. c. Required wetland buffers for existing wetlands and proposed mitigation areas; 3. A discussion of ongoing management practices that will protect and maintain the non- impacted and mitigation wetland, watercourse and buffer areas in perpetuity. 18.78.140 SUBMITTAL MATERIALS FOR APPEALS OF ADMINISTRATIVE PROJECT DECISIONS All appeals of Administrative Project Decisions shall include: A. Name and address of the appellant; B. The legal description and street address of the property involved in the appeal; C. A description of the project that is the subject of the appeal; D. Evidence that the appellant is an aggrieved person as defined in Chapter 18.80, BMC; E. List of names and addresses of property owners within 150 feet of the site, using the last declared county real estate tax records; F. Stamped, unsealed envelopes addressed with names of above property owners; G. Required appeal filing fee; and H. The specific grounds and allegations for the appeal, and evidence necessary to support and justify a decision other than as determined by the Planning Director. 232 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-26 18.78.150 ADMINISTRATIVE INTERPRETATION APPEALS All appeals of administrative interpretations shall include: A. Name and address of the applicant; B. The legal description and street address of the property, if any, involved in the appeal; C. A description of the property, if any, that is the subject of the interpretation appeal including: 1. A site plan drawn to scale showing the property dimensions, grading, landscaping and location of utilities, as applicable; 2. Location of all existing and proposed buildings; and 3. Drive accesses, driveways, access roads, parking spaces, off-street loading areas and sidewalks as applicable; D. The names and addresses of the owners of the property and any other persons having a legal interest therein; E. List of names and addresses of property owners within 150 feet of the site, using the last declared county real estate tax records; F. Stamped, unsealed envelopes addressed with names of the above property owners; G. Required filing fee; and H. Evidence to prove that the decision or action of the official for which an appeal is made was incorrect or in violation of the terms of this title. 18.78.160 SUBMITTAL MATERIALS FOR VARIANCES An application for a variance shall be accompanied by a development plan showing such information as the Planning Director may reasonably require for purposes of this title. The plans shall contain sufficient information for the Commission to make a proper decision on the matter. The request shall state the exceptional physical conditions and the peculiar and practical difficulties claimed as a basis for a variance. In all cases, the application shall include, and shall not be deemed filed until, all of the following is submitted: A. Name and address of the applicant; B. The legal description of the property involved in the request for variance, including the street address, if any, of the property; C. The names and addresses of the owners of the property and any other persons having a legal interest therein; D. List of names and addresses of property owners within 150 hundred feet of the site, using the last declared county real estate tax records; E. Stamped, unsealed envelopes addressed with names of above property owners; F. A site plan drawn to scale showing the property dimensions, grading, landscaping and location of utilities, as applicable; G. Location of all existing and proposed buildings; H. Drive accesses, driveways, access roads, parking spaces, off-street loading areas and sidewalks as applicable; I. A clear description of the variance requested and the reasons for the request; J. Justification, in writing of subsections 1, 2, 3 and, when applicable, 4 of §18.66.060.C, BMC; 233 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-27 K. Evidence satisfactory to the City Commission of the ability and intention of the applicant to proceed with actual construction work in accordance with said plans within six months after issuance of permit; and L. Required filing fee. 18.78.170 SUBMITTAL MATERIALS FOR TELECOMMUNICATIONS The following information shall be submitted for review of wireless facilities as applicable. Failure to provide required materials will result in a determination that the application is incomplete and the application will not be processed. A. Submittal Materials. Table 78-2 Telecommunication Submittal Materials Micro- scale Small- scale Large- scale 1. A detailed written description of how the applicant has complied with, or will comply with, the applicable standards of this title, especially those of this chapter; X X X 2. An accurate photo simulation of the site with the proposed facility in place. The simulation shall be to scale, and depict all planned and expected antennae, including collocation of other carriers, on the facility. Landscaping which is not existing or proposed on the accompanying site plan shall not be included in the simulation unless it exists on adjoining properties; X X X 3. A statement of whether the proposed facility is exempt or non-exempt from environmental review under the Rules of the FCC; a. If the facility is claimed to be exempt, a detailed and specific citation to the Rules of the FCC indicating the section which details the relevant exemption provisions shall be included. If the facility is not exempt from environmental review, a copy of the environmental review shall be provided with the application, and the approval from the FCC for the site shall be provided to the City of Bozeman prior to the final site plan approval; AND b. If the facility is claimed to be exempt from environmental review, a statement shall be provided, under oath and notarized, that the proposed or existing facility does or will comply with FCC radio frequency emission guidelines for both general population/ uncontrolled exposures and occupational/controlled exposures as defined in the FCC rules. The provision of false information shall result in the immediate revocation of permits or approvals granted upon the basis of the false information and the cessation of operation of the offending facilities; X X X 4. When the applicant is a wireless service provider, proof that the applicant is licensed by the FCC to provide the wireless communication services that the proposed facility is designed to support, or that licensing by the FCC is not required; X X X 5. A report providing a description of the large scale wireless facility with technical reasons and justification for its design and placement; X 6. A description of the maximum capacity of the large scale wireless facility as proposed and how the facility can be retrofitted or modified to accommodate changing user needs; X 7. Documentation establishing the structural integrity for the large scale wireless facility's proposed use including documented loading calculations for wind, snow and seismic forces under circumstances of maximum capacity loading prepared by a professional structural engineer licensed to practice in the State of Montana. Loading criteria shall be those set forth in the edition of the International Building Code most recently adopted by the City; and X 8. A statement of how the collocation requirements of Section 18.54.040.B, BMC, shall be met. X B. In addition to the materials required above, for all large scale wireless facilities 50 feet or greater in height, the applicant shall submit: 1. Propagation studies for the users of the proposed facility, including existing service coverage maps and whether the placement of the new site will require relocations of 234 Ordinance # 1761 page 78-28 existing facilities, or a description of how and why the proposed site and facility size is required to provide service that is otherwise unavailable or substantially inadequate or is required for the introduction of a new service; 2. A statement of intent of how co-location on the facility will be addressed; 3. A statement of willingness to allow co-location at reasonable and customary rates by all technically feasible providers up to the structural capacity of the tower; 4. An inventory of all surrounding buildings or other structures greater than 50 feet in height within a radius of one mile of the proposed location with a listing of height and suitability for hosting the proposed users of the large scale wireless facility; 5. An applicant shall demonstrate in writing that there are no available openings on existing facilities which are feasible and that a new structure is necessary. Such demonstration shall address the criteria in §18.54.040.B, BMC; 6. A detailed explanation of how the large scale wireless facility will be maintained and how the maintenance and operations of the large scale wireless facility will be transferred to a third party should the applicant no longer retain ownership. Unless otherwise approved by the City, the responsibility of maintenance and operations shall transfer to the owner of the underlying property; 7. An explanation of how the applicant will provide a financial security for the removal of the large scale wireless facility in the event that it no longer serves telecommunications carriers. The financial guarantee shall be 150 percent of the estimated cost of facility removal and must be acceptable to the City; and 8. A large scale wireless facility may be reviewed as a multiple phase project and be constructed over time as provided for in §18.54.040.B, BMC. An applicant intending to construct a new large scale wireless facility shall provide letters of intent adequate to meet the requirements for leases set forth in §18.54.040.B, BMC. 235 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-1 CHAPTER 18.80 DEFINITIONS 18.80.010 DEFINITION OF TERMS AND INTERPRETATION OF LANGUAGE A. All words in this title shall be first defined as provided in this chapter and, if not defined herein, shall be defined as in the latest edition of ‘The Illustrated Book of Development Definitions’ by Harvey S. Moskowitz and Carl G. Lindbloom, and if not defined in ‘The Illustrated Book of Development Definitions’, shall have their customary dictionary definitions. B. Words used in the present tense include the future tense; words used in the singular include the plural, and words used in the plural include the singular; the word “shall” is always mandatory, the word “person” includes a firm, association, organization, partnership, trust, corporation or company, as well as an individual; the word “lot” includes the words “plot” or “parcel”; the word “building” includes the word “structure”; the words “used” or “occupied,” as applied to any land or building, shall be construed to include the word “intended, arranged, or designed to be used or occupied”; the words “map” or “zoning map” mean the zoning map(s) of the City that delineate the area to be governed by these regulations. C. For the purposes of this title certain words and terms used herein are defined as follows: 18.80.020 ACCESS OR ACCESS WAY The place, means or way by which pedestrians and vehicles shall have adequate and usable ingress and egress to property or use as required by this title. 18.80.030 ACCESSORY BUILDING OR USE A subordinate building, or portion of the principal building, located on the same lot as the principal building, or a subordinate use of land, either of which is customarily incidental to the principal building or to the principal use of land. Where part of an accessory building is connected to part of the principal building by a common wall, such accessory building shall be counted as part of the principal building. Individual public utility installations above ground are considered accessory buildings. 18.80.035 ADAPTIVE REUSE The development of a new use for an older building or for a building originally designed for a special or specific purpose. 18.80.040 ADMINISTRATIVE DESIGN REVIEW (ADR) STAFF Certain members of the planning staff charged with the design review, as defined in this chapter, of certain plans and proposals as specified in this title. The organization, composition and procedures of the administrative design review staff are subject to the requirements of Chapter 18.62, BMC. 18.80.050 ADULT BUSINESS An establishment which advertises, trades, exchanges, transfers, sells, presents, shows, offers or exhibits materials, activities, reproductions, likenesses, services and/or objects defined as obscene by §45-8- 201(2), MCA. Adult business as defined in this section shall include, but need not be limited to, adult bookstores, adult motion picture theaters, rap studios, massage parlors, exotic dance studios, nude art studios, nude photographic studios and nude body painting studios. 18.80.060 AFFORDABLE HOUSING Housing for persons earning less than 65 percent of the area’s annual median income for rental housing and 100 percent of the area’s annual median income for purchased housing. Further, affordable housing 236 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-2 does not require greater than 30 percent of the household gross annual median income for housing. Annual median income is defined by the Department of Housing and Urban Development. Affordable housing is subject to the City’s affordable housing policy. 18.80.070 AGGRIEVED PERSON A person, as defined in this chapter, who has a specific, personal and legal interest in the final decision of an agency, board or commission, as distinguished from a general interest such as is the concern of all members of the community, and which interest would be specifically and personally prejudiced by the decision or benefited by its reversal. 18.80.080 AGRICULTURAL ACTIVITY The cultivation or tilling of soil for the purpose of producing vegetative materials for sale or for use in a commercial operation and/or the raising or tending of animals for commercial sale or use. Agriculture does not include gardening for personal use, keeping of house pets or landscaping for aesthetic purposes. 18.80.090 AGRICULTURAL WATER USER FACILITY Those facilities, which include but are not limited to ditches, pipes, and other water conveying facilities, which provide water for irrigation and stock watering on agricultural lands, with said lands being defined in §15.7.202, MCA. 18.80.100 ALLEY A permanent public thoroughfare providing a secondary means of access to abutting lands. 18.80.110 ALIQUOT PART An equal division of a government section in quarters as described by the ‘Manual for the Survey of the Public Lands of the United States.’ 18.80.120 ALTERATION Any act or process, except repair and light construction as defined herein, that changes one or more of the architectural features of a structure or site, including, but not limited to, the erection, construction, reconstruction, relocation of, or addition to a structure. The term alteration may apply to any act or process that changes the interior architectural features of that portion of a public or private property commonly frequented by the general public, provided said public or private property is located within a designated historic district or listed individually on the National Register of Historic Places. However, changes upon interior elements of private residences, regardless of their location or historic status, shall not be considered alterations as defined in this section. Alteration further means any change or addition to a structure within a floodplain that either increases its exterior dimensions or increases its potential flood hazard. 18.80.130 ANIMAL HOSPITAL A place where animals or pets are given medical or surgical treatment and are cared for during the time of such treatment. Outside pens, kennels or runs are not permitted as part of an animal hospital operation. Short term interior boarding is permitted. 18.80.140 ANTENNA One or more rods, panels, discs or similar devices used for the transmission or reception of radio frequency signals, which may include omnidirectional antenna (rod), directional antenna (panel) and parabolic antenna (disc). 237 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-3 18.80.150 APARTMENT A habitable room or suite of two or more habitable rooms meeting the requirements of the City’s adopted International Building Code, located in an apartment building or used for residential purposes in nonresidential buildings located within nonresidential districts, as specified in this title. Efficiency units shall qualify as an apartment under this definition. 18.80.160 APARTMENT BUILDING A building other than a hotel or motel containing five or more dwelling units. 18.80.170 APPELLANT An aggrieved person who has appealed the decision of an agency, board or commission to another body designated herein by the filing of a notice of appeal. 18.80.180 APPLICANT The person(s) who, or organization which, submitted the application to the agency, board or commission for approval, or the person(s) who, or organization which, submitted the application to the agency, board or commission whose decision has been appealed. 18.80.190 ARCHITECTURAL APPEARANCE The architectural character and general composition of a structure, including but not limited to, the kind and texture of the building’s materials and the type, design and character of all windows, doors, light fixtures, signs and appurtenant exterior elements; and, interior architectural detail including, but not limited to, floors, fixtures, hardware, ornamentation and other elements that contribute to the building’s architectural or historical significance. 18.80.200 AREA OF SPECIAL FLOOD HAZARD The land in the floodplain within the community subject to inundation by a one percent or greater chance of flooding in any given year, i.e., the 100-year floodplain. 18.80.210 AREA OF SIGNS The area of a sign that shall be computed by enclosing the entire area within any type of perimeter or border which may enclose the outer limits of any writing, representation, emblem, figure or character together with any other material or color forming an integral part of the display or used to differentiate such sign from a building on which it is placed. The area of a sign having no such perimeter shall be computed by enclosing the entire area within parallelograms, triangles, or circles in a size sufficient to cover the entire area of the sign copy and computing the size of such area. In the case of a two-sided sign, the area shall be computed as including only the maximum single display surface which is visible from any ground position at one time. If the angle between the two sign faces is greater than 45 degrees, the sign area will be the sum of the areas of the two faces. The supports or uprights on which any sign is supported should not be included in determining the sign area unless such supports or uprights are designed in such a manner as to form an integral background of the sign. In the case of any spherical, conical, or cylindrical sign, one-half of the total surface area shall be computed as the area of the sign. 18.80.220 ARTIFICIAL LOT An area within a legally existing lot that is delineated by the Planning Director for the sole purpose of satisfying the landscaping requirements of this title. 18.80.230 ARTIFICIAL OBSTRUCTION - DEVELOPMENT Any obstruction which is not natural and includes any dam, diversion, wall, bank stabilization method, embankment, levee, dike, pile, abutment, projection, revetment, excavation, channel rectification, bridge, 238 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-4 conduit, culvert, building, refuse, automobile body, fill or other analogous structure or matter in, along, across or projecting into any 100-year floodplain which may impede, retard or alter the pattern of flow of water, either in itself or by catching or collecting debris carried by the water, or that is placed where the natural flow of water would carry the same downstream to the damage or detriment of either life or property. 18.80.240 ARTS CENTER AND/OR ENTERTAINMENT CENTER A structure or facility for the presentation of the performing arts, including indoor motion picture theaters; theaters for live performances; indoor concert halls; studios for arts education, such as dance or painting. Also includes entertainment activities such as arcades; bowling alleys or pool halls. Arts and entertainment center does not include any business meeting the definition of adult business as defined by this title. 18.18.245 ATTACHED STRUCTURE A building sharing with one or more other buildings a common wall(s) for not less than five feet. 18.80.250 AUTOMOBILE FUEL SALES OR REPAIR The use of a site for the direct sale of fuel to the end user, or for the repair of automobiles, noncommercial trucks, motorcycles, motorhomes, recreational vehicles or boats. This includes the sale and on-site installation of parts, wheel and brake shops, body and fender shops, and similar repair and service activities, but excludes dismantling or salvage. 18.80.260 AUTOMOBILE REDUCTION YARD Any area of land where two or more motor vehicles not in running condition and/or two or more unlicensed motor vehicles, or parts thereof, are stored in the open and are not being restored to operation; or any land, building or structure used for the wrecking, dismantling, storage or abandonment of motor vehicles or parts thereof. 18.80.270 AUTO SALVAGE YARD A junkyard primarily containing inoperable vehicles for purposes of being dismantled and sold as parts. 18.80.280 AUTOMOBILE WASHING ESTABLISHMENT A building which has its primary purpose as washing automobiles. Such facilities shall be considered incidental to automobile service stations if not more than one auto may be washed at one time and if the service station is clearly the principal use. 18.80.290 AWNING A roof-like structure, which is generally composed of a skeletal frame, covered in a fabric or other skin- type material, and typically open on the bottom side, which projects beyond a building or extending along and projecting beyond the wall of the building. For the purposes of this title a sign on an awning shall be considered to be a wall sign. 18.80.300 BANNER Any sign of lightweight fabric or similar material that is permanently mounted to a pole or a building by a permanent frame at one or more edges. A single one of each national, state or municipal flags, or the official flag of any institution or business shall not be considered banners. 18.80.310 BAR (TAVERN, COCKTAIL LOUNGE) An establishment where alcoholic beverages are served on premises and where the total sales of alcohol exceeds the total sales of food. 239 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-5 18.80.320 BASE FLOOD A flood having a one percent chance of being equalled or exceeded in any given year. A base flood is the same as a 100-year flood. 18.80.330 BASE FLOOD ELEVATION The elevation above sea level of the base flood in relation to National Geodetic Vertical Datum of 1929 unless otherwise specified in the flood hazard study. 18.80.340 BASEMENT A portion of a building located partly underground but having not less than half its floor-to-ceiling height below the average grade of the adjoining ground. 18.80.350 BEACON Any light with one or more beams directed into the atmosphere or directed at one or more points not on the same zone lot as the light source; also, any light with one or more beams that rotate or move. 18.80.360 BED AND BREAKFAST HOME A single-household dwelling which remains owner-occupied at all times providing one or more guest rooms for compensation, and where food service is limited to breakfast which may be served to overnight guests only. 18.80.370 BUILDING Any structure having enclosed space and a roof for the housing and/or enclosure of persons, animals or chattels. 18.80.380 BUILDING AREA The maximum horizontal projected area of the principal and accessory building(s), excluding open steps, terraces, and architectural appurtenances projecting not more than 2 feet. Building area, as that portion of a lot upon which construction is permitted, is that area of a lot that lies within the boundaries of the front, side and rear yard setback requirements measured from the actual lot line. 18.80.390 BUILDING ENVELOPE The three-dimensional volume on a lot lying between the front, side and rear yard setback lines and between ground level and the maximum allowable building height, amounting to the area available for potential building construction. 18.80.400 BUILDING FRONTAGE The maximum dimension of the building front measured on a straight line parallel to the street, but excluding facades facing alleys or driveways. 18.80.410 BUILDING HEIGHT The vertical distance measured from grade as defined in this section to the highest point on the roof or parapet wall. Where a building utilizes multiple roof styles or pitches, the highest point of each type of roof or parapet wall shall be in conformance with applicable height regulations as established for the respective roof pitches in each zoning district. Where the vertical difference between grade as defined in this section is greater than 2 feet between opposite elevations of the building, the height of the building may be increased by 1 foot for every 1 foot in grade difference up to a maximum of 6 additional feet. 18.80.420 BUILDING, PRINCIPAL A building in which is conducted the main, or principal, use of the lot on which the building is situated. 240 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-6 18.80.430 BUSINESS Engaging in the purchase, sale, barter or exchange of goods, wares, merchandise or services; the maintenance or operation of offices or recreational or amusement enterprises. 18.80.440 CANOPY Any open, permanent roof-like accessory structure which is not attached or part of a principal building. 18.80.450 CANOPY TREE A species of tree which normally bears crown foliage no lower than 6 feet above ground level upon maturity. 18.80.460 CARPORT A structure, open on at least two sides, consisting of a roof and either walls or columns for the purpose of housing automotive vehicles and other chattels. The structure shall be considered as an accessory building when detached from the principal building and as a part of the principal building when attached to the principal building along one or more sides of the carport or principal building. 18.80.470 CASINO A. An establishment whose primary use or activity is gambling, either in the form of gambling machines (video poker, keno, etc.), card games or other licensed gambling activity. A casino will normally have beverage and restaurant facilities as accessory uses. In all instances, an establishment will be considered a casino for the purpose of these regulations if any of the following characteristics apply: 1. The establishment is referenced as a casino by signage, advertisement or by name; 2. More than one card table is on the premises; and/or 3. Fifteen or more gambling machines are on the premises. B. An applicant for a casino establishment must obtain a Montana state license to sell alcoholic beverages for consumption on the premises. 18.80.480 CEMETERY Land used for the burial of the dead and dedicated for cemetery purposes, including crematories, mausoleums and mortuaries when operated in conjunction with and within the boundary of such cemetery. 18.80.490 CERTIFICATE OF APPROPRIATENESS A permit issued by the pertinent review authority indicating its approval of plans to alter or construct a structure or alter a site within the Neighborhood Conservation Overlay District or Entryway Overlay District. 18.80.500 CERTIFICATE OF SURVEY A drawing of a field survey prepared by a registered land surveyor for the purpose of disclosing facts pertaining to boundary locations. 18.80.510 CHILD A person under twelve years of age. 241 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-7 18.80.520 CHURCH A building, together with its accessory buildings and uses, where persons regularly assemble for religious worship, and which building, together with its accessory buildings and uses, is maintained and controlled by a religious body organized to sustain public worship. 18.80.530 CITY The City of Bozeman. 18.80.540 CITY COMMISSION The governing body of the City of Bozeman. 18.80.550 CIVIC USE Public buildings or uses, including but not limited to, college/university facilities, congregate postal facilities, schools, government offices, libraries, assembly uses, police stations, and fire stations. 18.80.560 CLUB, PRIVATE (NONPROFIT) A nonprofit association of persons who are bona fide members, paying annual dues, which owns, hires or leases a building, or a portion thereof, the use of such premises being restricted to members and their guests. 18.80.570 CO-LOCATION The placement of an antenna by two or more wireless service providers on a common antenna- supporting structure, or the addition or replacement of antennas on an existing structure. The term does not include roof-mounted or surface-mounted wireless facilities or the placement of other antenna on an amateur radio antenna. 18.80.580 COMMERCIAL MESSAGE Any sign, wording, logo or other representation that directly or indirectly names, advertises or calls attention to a business, product, service or other commercial activity. 18.80.590 COMMERCIAL NODE A commercial node is an area meeting all of the following conditions: 1. Designated as Community Commercial in the land use section of the City’s adopted growth policy; 2. Designated as a B-2 zoning district; and 3. Located in one of the four following locations: a. Northwest of the intersection of Stucky Road and South 19th Avenue to the limits as shown on the future land use map contained in the adopted growth policy, b. East of Highland Boulevard across from the Bozeman Deaconess Hospital to the limits as shown on the future land use map contained in the adopted growth policy, c. South of West Main Street across from the Gallatin Valley Mall to the limits as shown on the future land use map contained in the adopted growth policy, d. Northwest of the intersection of Baxter Lane and Davis Lane to the limits as shown on the future land use map contained in the adopted growth policy. 18.80.600 COMMON OPEN SPACE Undeveloped land within a subdivision that has been designated, dedicated, reserved or restricted in perpetuity from further development and is set aside for the use and enjoyment by residents of the 242 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-8 development. Common open space shall not be part of individual residential lots. It shall be substantially free of structures, but may contain historic structures and archaeological sites, and/or recreational facilities for residents, including but not limited to benches, picnic tables and interpretive signage as indicated on an approved development plan. Stormwater control facilities for the benefit of the subdivision may also be located within common open space. 18.80.610 COMMON OWNERSHIP Ownership by the same person, corporation, firm, entity, partnership or unincorporated association; or ownership by different corporations, firms, partnerships, or unincorporated association in which a stockbroker, partner, or associate, or a member of his family owns an interest in each corporation, firm, partnership, entity or unincorporated association. 18.80.620 COMMUNITY CENTER A building or portion of a building used for nonprofit cultural, educational, recreational, religious or social activities which is open to the public or a designated part of the public, usually owned and operated by a public or nonprofit group or agency. Examples of community centers are schools, churches, Boys and Girls Clubs, and similar uses. Community center does not include fraternities, lodges or similar uses. 18.80.630 COMMUNITY RESIDENTIAL FACILITY A single residential structure having common kitchen facilities including: 1. Those occupied by persons having developmental disabilities and living together for the purpose of residential training, observation and/or common support, in which care is provided on a 24 hour per day basis; 2. A community group home for developmentally, mentally or severely disabled persons which does not provide skilled or intermediate nursing care; 3. A youth foster home or other facility for care of minors as defined in §52-2-601 et seq., MCA; 4. A halfway house operated in accordance with regulations of the State Department of Public Health and Human Services for the rehabilitation of alcoholics or drug dependent persons; 5. A licensed adult foster care home; or 6. Any facility defined in §76-2-411, MCA. Where a limitation of eight or fewer residents is imposed for the purpose of defining the necessary review process to establish this use, the operator of a residential facility, members of the operator’s household or persons employed as staff shall not be counted as residents, except that the total number of all persons living at the facility shall not exceed ten. 18.80.640 COMPATIBLE DEVELOPMENT The use of land and the construction and use of structures which is in harmony with adjoining development, existing neighborhoods, and the goals and objectives of the City’s adopted growth policy. Elements of compatible development include, but are not limited to: variety of architectural design; rhythm of architectural elements; scale; intensity; materials; building siting; lot and building size; hours of operation; and integration with existing community systems including water and sewer services, natural elements in the area, motorized and non-motorized transportation, and open spaces and parks. Compatible development does not require uniformity or monotony of architectural or site design, density or use. 243 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-9 18.80.650 COMPATIBLE LAND USE A land use which may by virtue of the characteristics of its discernible outward effects exist in harmony with an adjoining land use of differing character. Effects often measured to determine compatibility include, but are not limited to, noise, odor, light and the presence of physical hazards such as combustible or explosive materials. 18.80.660 CONDITIONAL USE A public or private use as listed in this title which, because of its unique characteristics, cannot be properly classified as a principal use or accessory use in a particular district. After consideration in each case of the impact of such use upon neighboring land, and of the public need for the particular use at the particular location, a permit for such conditional use may or may not be granted, with or without conditions, in addition to any condition specifically stated in this title for any particular conditional use, including time limits, pursuant to the requirements of this title. 18.80.670 CONDITIONAL USE PERMIT Legal authorization to construct, develop or operate a conditional use as defined by this title. 18.80.680 CONSERVATION EASEMENT The grant of a property right or interest from the property owner the public or nonprofit conservation organization stipulating that the described land shall remain in perpetuity in its natural and open state, precluding future or additional development (with the exception of any allowable structures or facilities). 18.80.690 CONTIGUOUS TRACT For the purpose of these regulations, a parcel of land next to, abutting, adjoining or touching another individual parcel of land, including tracts which are separated by public right-of-way. 18.80.700 CONSTRUCTION The act of adding to an existing structure or erecting a new principal or accessory structure. 18.80.710 CONVENIENCE FOOD RESTAURANT An establishment whose principal business is the sale of foods, frozen desserts or nonalcoholic beverages to the consumer in a ready-to-eat state for consumption either within the premises or for carry-out with consumption either on or off the premises and whose design or principal method of operation includes both of the following characteristics: A. Foods, frozen desserts or nonalcoholic beverages are usually served in edible containers or in paper, plastic or other disposable containers; B. The customer is not served food at his/her table by an employee but receives it at a counter, window or similar facility for carrying to another location for consumption either on or off the premises. 18.80.720 CONVENIENCE USE Retail commercial uses which have relatively high traffic generation rates per 1,000 square feet compared to other commercial uses. A use is designated as a convenience use if the method of operation includes one or more of the following characteristics: A. Retail motor fuel is sold; B. The primary business is the sale of food or drink for consumption, either on or off premises, over a counter, or from an outdoor service window or automobile service window. Of the food or drink sold, at least 20 percent is in disposable or carry-out containers; or C. Drive-in and drive-through restaurants. 244 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-10 18.80.730 COOPERATIVE HOUSEHOLD Five or more persons who are granted a conditional use permit as a cooperative household pursuant to the terms of Chapter 18.34 of this title. A cooperative household exhibits four or more of the following characteristics: A. A shared strong bond or common commitment to a single purpose, such as members of a religious order; B. Are not legally dependent on others not living with them; C. Can establish legal “domicile” as defined by state law; D. Share a single household budget; E. Share in the work of maintaining the premises; F. Legally share in the ownership or possession of the premises, e.g. tenants in common on a deed or cosigners of a single lease; or G. The relationship must be of a permanent and distinct character with a demonstrable and recognizable bond characteristic of a cohesive unit. Cooperative housing does not mean any society, club, fraternity, sorority, association, lodge, organization or group of students or other individuals with a common living arrangement or whose basis for the establishment of the housekeeping unit is temporary. 18.80.740 COVENANT An agreement that binds and restricts the land in the hands of present owners and subsequent purchasers with a view towards protecting and enhancing the physical, natural and economic integrity of an area. 18.80.750 DATE OF SUBMISSION The date at which the plat or plan and all required supplementary information is received and certified as complete by the Planning Department. 18.80.760 DAY CARE CENTER A place in which supplemental care is provided to thirteen or more nonresident persons on a regular basis and which is licensed by the State of Montana. 18.80.770 DAY CARE HOME, FAMILY A private residence in which supplemental care is provided to three to six nonresident persons from separate families on a regular basis and which is registered by the State of Montana. 18.80.780 DAY CARE HOME, GROUP A private residence in which supplemental care is provided to seven to twelve nonresident persons on a regular basis and which is registered by the State of Montana. 18.80.790 DEDICATION The deliberate appropriation of land by an owner for any general and public use, reserving no rights which are incompatible with the full exercise and enjoyment of the public use to which the property has been devoted. 18.80.800 DEMOLITION Any act or process that destroys, in part or whole, a structure or archaeological site. 245 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-11 18.80.810 DESIGN REVIEW The aesthetic evaluation of certain development proposals, including those located in the neighborhood conservation overlay district, entryway overlay district, and all planned unit developments and retail developments consisting of single tenant buildings greater than 40,000 square feet relative to architectural, site, landscape, environmental, urban and other design matters as specified in this title. 18.80.820 DESIGN REVIEW BOARD That board created by Chapter 18.62 of this title and appointed by the City Commission, charged with the design review, as defined in this chapter, of certain plans and proposals as specified in this title. 18.80.830 DEVELOPMENT Any man-made change to improve or alter real estate, including but not limited to, subdivision of land, buildings or other structures, mining, dredging, filling, grading, paving, excavation or drilling operations. 18.80.840 DEVELOPMENT ENVELOPES Areas on a lot within which grading, lawns, pavement and buildings will be located. 18.80.850 DEVELOPMENT REVIEW COMMITTEE That committee created by Chapter 18.62, BMC and charged with the expressed intent of reviewing designated plans and proposals. 18.80.860 DEVIATION A modification of physical standards of this title as applied to a specific piece of property located within the neighborhood conservation overlay district or entryway corridor overlay district. A deviation may be granted only by the City Commission. 18.80.870 DIVISION OF LAND The segregation of one or more parcels of land from a larger tract held in single or undivided ownership by transferring, or contracting to transfer, title to or possession of a portion of the tract, or properly filing a certificate of survey or subdivision plat establishing the identity of the segregated parcels pursuant to these subdivision regulations and the Montana Subdivision and Platting Act. The conveyance of a tract of record or an entire parcel of land that was created by a previous division of land is not a division of land. 18.80.880 DIRECTIONAL SIGN An on-premise sign which is intended to convey information regarding the location of specific features of the site or to convey on-premise regulations including traffic and circulation regulations. 18.80.890 DRIVE ACCESS That area between the curb of a street, or edge of the traveled portion of a street when no curb exists, and the right-of-way/property line over which the City will permit vehicular travel from the traveled portion of a street to an individual property or off-street parking space(s). 18.80.900 DRIVE-IN BUSINESS Any business in which people are provided a service or a product, where a sale is made without the customer being required to leave the vehicle. Such businesses include, but are not limited to, drive-in theater, drive-in bank, freestanding automated teller machine, drive-in laundry or dry cleaning pickup station, drive-in restaurant and any business offering take-home food services. 246 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-12 18.80.910 DWELLING A building, or portion thereof, meeting the requirements of the City’s adopted International Building Code and used by one household, as defined by Chapter 18.80, BMC, for residential purposes. Dwelling occupancy duration is typically longer than thirty continuous days. Dwellings may exist in many configurations, including single-household, two-household, multiple-household dwellings and group homes. Dwellings do not include hotels, motels, extended stay lodgings or tourist homes. 18.80.920 EASEMENT A grant by a property owner to the public, a specific person or persons, other than the owner, for a right to use land for a specific purpose or purposes. 18.80.930 EFFICIENCY UNIT A dwelling unit containing only one habitable room as defined and regulated by the most recently adopted International Building Code. 18.80.940 ENGINEER (REGISTERED PROFESSIONAL ENGINEER) A person licensed in conformance with the Montana Professional Engineers Registration Act (§37-67- 101 through §37-67-332, MCA) to practice engineering in the State of Montana. 18.80.950 ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT Engineering Division of the City of Bozeman’s Department of Public Service. 18.80.960 ESSENTIAL SERVICES (TYPE I) Water pumping stations; stormwater drainage facilities (including collection lines, retention/detention ponds and drainage ways); sanitary sewer and storm sewer lift stations; public domestic water storage facilities; water fill stations for fire fighting equipment; local service telephone lines and cables; local service electrical distribution lines and cables; local service cable television lines; local service electronic data transmission lines and cables; water and sanitary sewer distribution and collection lines; and public and amateur radio antennae and towers. 18.80.970 ESSENTIAL SERVICES (TYPE II) Pipelines to transport gas, oil and coal (interstate and intrastate); electric substations; electrical transmission lines (interstate and intrastate); public supply facilities (electric and gas); public treatment facilities (water, sanitary sewer and storm sewer); telephone satellite community dial offices; telephone exchanges and repeater stations, except those facilities which may be considered wireless facilities; other accessory facilities, equipment and structures; and police and fire stations. 18.80.980 ESTABLISH To construct, place, insert or excavate. 18.80.990 EVERGREEN TREE OR SHRUB A tree or shrub of a species which normally retains its leaves/needles throughout the year. 18.80.1000 EXISTING MANUFACTURED HOME PARK OR SUBDIVISION A manufactured home park or subdivision where the construction of facilities for servicing the manufactured home lots is completed before the effective date of the floodplain management regulations. This includes, at a minimum, the installation of utilities, the construction of streets, and either final site grading or the pouring of concrete pads. 247 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-13 18.80.1010 EXTENDED STAY LODGINGS Guest rooms intended or designed to be used, or which are used, rented or hired out to be occupied, or which are occupied for sleeping purposes for guests and contain kitchen facilities for food preparation including but not limited to such facilities as refrigerators, stoves and ovens. Generally an individual guest will not exceed thirty days stay. This definition includes dwelling units used, rented or hired out for vacation homes. 18.80.1020 FINAL DECISION The final action of an agency, board or commission when no further action is available before such agency, board or commission. 18.80.1030 FINAL PLAT The final drawing of a subdivision and dedication required by this title and the Montana Subdivision and Platting Act to be prepared for filing for record with the Clerk and Recorder, and containing all elements and requirements set forth in this title and the Montana Subdivision and Platting. 18.80.1040 FINAL SITE PLAN The final scale drawings of a preliminarily approved development and any other required information, the approval of which by the Planning Director indicates that the required conditions for approval have been met. 18.80.1050 FLOOD OR FLOODING A general and temporary condition of partial or complete inundation of normally dry lands from the overflow of a stream, or the unusual and rapid accumulation or runoff of surface waters from any source. 18.80.1060 FLOOD INSURANCE RATE MAP The map on which FEMA has delineated both the 100-year floodplains and the risk premium zones. 18.80.1070 FLOOD INSURANCE STUDY The report in which FEMA has provided flood profiles, as well as the Flood Boundary/Floodway Map and the water surface profiles. 18.80.1080 FLOODPLAIN Areas generally adjoining a stream that would be covered by floodwater of a 100-year flood except for designated shallow flooding areas that receive less than one foot of water per occurrence. The floodplain consists of a floodway and floodway fringe. Floodplain regulations are found in Chapter 18.58, BMC. 18.80.1090 FLOODPLAIN ACT The Montana Floodplain and Floodway Management Act, §76-5-101 et seq., MCA. 18.80.1100 FLOODWAY The channel of a stream and the adjacent overbank areas that must be reserved in order to discharge a base flood (100-year flood) without cumulatively increasing the water surface elevation more than one- half foot. 18.80.1110 FLOODWAY FRINGE The portion of the floodplain that is outside the limits of the floodway. 248 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-14 18.80.1120 FOOD PROCESSING FACILITY A facility in which food is processed or otherwise prepared for eventual human consumption but not consumed on the premises. 18.80.1130 FOOTCANDLE A unit of light intensity stated in lumens per square foot and measurable with an illuminance meter. 18.80.1140 FREESTANDING SIGN Any sign supported by structures or supports that are placed on, or anchored in, the ground and that are independent from any building or other structure. 18.80.1150 FRONT LINE OF BUILDING The line of the face of a building nearest the front lot line. 18.80.1160 FRONT YARD A yard extending across the full width of the lot between two side lot lines, the depth of which is the least distance between the street right-of-way and the front building line. 18.80.1170 GARAGE, PRIVATE A detached accessory building, or portion of a main building, designed or primarily used for the storage of self-propelled vehicles for the household housed in the building to which such garage is accessory. 18.80.1180 GARAGE, PUBLIC Any building or premises, except those defined herein as a private garage, used for the storage or care of motor vehicles; or where such vehicles are equipped for operation, repaired or kept for rental, hire or sale. 18.80.1190 GLARE The sensation produced by lighting that causes an annoyance, discomfort or loss in visual performance and visibility to the eye. 18.05.1200 GOVERNING BODY The governing authority of a city or town organized pursuant to law. In the City of Bozeman, the City Commission is the governing authority. 18.80.1210 GRADE The lowest point of elevation of the finished surface of the ground between the exterior wall of a building and a point 5 feet distance from the wall, or the lowest point of elevation of the finished surface of the ground between the exterior wall of the building and the property line if it is less than 5 feet distance from the wall. If walls are parallel to and within 5 feet of a public sidewalk, alley or other public way, the grade shall be the elevation of the sidewalk, alley or public way. “Finished surface of the ground” shall not include window wells, stairwells or other similar features, but shall include features such as usable patio areas. 18.80.1220 GREEN An open space available for unstructured recreation, with landscaping consisting of maintained grassy areas, trees and other vegetation. 249 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-15 18.80.1230 GREENHOUSE A building or structure constructed chiefly of glass, glass-like translucent material, cloth, lath or similar materials which is devoted to the protection or cultivation of flowers or other plants. 18.80.1240 GROUND FLOOR AREA The square foot area of a building within its largest outside dimension computed on a horizontal plane at the ground floor level, exclusive of open porches, breezeways, terraces, garages, exterior stairways and secondary stairways. 18.80.1250 GROSS ACREAGE The total area of a parcel including the area of perimeter street rights-of-way to the centerline of the street. 18.80.1260 GROSS DENSITY The number of residential dwelling units per unit of land used for residential purposes, with unit of land being the gross residential acreage.. 18.80.1270 GROUNDCOVER Natural mulch or plants of species which normally reach a height of less than 2 feet upon maturity, installed in such a manner so as to form a continuous cover over the ground. 18.80.1280 GROWTH POLICY An official public document adopted and used by a local government as a general guide for development and conservation decisions. It is not a regulation; rather, it is an official statement of public policy to guide growth and change. The required and optional elements of a growth policy are listed in § 76-1- 601, MCA. 18.80.1290 GUEST HOUSE An attached or detached accessory building used to house guests of the occupants of the principal building, and which is never rented or offered for rent. Any guest house providing cooking facilities (e.g. full size dishwasher, more than a bar sink, or a stove) shall be considered a dwelling unit. 18.80.1300 HEALTH AUTHORITIES The State Department of Environmental Quality, local environmental health specialist or other authorized representative. 18.80.1310 HEALTH AND EXERCISE ESTABLISHMENTS An establishment designed and equipped for the conduct of sports, exercise activities and other customary and usual recreational activities, including tennis, racquetball, handball and squash courts, martial arts, gymnastics, weight and aerobic exercise rooms, running facilities, swimming pools, yoga, sport dancing, and whirlpool and sauna facilities. Permitted accessory uses shall include child care, sun tanning booths, massage, health and nutrition counseling services, retail sales of sporting goods and restaurant services. 18.80.1320 HEIGHT OF LOW PROFILE SIGN The vertical distance between the finished grade and the highest component of the sign. 18.80.1330 HEIGHT OF POLE STYLE SIGN The vertical distance between the elevation of the adjacent street curb, or edge of pavement if no curb exists, to the highest attached component of the sign. In the event that the finished grade of the sign 250 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-16 location is higher, or lower, than the adjacent street curb or edge of pavement, the height shall be determined as the vertical distance from the median elevation between the adjacent street curb or edge of pavement and the lowest finished grade at the base of the sign to the highest attached component of the sign. 18.80.1340 HISTORIC SITE The location of a significant event, a prehistoric or historic occupation or activity, or a building or structure, whether standing, ruined or vanished, where the location itself possesses significant historic, cultural or archaeological value. The value of a site shall be based on the ability of the site to meet the eligibility requirements for historical significance as described by the National Register of Historic Places. 18.80.1350 HOME BASED BUSINESS Any business, occupation or activity undertaken for gain within a residential structure that is incidental and secondary to the use of that structure as a dwelling. Home based businesses are subject to the requirements of this title. 18.80.1360 HOME OFFICE An accessory use in which work for compensation is undertaken, including, but not limited to, receiving or initiating correspondence, such as phone calls, mail, faxes or e-mail; preparing or maintaining business records; word and data processing; and telephone, mail order and off-premise sales. 18.80.1370 HOSPITAL An institution for the diagnosis, treatment or other cure of human ailments and which may include a sanitarium or clinic, provided such institution is operated by, or treatment is given, under direct supervision of a physician licensed to practice by the State of Montana. 18.80.1380 HOTEL OR MOTEL A building or a group of buildings in which lodging is provided and offered to transient guests for compensation; shall not include a boarding house, extended stay lodgings, lodging house or rooming house. 18.80.1390 HOUSEHOLD A person living alone, or any of the following groups living together as a single nonprofit housekeeping unit and sharing common living, sleeping, cooking and eating facilities: A. Any number of people related by blood, marriage, adoption, guardianship or other duly- authorized custodial relationship; B. Not more than four unrelated people, including persons enrolled in an institution of higher learning; C. Two unrelated people and any children related to either of them; or D. Not more than four people who are: 1. Residents of a “Community Residential Facility” as defined in § 76-2-411 et seq., MCA and this title; or 2. “Handicapped” as defined in the Fair Housing Act, 42 USC §3602 (h). This definition does not include those persons currently illegally using or addicted to a “controlled substance” as defined in the Controlled Substances Act, 21 USC § 802 (6). E. “Household” does not include: 251 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-17 1. Any society, club, fraternity, sorority, association, lodge, combine, federation, coterie, cooperative housing or like organization; 2. Any group of individuals whose association is temporary or seasonal in nature; or 3. Any group of individuals who are in a group living arrangement as a result of criminal offenses. 18.80.1400 ILLUMINANCE The quantity of light measured in footcandles or lux. The density of the luminous flux incident on a surface; it is the quotient of the luminous flux by the area of the surface when the latter is uniformly illuminated. 18.80.1410 IMMEDIATE FAMILY A spouse, children by blood or adoption, and parents. 18.80.1420 INCIDENTAL Any action or use of less importance, or secondary to, any other action or use. 18.80.1430 INCIDENTAL SIGN A sign, generally informational, that has a purpose secondary to the use of the zone lot on which it is located, such as “no parking,” “entrance,” “loading only,” “telephone,” and other similar directives. No sign with a commercial message, which is designed with the intent to be legible from a position off the zone lot on which the sign is located, shall be considered incidental. 18.80.1440 INDUSTRY, HEAVY Those industries whose processing of products results in the emission of any atmospheric pollutant, light flashes, glare, odor, noise or vibration which may be heard and/or felt off the premises and those industries which constitute a fire or explosion hazard. 18.80.1450 INDUSTRY, LIGHT Those industries whose processing of products results in none of the conditions described for heavy industry. 18.80.1460 INTERCHANGE ZONE Districts created for the purpose of allowing larger and/or additional signage for the areas adjacent to the Interstate 90 interchanges at East Main Street, North 7th Avenue and North 19th Avenue which are located within the Entryway Overlay District, B-2 Zoning District and within 1,300 feet of the Interstate 90 right-of-way. 18.80.1470 IRREGULARLY SHAPED TRACT OF LAND A parcel of land other than an aliquot part of the United States Government survey section or a United States lot, the boundaries or areas of which cannot be determined without a survey or trigonometric calculation. 18.80.1480 LANDMARK A site, structure or object designated as a “landmark” pursuant to the procedures prescribed in Chapter 18.28, BMC, that is worthy of preservation, restoration or rehabilitation because of its historic land planning or architectural significance and officially recognized through listing in the National Register of Historic Places. A landmark shall be subject to all neighborhood conservation overlay district procedures and requirements. 252 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-18 18.80.1490 LANDSCAPE ARCHITECT A person licensed to practice landscape architecture in the State of Montana. 18.80.1500 LANDSCAPING At least 75 percent coverage of an area with natural grass, vegetative groundcover or other natural living plant materials, the remainder of which is covered with nonvegatative decorative landscape design elements such as washed rock, lava rock, bark chips and ornamental features such as pools, fountains, benches, etc. For purposes of this title, the term landscaping shall be considered to have the same meaning as the terms landscape, landscaped and landscaped area. 18.80.1510 LARGE SCALE WIRELESS FACILITY A wireless facility 25 feet or greater in height from the base to the highest point including attachments. Examples of supporting structures are monopoles, self supporting (lattice) towers, guy-wire supported towers and other similar structures When calculating the height of a facility, other structures designed for other uses such as buildings or water towers shall not be included in the calculation. Some illustrated examples of large scale wireless facilities are shown in the appendix. 18.80.1520 LARGE SHRUB A shrub which normally reaches a height of 5 feet or more upon maturity, and usually has five or more canes. 18.80.1530 LARGE TREE A tree of a species which normally reaches a height of 25 feet or more upon maturity, and usually has a single stem. 18.80.1540 LEVEE A man-made embankment, usually earthen, designed and constructed in accordance with sound engineering practices to contain, control or divert the flow of water to provide protection from temporary flooding. 18.80.1550 LEVEE SYSTEM A flood protection system that consists of a levee, or levees, and associated structures, such as drainage and closure devices, which are constructed and operated in accordance with sound engineering practices. 18.80.1560 LIGHT CONSTRUCTION Any change not construed as an alteration or repair, including paving of established driving and parking areas (subject to the requirements of Chapter 18.46, BMC); construction of patios not greater than 120 square feet in size; construction of sidewalks not wider than 5 feet; and landscaping (but not including major changes in grading or site surface drainage). 18.80.1570 LIGHT GOODS REPAIR Establishments primarily engaged in the provision of repair services to individuals and households as well as businesses, but excluding automotive, boat and similar intensive repair use types. Typical uses include, but are not limited to, the repair of appliances, shoes or clothing, watches or jewelry, instruments, office equipment or electronics. 18.80.1580 LIGHT SOURCE A single artificial point source of light that emits measurable radiant energy in or near the visible spectrum. 253 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-19 18.80.1590 LIGHT TRESPASS Light emitted by a lighting installation that extends beyond the boundaries of the property on which the installation is sited. 18.80.1600 LIMITED ACCESS A way or means of allowing physical entrance to land at controlled locations or points. A “no access” strip or line may be placed on a plat as a means of limiting access. 18.80.1610 LIMITED ACCESS ROADWAY A street or road especially designed for through traffic, over which abutting land owners have no right to direct access. 18.80.1620 LOCAL SERVICES All services provided by governmental bodies for the benefit of citizens. These services include, but are not limited to, police, fire, water, recreation, streets, parks, libraries, schools, and wastewater and solid waste collection and disposal. 18.80.1630 LODGING HOUSE A building with not more than ten guest rooms where lodging with or without meals is provided for compensation to persons not meeting the definitions of household, community residential facility, cooperative household, fraternity or sorority. Also referred to as a boarding house. 18.80.1640 LOT A piece, parcel, plot, tract or area of land in common ownership created by subdivision or its legal equivalent for sale, lease or rent. A lot has the characteristics of being able to be occupied or capable of being occupied by one or more principal buildings, and the accessory buildings or uses customarily incidental to them, and including the open spaces required under this title, and having its principal lot frontage on a street. When one or more lots are held in common ownership they shall be treated a as single lot for the purposes of development review and evaluation of compliance with the standards of this title. 18.80.1650 LOT AREA The total horizontal area within the boundary lines of a lot. 18.80.1660 LOT MEASUREMENTS A. Lot Depth. The horizontal distance of a line measured at a right angle to the front lot line and running between the front lot line and rear lot line of a lot. B. Lot Width. The distance as measured in a straight line, between side lot lines at the points of intersection with the required front building line. C. Lot Frontage. The horizontal distance between the side lot lines measured at the point where the side lot lines intersect the street right-of-way. All sides of a lot that abuts a street shall be considered frontage. On curvilinear streets, the arc between the side lot lines shall be considered the lot frontage. D. Lot Area. The total horizontal area within the boundary lines of a lot. 18.80.1670 LOT TYPES A. Corner Lot. A lot at a junction of, and fronting on, two or more intersecting streets. B. Interior Lot. A lot other than a corner or through lot. 254 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-20 C. Double Frontage or Through Lot. A lot having frontage on two parallel, or approximately parallel, streets. D. Reverse Frontage Lot. A double frontage or through lot that is not accessible from one of the parallel or nonintersecting streets on which it fronts. 18.80.1680 LOT LINE, FRONT In the case of an interior lot, a line separating the lot from the street, in the case of a corner lot, a line separating the narrowest street frontage of the lot from the street and in the case of a double frontage or through lot, a line separating the lot from the street from which a drive access may be permitted by the City. 18.80.1690 LOT LINE, REAR A lot line which is opposite and most distant from the front lot line and, in the case of an irregular or triangular shaped lot, a line 10 feet in length within the lot, parallel to and at the maximum distance from the front lot line. 18.80.1700 LOT LINE, SIDE Any lot boundary line not a front lot line or a rear lot line. 18.80.1710 LOT LINE, ZERO A concept utilized to permit a structure or wall of a building to be located on a property line. 18.80.1720 LOT WIDTH The distance as measured in a straight line, between side lot lines at the points of intersection with the required front building line. 18.80.1730 LOT WITH RESIDENTIAL ADJACENCY Any of the following: A. A building site in a residential zoning district, if the site abuts or is directly across a street or alley from an R-1, R-2, R-3, R-4 or R-O zoning district; B. A building site in a nonresidential zoning district, if the site abuts or is directly across a street or alley from an R-S, R-1, R-2, R-3, R-4 or R-O zoning district; C. An artificial lot in a residential district, if the lot is less than 200 feet from an R-1, R-2, R-3, R-4 or R-O zoning district; or D. An artificial lot in a nonresidential zoning district, if the lot is less than 200 feet from an R-S, R- 1, R-2, R-3, R-4 or R-O zoning district. 18.80.1740 LOW-PROFILE SIGN A freestanding sign composed of a solid structure between finished grade and the top of the sign. Also referred to as a monument sign. 18.80.1750 LUMINAIRE A complete lighting unit consisting of a light source and all necessary mechanical, electrical and decorative parts; also called the lighting fixture. 18.80.1760 LUMINANCE The physical and measurable luminous intensity of a surface (e.g., a lamp, luminaire, reflecting material) in a specific area and measurable with an illuminance meter. The quotient of the luminous flux at an element of the surface surrounding the point, and propagated in directions defined by an elementary 255 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-21 cone containing the given direction, by the product of the solid angle of the cone and area of the orthogonal projection of the element of the surface on a plane perpendicular to the given direction. The luminous flux may be leaving, passing through and/or arriving at the surface. 18.80.1770 LUX A unit of light intensity stated in lumens per square meter. There is approximately 10.7 lux per footcandle. 18.80.1780 MANUFACTURED HOME A factory-built, single-household structure that is manufactured under the authority of 42 USC §5401, the National Manufactured Home Construction and Safety Standards Act, is built on a permanent chassis, and is used as a place for human habitation, but which is not constructed or equipped with a permanent hitch or other device allowing transport of the unit other than for the purpose of delivery to a permanent site, and which does not have wheels or axles permanently attached to its body or frame. This definition specifically does not include recreational vehicles. Any dwelling meeting the definition of modular home is not a manufactured home. 18.80.1790 MANUFACTURED HOME LOT OR SPACE A lot for rent or lease in a manufactured housing community designated for the accommodation of one manufactured home and its accessory buildings or structures for the exclusive use of the occupants. 18.80.1800 MANUFACTURED HOME STAND That area of a lot for rent or lease which has been prepared for the placement of a manufactured home in a manufactured home community. 18.80.1810 MANUFACTURED HOME COMMUNITY Any piece of real property under single ownership or control for which the primary purpose is the placement of two or more manufactured homes for permanent residential dwellings and for the production of income. A manufactured housing community does not include real property used for the display and sale of manufactured units, nor does it include real property used for seasonal purposes only, as opposed to year-round occupancy. Home sites within the community are leased to individual homeowners, who retain customary leasehold rights. 18.80.1820 MANUFACTURING The creation of products either with machinery or by hand according to an organized plan and with the division of labor. 18.80.1830 MANUFACTURING, LIGHT Fabrication of and/or assembly of goods from previously prepared materials. 18.80.1840 MEAN SEA LEVEL The National Geodetic Vertical Datum (NGVD) of 1929 or other datum to which base flood elevations are references. 18.80.1850 MEDICAL OFFICES, CLINICS AND CENTERS An establishment where patients are admitted for special study and treatment by licensed health care professionals, including acupuncturists and chiropractors. 256 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-22 18.80.1860 MICRO-SCALE WIRELESS FACILITY A wireless facility, less than 10 feet in height from the base to the highest point, including attachments. When calculating the height of a facility, other structures designed for other uses such as buildings or water towers shall not be included in the calculation. 18.80.1870 MINING The extraction of sand, gravel or other material from the land in the amount of four-hundred cubic yards or more and the removal thereof from the site without processing. 18.80.1880 MINI-WAREHOUSE (WAREHOUSE, RESIDENTIAL STORAGE) A building or group of buildings in a controlled access and fenced or screened compound that contains relatively small storage spaces of varying sizes and/or spaces for recreational vehicles or boats, having individual, compartmentalized and controlled access for the dead storage of excess personal property of an individual or household generally stored in residential accessory structures, when such building or group of buildings are not located on the lot of the residence. 18.80.1890 MINOR SUBDIVISION A subdivision that creates five or fewer lots from a tract of record. 18.80.1900 MOBILE HOME A transportable, manufactured structure, suitable for year-round single-household occupancy and having water, electrical and sewage connections similar to those of conventional dwellings. This definition applies only to units constructed prior to the Federal Manufactured Housing Construction and Safety Standards Act of 1974, which became effective June 15, 1976. Compare with the definition of manufactured home. 18.80.1910 MOBILE OFFICE A factory assembled structure or structures exceeding 8 feet in width, originally equipped with the necessary service connections, and originally made so as to be readily movable as a unit or units on its (their) own running gear and designed to be used as an office without a permanent foundation, in compliance with all applicable state regulations, whether or not the running gear has been removed. 18.80.1920 MODEL HOME A home constructed to display a builder’s for sale or lease units but which does not serve as a dwelling unit until sold as a residence. 18.80.1930 MODULAR OR SECTIONAL HOME A dwelling unit meeting the standards of the International Building Code which was mass produced in a factory, designed and constructed for transportation to a site for occupancy when connected to the required utilities and when permanently anchored to a permanent foundation, whether intended for use as an independent, individual unit or in combination with other units to form a larger building, and which does not have integral wheel, axles or hitch. For the purposes of locating a dwelling according to the standards of this title there is no distinction made between a dwelling constructed wholly or partly off-site and a dwelling constructed on-site so long as they meet the standards of the City’s adopted International Building Code. 18.80.1940 MONUMENT (PERMANENT MONUMENT) Any structure of masonry, metal or other permanent material placed in the ground which is exclusively identifiable as a monument to a survey point, expressly placed for surveying reference. 257 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-23 18.80.1950 NATURAL ENVIRONMENT The physical conditions which exist within a given area, including land, water, mineral, flora, fauna, noise, light, and objects of historic or aesthetic significance. 18.80.1960 NEIGHBORHOOD COMMERCIAL CENTER Commercial uses oriented at serving the needs of neighborhoods. These areas are typified by smaller scale shops and services, and a high level of pedestrian, bicycle and transit opportunities. Neighborhood commercial centers are intended to support and help give identity to individual neighborhoods by providing a visible and distinctive focal point. A neighborhood commercial center may also contain uses that draw from more than the immediate vicinity, especially when located adjacent to arterial streets. Activities commonly expected in this classification are daycares, smaller scale groceries, bakeries, coffee shops, retail stores, small restaurants, offices and residences above other uses. 18.80.1970 NEIGHBORHOOD CONSERVATION OVERLAY DISTRICT An area designated as the neighborhood conservation overlay district on the City zoning map pursuant to the procedures set forth herein. 18.80.1980 NET RESIDENTIAL DENSITY The number of residential dwelling units per buildable unit of land, excluding any land used or to be used as street rights-of-way, parks, public buildings or private nonresidential uses. For calculating net residential density, the following formula shall apply: D = du du A - (c+i+s+a+d) Where D = Residential density du = Total number of dwelling units in project A = Total site area (acres) c = Total commercial land area (acres) i = Total industrial land area (acres) s = Reserved but undedicated school or park sites (acres) a = Street, public or private, rights-of-way and transportation easements (acres) d = Dedicated park lands, conservation easements, or common open spaces (acres) 18.80.1990 NEW CONSTRUCTION Development commenced on or after the effective date of the ordinance codified in this title. 18.80.2000 NONBROADCAST TELECOMMUNICATION FACILITY A facility used for the transmission or enhancement of telecommunications which does not include the presence of antennas, as defined in this title. A nonbroadcast telecommunication facility does not include office use, materials storage or other similar uses. 18.80.2010 NONCANOPY TREE A large tree which in its native state has at maturity canopy vegetation less than 6 feet above the ground. 18.80.2020 NONCOMMERCIAL SPEECH Any sign wording, logo or other representation that does not directly or indirectly name, advertise or call attention to a business, product, service or other commercial activity. 258 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-24 18.80.2030 NONCONFORMING SIGN A sign that does not conform to the provisions of Chapter 18.52, BMC. 18.80.2040 NONCONFORMING STRUCTURE Any structure which was legal prior to the effective date of the ordinance codified in this chapter which fails to comply with the building location standards, and/or size requirements of the applicable zone of this title in which it is located. 18.80.2050 NONCONFORMING USE An existing use of land or building which was legal prior to the effective date of the ordinance codified in this title but which fails to comply with the requirements set forth in this title applicable to the zone in which such use is located. 18.80.2060 NOXIOUS MATTER OR MATERIAL Material capable of causing injury to living organisms by chemical reaction or capable of causing detrimental effects on the physical or economic well-being of individuals. 18.80.2070 NURSING HOME An extended or intermediate care facility licensed or approved to provide full time convalescent or chronic care to individuals who, by reason of advanced age, chronic illness or infirmity, are unable to care for themselves. 18.80.2080 NURSERY, PLANT Facilities for commercial development, growth and sale of plants and/or for the utilization of and storage of equipment for landscaping operation and wholesale and/or retail or commercial gardening supplies. 18.80.2090 OFF-PREMISE SIGN A sign which advertises or directs attention to products or activities that are not provided on the parcel upon which the sign is located. 18.80.2100 OFFICES Buildings or portions of buildings in which commercial activities take place but where goods are not produced, sold or repaired. These include but are not limited to general and professional offices; governmental offices; insurance offices; real estate offices; taxicab offices (but not taxi stands); travel agency or transportation ticket offices; telephone exchange; utility offices; radio broadcasting and similar uses. 18.80.2110 OFFICIAL FLOODPLAIN MAPS The Flood Insurance Rate Maps and Flood Boundary/Floodway Maps provided by FEMA for the City dated July 15, 1988 and incorporating any approved updates or revisions. 18.80.2120 ONE-HUNDRED YEAR FLOOD A flood having a one percent chance of being equalled or exceeded in any given year. A 100-year flood has nearly a 23 percent chance of occurring in a 25-year period. A 100-year flood is the same as a base flood. 18.80.2130 OPEN SALES (OR RENTAL) LOT Any land used or occupied for the purpose of buying, selling or renting for use away from the premises, any goods, materials or merchandise, and for the exterior storing of same prior to sale or rental. 259 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-25 18.80.2140 OPEN SPACE A land or water area devoid of buildings and other physical structures except where accessory to the provision of recreation, including but not limited to benches, picnic tables and interpretive signage. 18.80.2150 OPEN SPACE, USABLE That space which is capable of being used by the public for recreation, relaxation and social purposes. Parking lots and perimeter landscaping are specifically excluded from this definition of usable open space, except as allowed by §18.36.090, BMC. 18.80.2160 ORDINARY HIGH WATER MARK The outermost line caused by water impressing on land and covering it for sufficient periods to cause physical characteristics that distinguish the area below the line from the area above it. Characteristics of the area below the line include, when appropriate, but are not limited to, deprivation of the soil of substantially all terrestrial vegetation and destruction of its agricultural vegetative value. A floodplain adjacent to surface waters is not considered to lie within the surface water’s high water marks. 18.80.2170 OVERLAY ZONE A zone superimposed upon an underlying zone which establishes special requirements in addition to, or in lieu of, those of the underlying zone. 18.80.2180 PARAPET That part of the wall which extends above the roof. For the purposes of this title relating to signage, the top of the parapet shall be considered to be the roofline. 18.80.2185 PARK For the purposes of this title only, park means an open space, as defined in this title, under the ownership or other legal control of the City of Bozeman which provides area for active and passive recreational purposes. 18.80.2190 PARKING AREA An area, other than a street or alley designated for use, or used, for temporary parking of vehicles. 18.80.2200 PARKING SPACE, OFF-STREET A space designated for the temporary parking of a motor vehicle not on the right-of-way or alley but accessible from a street or alley. 18.80.2210 PARTY WALL Any wall of a building or structure which is common to two or more buildings, and which has a minimum of one-hour fire-resistant construction as defined and regulated by the latest adopted International Building Code. 18.80.2220 PATHWAY A facility that accommodates the recreational and/or transportation needs of pedestrians and bicyclists, including sidewalks, bike lanes, boulevard trails and trails. 18.80.2230 PAVED PARKING SPACE OR SURFACE An area covered by an impervious dust free surface of asphalt or concrete designed to specifications of the City Engineer. 260 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-26 18.80.2240 PENNANT Any lightweight plastic, fabric or other material, whether or not containing a message of any kind, suspended from a rope, wire or string, usually in series, designed to move in the wind. 18.80.2250 PERMEABLE PAVEMENT A paving material that permits water penetration to a soil depth of 18 inches or more. Permeable pavement may consist of nonporous surface materials poured or laid in sections not exceeding one square foot in an area and collectively comprising less than two-thirds of the total surface area. 18.80.2260 PERMITTED USE A use which is lawfully established in a particular district or districts and which conforms with all requirements, regulations and performance standards of such district. A permitted use may be a principal use, an accessory use or a conditional use. 18.80.2270 PERSONAL AND CONVENIENCE SERVICES Businesses offering services such as barbershops, beauty shops, tailors, shoe repair, tattooing, massage, laundromats, laundry and dry cleaning pickup and delivery stations, and similar uses. Some production of finished goods may occur as an activity accessory to the delivery of services. 18.80.2280 PERSONAL PROPERTY Property, other than real property, consisting of things temporal and movable. 18.80.2290 PERSONS Includes any individual or group of individuals, corporations, partnerships, associations or any other organized group of persons, including state and local governments and agencies thereof. 18.80.2300 PLANNED UNIT DEVELOPMENT (PUD) A land development project consisting of residential clusters, industrial parks, shopping centers, or office building parks or any combination thereof that compose a planned mixture of land uses built in a prearranged relationship to each other and having open space and community facilities in a common ownership or use, and/or public parkland. 18.80.2310 PLANNING BOARD The Bozeman Planning Board. 18.80.2320 PLANNING DEPARTMENT The Bozeman Department of Planning and Community Development. 18.80.2330 PLANNING DIRECTOR The Director of the Bozeman Department of Planning and Community Development and the person charged with the administration of this title unless otherwise specifically noted in this title. 18.80.2340 PLAT A graphical representation of a subdivision showing the division of land into lots, parcels, blocks, streets, alleys, and other divisions and dedications. 18.80.2350 PLAZA An area generally open to the public on a controlled basis and used principally for passive recreational activities and relaxation. Plazas are paved areas typically providing amenities such as seating, drinking and ornamental fountains, art, trees and landscaping for use by pedestrians. 261 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-27 18.80.2360 POLE SIGN A freestanding sign which is supported by a column(s) or other structural member(s) that is permanently attached to the ground or a ground-mounted structure and provides a minimum of 8 feet of visible, vertical clearance between the bottom of the sign and finished grade. 18.80.2370 PORTABLE SIGN Any sign not permanently attached to the ground or other permanent structure, or a sign designed to be transported, including, but not limited to, signs designed to be transported by means of wheels; signs converted to A- or T-frames; balloons used as signs; umbrellas used for advertising; and signs attached to or painted on vehicles parked and visible from the public right-of-way, unless said vehicle is used in the normal day-to-day operations of the business. 18.80.2380 PRESERVATION BOARD The Bozeman Historic Preservation Advisory Board. 18.80.2390 PRIMARY ACCESS The major access to a subdivision. The major access generally carries the most traffic as determined by the traffic engineering study. 18.80.2400 PRINCIPAL USE A use or structure which determines the predominant or major use of the lot on which it is located. The principal use shall be that use which establishes the character of the property relative to surrounding or adjacent properties. 18.80.2410 PRIVATE STREET A right-of-way usable by the public but maintained by a property owners association. 18.80.2420 PROJECTING SIGN Any sign affixed to a building or wall in such a manner that its leading edge extends more than 6 inches beyond the surface of such building or wall and is perpendicular to such building or wall. 18.80.2430 PROPER ACCESS Either an improved public street or road, maintained by the City of Bozeman, Gallatin County or the State of Montana; or a street or road built to the standards provided in these regulations. 18.80.2440 PROPERTY OWNER Any person, firm, corporation or other entity shown as being the legal owner of a tract, parcel or lot in the records of the County Clerk and Recorder. 18.80.2450 PROPERTY OWNERS ASSOCIATION An association incorporated or not incorporated, combining individual property ownership with shared use or ownership of common property or facilities, or shared maintenance of subdivision or community facilities. This definition includes condominium associations. 18.80.2460 PUBLIC BUILDING A building, supported by government funds, to be used in an official capacity on behalf of the entire community. 262 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-28 18.80.2470 PUBLIC HEALTH AND SAFETY A condition of optimal well-being, free from danger or injury, for a community at large, not merely for an individual or small group of persons. 18.80.2480 PUBLIC IMPROVEMENT Any structure or facility constructed to serve the residents of a subdivision or the general public such as parks, streets, sidewalks, curbs, gutters, street lighting, utilities and systems for water supply, sewage disposal and drainage. 18.80.2490 PUBLIC STREET OR ROAD A street or road for which the right-of-way has been dedicated to the public. 18.80.2500 REAL PROPERTY Property consisting of buildings and/or land. 18.80.2510 REAR YARD A yard extending across the full width of the lot between the two side lot lines the depth of which is the distance required by this title between the rear property line and the rear building line. 18.80.2520 RECREATIONAL VEHICLE A vehicular type portable structure without permanent foundation, which is built on a single chassis; which is designed to be self-propelled or permanently towable by a light duty truck; primarily designed as temporary living accommodation for recreational, camping and travel use and including but not limited to travel trailers, truck campers, camping trailers and self-propelled motor homes less than 8 feet in width and 50 feet in length. 18.80.2530 RECREATIONAL VEHICLE PARK A plot of ground upon which two or more sites are located, established or maintained for occupancy by the general public as temporary living quarters for travel, recreation or vacation purposes. 18.80.2540 RECREATIONAL VEHICLE SPACE A lot for rent or lease within a recreational vehicle park designed for the placement of a single recreational vehicle and the exclusive use of its occupants. 18.80.2550 RELOCATION Any movement of a structure, on the same site or to another site. 18.80.2560 REPAIR Any change not otherwise construed as light construction or an alteration, as herein defined, that constitutes replacing broken, worn or damaged materials with like, not necessarily identical, materials and is insignificant to the size and condition of the structure or property. Repainting and reroofing shall be included under this definition of repair. 18.80.2570 REQUIRED FRONT BUILDING LINE The line nearest to the front and across a lot establishing the minimum open space to be provided between the front line of a building and the front lot line. See also definition of “setback line”. 18.80.2580 REQUIRED REAR BUILDING LINE The line nearest to the rear and across a lot establishing the minimum open space to be provided between the rear line of a building and the rear lot line. See also definition of “setback line”. 263 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-29 18.80.2590 REQUIRED SIDE BUILDING LINE The line nearest to the side and extending between the required front building line and required rear building line establishing the minimum open space to be provided between the side line of a building and the side lot line. See also definition of “setback line”. 18.80.2600 REQUIRED YARD The minimum dimension of a front, side or rear yard as established by the use regulations for each district. 18.80.2610 RESTAURANT Any restaurant (except a drive-in restaurant or a convenience food restaurant as defined in this chapter), coffee shop, cafeteria, short-order café, luncheonette, sandwich stand, drugstore and soda fountain serving food. 18.80.2620 RETAIL The rental or sale of tangible personal property for any purpose other than for resale. 18.80.2630 RETAIL, LARGE SCALE The sale of tangible personal property for any purpose other than for resale where the total area utilized by a single tenant, exclusive of parking, occupies 40,000 square feet or more. 18.80.2640 REVOLVING SIGN Any sign which all, or a portion of, may rotate either on an intermittent or constant basis. 18.80.2650 RIDGELINE A relatively narrow elevation that is prominent because it rises at an angle of 25 percent or greater; an elongated crest, or series of crests, with or without individual peaks, significantly higher than the adjoining ground and often acting as the hydrologic dividing line between two or more drainage areas. 18.80.2660 RIDGELINE PROTECTION AREA A ridgeline protection area is the area within 150 feet horizontal feet of a ridgeline, measured perpendicular to the ridgeline when the ridgeline is: A. Located in an area above 4,900 feet in elevation above mean sea level; and B. When the elevation of a line parallel to the ridgeline loses either: 1. At least 10 feet in vertical elevation on both sides of the ridgeline within 100 feet; or 2. At least 30 feet in vertical elevation on both sides of the ridgeline within 300 feet. 3. A combination of the two standards where one side of the ridgeline meets one loss of elevation standard and the opposite side meets the other. 18.80.2670 RIGHT-OF-WAY A linear public way established or dedicated for public purposes by duly recorded plat, deed, easement, grant, prescription, condemnation, governmental authority or by operation of the law and intended to be occupied by a street, crosswalk, railroad, electric transmission lines, water line, sanitary sewer line, stormsewer line or other similar uses. 18.80.2680 ROADWAY That portion of the street or road right-of-way which is improved or is proposed to be improved to carry traffic and provide for the on-street storage of automobiles; where curb is provided, the roadway is measured from back-of-curb to back-of-curb. 264 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-30 18.80.2690 ROOF SIGN Any sign erected and constructed on and over the roof of a building, supported by the roof structure, and extending vertically above any portion of the roof. Roof signs shall not include signs located on a mansard roof if the sign is mounted vertically and integrated with the roof. For the purpose of this chapter, architecturally integrated mansard signs and other architecturally integrated signs located below the principal roof line shall be classified as wall signs. 18.80.2700 SCHOOL Any 1) pre-primary, primary or grammar, public, parochial or private school or high school; 2) preparatory school or academy, public or founded, or owned or conducted by or under the sponsorship of a religious or charitable organization; 3) private preparatory school or academy furnishing courses of instruction substantially equivalent to the courses offered by public high schools for preparation of admission to college or universities which award B.A. or B.S. degrees; 4) junior college or university, public or founded, or conducted by or under the sponsorship of a religious or charitable organization; or 5) private school when not conducted as a commercial enterprise for the profit of individual owners or stockholders. 18.80.2710 SCREENING A method of visually shielding or obscuring an abutting or nearby structure or use from another through the use of solid or nearly solid barriers (e.g., wall, fence, plantings, berms). 18.80.2720 SECURITY LIGHTING All outdoor lighting used for, but not limited to, illumination for walkways, roadways, equipment yards, parking lots and outdoor security where general illumination for safety or security of the grounds is the primary concern. 18.80.2730 SECOND OR SUBSEQUENT FRONT YARD OR CORNER SIDE YARD A yard on a corner lot the area of which is bounded by a line extending from the front of the principal building (the front building line) to a point intersecting the side street right-of-way line (side lot line), then along the side lot line to a point intersecting the rear lot line, then along the rear lot line to a point intersecting the line formed by extending the wall of the nearest principal building paralleling the side lot line. 18.80.2740 SETBACK The distance from the property line to the nearest part of the applicable building, structure or sign, measured perpendicularly to the property line. 18.80.2750 SETBACK LINE That line that is the required minimum distance from the street right-of-way or public access easement line or any other lot line that establishes the area within which structures must be placed, as specified in this title. 18.80.2760 SEWER, PUBLIC Any sanitary sewer line owned and maintained by the City, whether or not installed by the City. 18.80.2770 SHARED ACCESS A fixed automotive and pedestrian access location from a street to two or more adjoining properties which mutually have the right and ability to use the access, and which has been established by an easement or other legally binding means. 265 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-31 18.80.2780 SHOPPING MALL A multi-tenant retail structure where tenants are located on both sides of a covered walkway with direct pedestrian access to all establishments from the walkway. 18.80.2790 SIGN Any device, fixture, placard or structure that uses any color, form, graphic, illumination, symbol or writing to advertise, announce the purpose of, or identify the purpose of a person or entity, or to communicate information of any kind to the public. 18.80.2800 SIDE YARD A yard extending between the front building line and the rear building line, the width of which is the least distance between the side lot line and the nearest part of the principal building. 18.80.2810 SITE PLAN A scale drawing showing the accurate location of all structures, streets, alleys and parking areas, existing and proposed, on subject property or any other information as may be required by this title. 18.80.2820 SMALL SCALE WIRELESS FACILITY A wireless facility less than 25 feet in height from the base to the highest point including attachments. Examples of supporting structures are monopoles, self supporting (lattice) towers, guy-wire supported towers and other similar structures. When calculating the height of a facility, other structures designed for other uses such as buildings or water towers shall not be included in the calculation. This definition excludes those facilities meeting the definition of micro-scale wireless facility. Some illustrated examples of locations for possible small scale wireless facilities are shown in the appendix. 18.80.2830 SMALL TREE A tree of a species which normally reaches a height of less than 25 feet upon maturity. 18.80.2840 SOIL A medium in which plants will grow. 18.80.2850 SPECIAL EVENT SIGN A temporary sign which advertises special civic events and activities such as street fairs, community festivals, parades, farmers markets and charity benefits. 18.80.2860 SQUARE Open space that may encompass an entire block, is located at the intersection of important streets, and is set aside for civic purposes, and consists of paved walks, lawns, trees and civic buildings. 18.80.2870 STABLE, COMMERCIAL Any building or complex of buildings and pastures which is designed, arranged, used or intended to be used for equestrian purposes, where less than 75 percent of the capacity is for the use of the owner or resident of the property. A public stable is an agricultural activity. 18.80.2880 STABLE, PRIVATE Any building located on a lot which is designed, arranged, used or intended to be used for not more than four horses for the private use of the owner of the lot, but shall not exceed 6,000 square feet in area. 266 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-32 18.80.2890 START OF CONSTRUCTION The commencement of clearing, grading, filling or excavating to prepare a site for construction. 18.80.2900 STEALTH, OR CAMOUFLAGED Placement of a wireless facility in such a way that it may not be discerned as being separate from the principal use of a site. This may be accomplished through visual screening, use of color or encasement of the facility within an existing structure such as a steeple. A stealth installation may also include the placement of a new structure to contain the facility so long as the new structure complies with the height, setback and other requirements of the zoning code or is otherwise exempt from those requirements. 18.80.2910 STREET A right-of-way, dedicated or otherwise legally established, for public use by motorized and non- motorized vehicles and pedestrians, usually affording the principal means of access to abutting property. 18.80.2920 STREET FRONTAGE Any property line separating a lot from a street other than an alley; the front lot line. 18.80.2930 STREET, PUBLIC Any street which has been dedicated to or is otherwise publicly owned. Any street not a public street shall be deemed a private street. 18.80.2940 STREET TYPES For the purposes of these regulations, street types are defined as follows: A. Alley. A street used primarily for vehicular access to the rear of properties which abut and are served by public or private streets. B. Arterial. A street or road having the primary function of moving traffic with emphasis on a high level of mobility for through movement and the secondary function of providing limited access to adjacent land. Arterial streets are generally designated in the Bozeman transportation plan, however, streets not depicted in the Bozeman transportation plan may be designated as arterials by the City Engineer. 1. Principal Arterial. Serves the major centers of activity, the highest traffic volume corridors, and the longest trip distances in an urbanized area. This group of streets carries the highest proportion of the total traffic within the urban area with typical loads of 10,000 to 35,000 vehicles per day. Most of the vehicles entering and leaving the urban area, as well as most through traffic bypassing the central business district, utilize principal arterials. Significant intra-area travel, such as between central business districts and outlying residential areas, and between major suburban centers, are served by major arterials. 2. Minor Arterial. Interconnects with and augments the urban principal arterial system. It accommodates trips of moderate length and at a somewhat lower level of travel mobility than principal arterials, and it distributes travel to smaller geographic areas. With an emphasis on traffic mobility, this street network includes all arterials not classified as principal arterials while providing access to adjacent lands. Minor arterials typically carry 5,000 to 15,000 vehicles per day. C. Collector. A street or road that provides equal priority to the movement of traffic, and to the access of residential, business and industrial areas. This type of roadway differs from those of the arterial system in that the facilities on the collector system may traverse residential 267 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-33 neighborhoods. The system distributes trips from the arterials to ultimate destinations. The collector streets also collect traffic from local streets in the residential neighborhoods, channeling it into the arterial system. Collectors typically carry 2,000 to 10,000 vehicles per day. Collector streets are typically designated in the Bozeman transportation plan, however, additional streets may be designated as collectors by the City Engineer. D. Cul-de-sac. A street having only one outlet for vehicular traffic and terminating in a turnaround area. E. Dead-End Street. A street having only one outlet for vehicular traffic. F. Half-Street. A portion of the width of a street, usually along the outside perimeter of a subdivision, where the remaining portion of the street must be located on adjacent property. G. Local Streets. A street having the primary purpose of permitting access to abutting lands and connections to higher systems. Generally, service to higher speed traffic movements are intentionally discouraged. They typically carry 1,000 to 3,000 vehicles per day but can carry in excess of 6,000. H. Loop. A local street which begins and ends on the same street, generally used for access to properties and to control traffic access to arterials or collectors. 18.80.2950 STRUCTURE Anything constructed or erected which requires location on the ground; and for the purposes of floodplain review anything which may impede, retard or alter the pattern of flow of water in a floodplain. 18.80.2960 STRUCTURAL ALTERATION Any change in the supporting members of a building, such as bearing walls or partitions, columns, beams or girders, or any change in the exterior walls or the roof. 18.80.2970 SUBDIVIDER Any person, firm, corporation or other entity who causes land to be subdivided or who proposes a subdivision of land. 18.80.2980 SUBDIVISION A division of land or land so divided that it creates one or more parcels containing less than 160 acres that cannot be described as a one-quarter aliquot part of a United States government section, exclusive of public roadways, in order that the title to or possession of the parcels may be sold, rented, leased or otherwise conveyed, and shall include any resubdivision, and shall further include any condominium or area, regardless of its size, that provides or will provide multiple space for recreational camping vehicles or manufactured homes. A subdivision shall comprise only those parcels less than 160 acres that cannot be described as a one-quarter aliquot part of a United States government section when the parcels have been segregated from the original tract, and the plat thereof shall show all such parcels whether contiguous or not. 18.80.2990 SUBDIVISION OR DEVELOPMENT CONSTRUCTION YARD A temporary office and/or vehicular and material storage yard. 18.80.3000 SUBSTANTIAL DAMAGE Damage sustained by a structure where the cost of restoring the structure to its condition before damage would equal or exceed 50 percent of the market value of the structure before the damage occurred as determined by Gallatin County’s last equalized assessment roll. 268 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-34 18.80.3010 SUBSTANTIAL IMPROVEMENT Any repair, reconstruction or improvement of a structure, the cost of which equals or exceeds 50 percent of the market value of the structure either: A. Before the improvement or repair is started; or B. If the structure has been damaged, and is being restored, before the damage occurred. For the purposes of this definition, substantial improvement is considered to occur when the first construction to any wall, ceiling, floor or other structural part of the building commences. The term does not include: 1. Any project for improvement of a structure to comply with existing state or local health, sanitary or safety code specifications which are solely necessary to assure safe living conditions, or 2. Any alteration of a structure listed on the National Register of Historic Places or State Inventory of Historic Places. 18.80.3020 SUITABLE FILL Fill material which is stable, compacted, well-graded, pervious, generally unaffected by water and frost, devoid of trash or similar foreign matter, devoid of tree stumps or other organic material and is fitting for the purpose of supporting the intended use and/or permanent structure. 18.80.3030 SURVEYOR (REGISTERED LAND SURVEYOR) A person licensed in conformance with the Montana Professional Engineers, Registration Act (§37-67- 101 through §37-67-332, MCA) to practice surveying in the State of Montana. 18.80.3040 SWAP MEET Any permanent or temporary sales or lot where the sale or trade of goods, materials and merchandise takes place outside any permanent structure, from within temporary structures or from vehicles and where several sellers or traders may congregate for the purpose of selling or trading. 18.80.3050 TEMPORARY USE A use established for a fixed period of time with the intent to discontinue such use upon the expiration of the time period. 18.80.3060 TRANSIT STOP Improvements and facilities at selected points along transit routes for passenger pickup, drop off and waiting. Facilities and improvements may include shelters, benches, signs, structures and other improvements to provide security, protection from the weather and access to nearby services. 18.80.3070 TOWNHOUSE A dwelling unit, located on its own lot, that shares one or more common or abutting walls with one or more dwelling units, each located on its own lot. A townhouse does not share common floors/ceilings with other dwelling units. 18.80.3080 TOWNHOUSE CLUSTER A building consisting of three or more noncommunicating, attached one-household units placed side by side and/or back to back, with no unit located over another, and having a common wall between each two adjacent dwelling units. 269 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-35 18.80.3090 TRACT OF RECORD An individual parcel of land, irrespective of ownership, that can be identified by legal description, independent of any other parcel of land, using documents on file in the records of the County Clerk and Recorder’s Office. 18.80.3100 UNIFORMITY RATIO In outdoor lighting, a measure indicating how evenly light is distributed across a surface as expressed in a ratio of one value to another, such as average to minimum, or maximum to minimum. Using ratios, perfect uniformity would be 1:1. 18.80.3110 USE The employment or occupation of a building, structure or land for a person’s service, benefit or enjoyment. 18.80.3115 USABLE LOT AREA The portion of an area of a lot exclusive of setbacks or other building restrictions within which structures subject to setbacks may be placed. 18.80.3120 VARIANCE A modification or variation of the provisions of this title as applied to a specific piece of property. 18.80.3130 VIOLATION The failure of a structure, subdivision, use of land or other development to be fully compliant with this title. 18.80.3140 WALL SIGN Any sign painted on, attached to or erected against the wall of a building, structure, canopy or awning with the exposed face of the sign parallel to the plane of said wall or structure. The sign must be attached in a manner so that it does not extend 6 inches beyond the wall. 18.80.3150 WAREHOUSE An enclosed building designed and used primarily for the storage of goods and materials. 18.80.3160 WATERCOURSE Any stream, river, creek, drainage, waterway, gully, ravine or wash in which some or all of the water is naturally occurring, such as runoff or springs, and which flows either continuously or intermittently and has a definite channel, bed and banks, and includes any area adjacent thereto subject to inundation by reason of overflow. In the event of a braided or other multiple channel configuration of a watercourse, the area of the watercourse shall be that area lying between the two outermost high water marks, as defined in this title. The term watercourse shall not be construed to mean any facility created exclusively for the conveyance of irrigation water or stormwater. The City may consult with other agencies with expertise in this matter when there is a question of whether a particular water body is a watercourse. 18.80.3170 WETLAND Areas that are inundated or saturated by surface or groundwater at a frequency and duration sufficient to support, and that under normal circumstances do support, a prevalence of vegetation typically adapted for life in saturated soil conditions, including swamps, marshes, bogs and similar areas. The provisions contained in these regulations do not apply to wetlands created by a wholly man-made water source used for irrigation purposes or stormwater control. 270 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-36 Those areas that are inundated or saturated by surface or ground water at a frequency and duration sufficient to support, and that under normal circumstances do support, a prevalence of vegetation typically adapted for life in saturated soil conditions, and meet the established criteria briefly described below. A. Vegetation: A prevalence of hydrophytic vegetation. Hydrophytic species, due to morphological, physiological, and/or reproductive adaptation(s), have the ability to grow, effectively compete, reproduce, and/or persist in anaerobic soil conditions. B. Soils: A hydric soil is a soil that formed under conditions of saturation, flooding, or ponding long enough during the growing season to develop anaerobic conditions in the upper part. C. Hydrology: The area is inundated either permanently or periodically, or the soil is saturated to the surface at some time during the growing season of the prevalent vegetation at a duration sufficient to induce anaerobic and reducing conditions. 18.80.3180 WHOLESALE The sale of goods and merchandise for resale instead of for direct consumption. 18.80.3190 WILDLIFE Animals that are neither human, domesticated, nor feral descendants of commonly domesticated animals. 18.80.3200 WILDLIFE HABITAT The place or type of habitat where wildlife naturally lives. 18.80.3210 WINDOW SIGN Any sign painted, attached, glued or otherwise affixed to a window for the purpose of being visible from the exterior of the building. 18.80.3220 WIRELESS FACILITY An unstaffed facility for the transmission or reception of radio frequency (RF), microwave or other signals for commercial communications purposes, typically consisting of an equipment enclosure, an antenna support structure and one or more antennae. This definition excludes amateur radios, Essential Services (Type I), satellite earth stations and private receive-only antennae, such as for the reception of television signals. 18.80.3230 WRECKING YARD A place, lot or area where the primary function is that of dismantling, storage, abandonment or sale of goods and materials as parts or scraps. 18.80.3240 YARD A space on the same lot with a principal building, which is open and unoccupied from the ground upward or from the ground downward other than by steps, walks, terraces, driveways, lamp posts and similar structures, and unobstructed by structures, except as otherwise provided in this title. 18.80.3250 ZONING COMMISSION The Bozeman Zoning Commission. 271 Ordinance # 1761 page 80-37 18.80.3260 ZONING MAP A map or maps with all notations, dimensions, references and symbols shown thereon depicting individual zoned districts in accordance with this title. 272